TIDMFXPO
RNS Number : 7180W
Ferrexpo PLC
23 April 2019
23 April 2019
Ferrexpo plc
("Ferrexpo", the "Group" or the "Company")
2018 Full Year Results: 40% increase in dividends to a record
23.1 US cents, increased capital investment and continued debt
reduction.
Ferrexpo plc today announces its financial results for the year
ended 31 December 2018.
Steve Lucas, Non-executive Chairman, said:
"I am pleased to report a successful year for Ferrexpo. We
continued to benefit from the strong global demand for our
high-grade iron ore pellets, which helped deliver strong cash flow
despite a rise in costs. This enabled us to increase investment,
reduce debt further and pay a record dividend."
"Our balance sheet is now strong and this gives us a platform to
deliver the next stage in our planned expansion. This year we plan
to increase investment once more to be able to hit our medium-term
production target of 12 million tonnes per annum by 2021 and lay
the foundations for our longer-term intention to move to annual
output of 20 million tonnes per annum."
Extract of 2018 Financial Performance:
US$ million (unless otherwise stated) Year ended Year ended Change
31.12.18 31.12.17
Total pellet production (kt) 10,607 10,444 1.6%
----------- ----------- -------
Sales volumes (kt) 10,227 10,467 -2.3%
----------- ----------- -------
Average CFR 62% iron ore fines price (US$/t) 69.5 71.3 -2.5%
----------- ----------- -------
Revenue 1,274 1,197 6.4%
----------- ----------- -------
C1 cash cost of production(A) (US$/t) 43.3 32.3 34.1%
----------- ----------- -------
Underlying EBITDA(A) 503 551 -8.7%
----------- ----------- -------
Underlying EBITDA margin(A) 39% 46% -7ppt
----------- ----------- -------
Profit for the year 335 394 -15.0%
----------- ----------- -------
Diluted EPS 56.7 66.9 -15.2%
----------- ----------- -------
Dividend per share (US cents) 23.1 16.5 40.0%
----------- ----------- -------
Net cash flow from operating activities 292 353 -17.3%
----------- ----------- -------
Capital investment(A) 135 103 31.1%
----------- ----------- -------
Net debt 339 394 -14.0%
----------- ----------- -------
Total liquidity(A) 268 312 -14.1%
----------- ----------- -------
Net debt to Underlying EBITDA (A) 0.67x 0.72x -8.2%
----------- ----------- -------
Health and Safety
-- We deeply regret to report one work related fatality in 2018 (2017: one)
-- Group Lost Time Injury Frequency Rate 1.18x (2017:1.17x)
Market Environment
-- Strong market environment for high grade pellets
-- Group achieved new record pellet premium
-- Average realised FOB price increased 9% compared to 2017
Operational
-- Production of pellets increased 2% to 10.6MT (2017: 10.4MT)
-- Production reflected planned pellet line refurbishment in 2Q
2018 and a general increase in maintenance levels
-- Production of premium 65% Fe pellets in line with 2017 at 9.9MT
-- Sales volumes of 10.2MT (2017: 10.5MT) reflected 400kt
increase in stocks due to temporary logistics constraints
-- C1 cash cost of production(A) of US$43.3 per tonne (2017:
US$32.3 per tonne) reflected higher commodity input prices, local
inflation and increased mining and maintenance activity
Financial
-- Revenue up 6% to US$1.3BN (2017: US$1.2BN) principally
reflecting higher pellet premiums and freight rates and lower sales
volumes
-- Underlying EBITDA (A) US$503M (2017: US$551M) reflected
higher average prices of US$9 per tonne offset by higher costs and
lower sales volumes
-- Profit before tax of US$392M (2017: US$450M)
-- Net cash flows from operating activities US$292M (2017:
US$353M) reflected lower underlying EBITDA and working capital
build mainly due to increased year end stocks
-- Net debt reduced 14% to US$339M as of 31 December 2018 (31 December 2017: US$394M)
-- Net debt to underlying EBITDA(A) lower for third consecutive
year at 0.67 times as of 31 December 2018 (as of 31 December 2017:
0.72 times)
-- Total liquidity (A) US$268M as of 31 December 2017 (31 December 2017: US$312M)
-- Final special dividend of 6.6 US cents per share (2017: 6.6
US cents) payable on 14 May 2019 and final ordinary dividend of 6.6
US cents per share proposed (2017: 3.3 US cents)
-- 40% increase in total dividend declared for 2018 to a 23.1 US
cents per share (total 2017 dividend per share: 16.5 US cents)
Outlook
To date in 2019, realised prices for Ferrexpo's pellets have
continued at high levels.
In 2019, the Group will continue its repairs and maintenance
programme which will include a 75 day pellet line shutdown in 2H
2019. Overall, 2019 production volumes are expected to be in line
with 2018 at approximately 10.6 million tonnes.
The cost of production in 2019 is expected to increase as a
result of higher commodity input prices and local inflation in
Ukraine. Year to date the Hryvnia has been broadly stable against
the US dollar, appreciating by approximately 2%.
Capital expenditure in 2019 will be focused towards growth
projects and is expected to be in the range of US$220 million to
US$300 million, subject to realised pricing and market conditions.
Of this, sustaining capital expenditure is expected to be in line
with 2018. Investment of approximately US$35 million is planned for
the Concentrator Expansion Programme 1 ("CEP1"), which is
anticipated to increase pellet production to approximately 12
million tonnes per annum by 2021. In addition, subject to market
conditions and available cash flows, Ferrexpo will commence
construction on a new press filtration plant and other pellet
capacity upgrade projects as well as purchase of additional rail
cars.
Alternative Performance Measures:
Words with the symbol (A) are defined in the Alternative
Performance Measures section on page 165.
Notes to Editors:
Ferrexpo is a Swiss headquartered iron ore company with assets
in Ukraine. It has been mining, processing and selling high quality
iron ore pellets to the global steel industry for 40 years.
Ferrexpo's resource base is one of the largest iron ore deposits in
the world. In 2018, the Group produced 10.6 million tonnes of
pellets, a 2% increase compared to 2017, ranking it as the 3rd
largest exporter of pellets to the global steel industry with a
market share of approximately 8.5%. Ferrexpo has a diversified
customer base supplying steel mills in Austria, Germany, Japan,
South Korea, Taiwan, China, Slovakia, the Czech Republic, Turkey
and Vietnam. Ferrexpo has a premium listing on the main market of
the London Stock Exchange under the ticker FXPO. For further
information, please visit www.ferrexpo.com
Analyst meeting:
There is an analyst and investor call at 09.00 GMT today. The
call will be hosted by Steve Lucas (Chairman), Kostyantin Zhevago
(CEO) and Chris Mawe (CFO).
Dial in details are as follows:
Audio webcast link:
https://edge.media-server.com/m6/p/jum5546n
If joining by telephone:
Standard International Dial-In: +44 (0) 203 0095710
Switzerland, Zurich: 0445804873
United States, New York: 19177200178
Conference ID: 2788744
For further information contact:
Ferrexpo:
Ingrid McMahon +44 207 389 8304
Maitland:
James Isola +44 207 379 5151
STRATEGIC REPORT
Chairman's Statement
Health and Safety
We deeply regret the fatality (2017: one) in October 2018 of
Maxim Blinkov, a contractor at Ferrexpo Poltava Mining ("FPM"), who
was fatally injured after falling from a height in the processing
plant. Our goal remains firmly focused on achieving zero fatalities
or injuries. On behalf of the Group, I would like to express our
sincere condolences to the family of our colleague.
Year in Summary
I am pleased to report another strong year for iron ore pellet
demand with premiums rising 30% over 2017 levels. In general, the
iron ore market in 2018 was notable for its unusually low levels of
volatility. Average iron ore prices for 58% Fe fines and the
benchmark 62% Fe fines declined marginally compared to 2017, while
the average price for 65% Fe fines increased by 3%. Pellets,
however, were an exception as steel mills looked to boost
productivity.
The steel industry experienced strong profitability for most of
2018 due to high global demand. As such, mills looked to increase
their utilisation rates to maximise output, while in China mills
also sought to decrease their emissions by reducing sintering and
increasing use of higher grade direct charge material, such as
pellet. Meanwhile, additional supply of pellet was limited,
resulting in pellet premiums trading at ten-year highs.
In the 4Q of 2018, steel margins contracted reflecting increased
global trade tensions and slower economic activity, especially in
China, while steel output remained at relatively high levels. As a
result steel demand and profit margins fell. To date in 1Q 2019,
the steel industry in China has seen a gradual recovery in margins,
while margins in Europe have been slower to improve.
In 2018, commodity producers experienced significantly higher
oil prices with an average 31% increase in the price of Brent
compared to 2017. This drove an increase in Ferrexpo's cost of
pellet production along with other external factors, such as local
PPI inflation of 18% while the Hryvnia appreciated marginally
against the US Dollar adding further to cost pressures. Ferrexpo
remains a low cost producer relative to the majority of its
peers.
Underlying EBITDA for 2018 was US$503 million (2017: US$551
million). Profit for the period was US$335 million (2017: US$394
million) while net cash flows from operating activities were US$292
million (2017: US$353 million).
Ferrexpo further strengthened its balance sheet during 2018 and
net debt reduced for the third consecutive year to US$339 million
as of 31 December 2018 (31 December 2017: US$394 million). The
Group has strong credit metrics with net debt to underlying EBITDA
comfortably below 1 times.
Finally, I am pleased to report, subject to shareholder
approval, a record dividend for the 2018 financial year of 23.1 US
cents per share, a 40% increase compared to 2017 (16.5 US cents per
share).
Industry
It is with immense sadness that we saw reports of the
catastrophic breach of a tailings dam in Brazil in January 2019. As
would be expected, there are likely to be far-reaching
consequences, including increased scrutiny of the global mining
industry. Ferrexpo supports the establishment of an independent
organisation to monitor the safety of all tailings dams on a global
basis to ensure compliance with the highest level of safety
standards.
Ferrexpo operates one tailings dam covering an area of 1,500
hectares. The dam is constructed on flat topography and the method
of construction is the Modified Centreline methodology. The dam is
inspected twice a year by the Ukrainian mining regulator. Following
the breach in Brazil in January, Ferrexpo appointed Knight Piesold,
an international independent consultant, to further review and
verify the dam's design, construction and monitoring.
For further information on the market environment see
Operational Review on page 16.
Iron Ore Pellet Market
Iron ore pellets are a niche market segment, representing 8% of
the total iron ore export market, principally due to high barriers
to entry, including the requirement to beneficiate and upgrade the
iron ore and the high capital intensity to establish a full
mine-to-port pelletising operation which is typically in excess of
US$300 per tonne of output for a greenfield operation.
Pellets are one of the most efficient sources of iron in the
steelmaking process. This has underpinned demand and profitability
for established pellet producers for many years. As in the past, we
continue to believe long-term demand for pellet will be supported
by requirements for iron ore of a higher grade and in a form that
reduces energy inputs, slag volumes and air emissions in the
steelmaking process while improving the quality of the final
product. This is likely to be further supported by the general
decline of naturally occurring high quality iron ore fines and lump
as well as ongoing consolidation in the steel industry in China and
Europe, which underpins a general increase in utilisation
rates.
For these reasons Ferrexpo expects pellets to continue to
receive a healthy price premium relative to other types of iron ore
which will underpin the Group's profitability. The size of the
premium, however, is likely to vary in line with steel mill
profitability reflecting the cyclical nature of the industry. Given
the limited availability of seaborne pellets, however, supply
disruptions can also influence pricing until the market is able to
adjust. The Group expects reduced supply of global pellet exports
in 2019 and 2020 following the major supply disruptions in
Brazil.
With the best steel mills in the world amongst Ferrexpo's
customers, the Company is well positioned to benefit from
increasing demand.
For further information on the market environment see Market
Review on page 12.
Capital Allocation
The Group's capital allocation strategy is to maintain an
appropriate balance between investment grade credit metrics,
attractive dividends and investment in growth opportunities. This
strategy has been designed to reduce the risks inherent in
operating in an emerging market while selling our product in a
volatile commodities market.
Balance Sheet
During the year Ferrexpo's credit rating was upgraded by
Moody's, Fitch and S&P. Ferrexpo's credit rating is restricted
by Ukraine' country ceiling and the Group's rating should improve
in line with positive developments in Ukraine.
Ferrexpo aims to maintain prudent leverage metrics with net debt
to underlying EBITDA as of 31 December 2018 at 0.67 times. The
Group's priority since 2015 has been to reduce debt and it has
repaid over US$500 million of gross debt since 1 January 2016. As
such, the Board feels it is appropriate to readjust the use of
available free cash flows from primarily deleveraging to include a
more balanced focus on dividends and investment projects whilst
ensuring the Group's credit metrics remain strong.
Dividends
The Board is pleased to announce a special dividend of 6.6 US
cents per share (2017 final special dividend: 6.6 US cents per
share) and propose a final ordinary dividend per share of 6.6 US
cents per share (2017 final ordinary dividend: 3.3 US cents per
share). If the final ordinary dividend is approved by shareholders,
the total dividend declared for the 2018 financial year will be a
record 23.1 US cents per share, equivalent to approximately US$135
million (2017 total dividend declared: 16.5 US cents per share or
US$97 million). This reflects the long-term structural factors
underpinning pellet demand and the continued solid cash generation
of the Group.
Capital Investment(A)
Capital investment(A) increased by 31% in 2018 to US$135 million
(2017: US$103 million). This included the Group's Concentrate
Expansion Programme 1 ("CEP1") which will enable the Group to
increase pellet output by 13% or approximately 1.5 million tonnes
to 12 million tonnes per annum in 2021.
Ferrexpo has a number of priority projects and will continue to
invest in these project in 2019. Subject to available cash
generation through the year and to debt repayments and dividend
declarations, the Group will increase its annual capex expenditure
to include initial investment into growth projects aimed at
increasing pellet production beyond 12 million tonnes per
annum.
This portfolio of projects has the potential to increase pellet
production volumes up to 20 million tonnes per annum.
In total, capex(A) for 2019 is expected to be in a range of
US$170 million to US$220 million, subject to realised pricing.
Ferrexpo's investment strategy remains to identify opportunities
which are value accretive to the Group and that can reduce
operating risk.
Social Responsibility
For the year ended 2018, it is expected that Ferrexpo's pellet
exports will be approximately 2%(1) of Ukraine's total export
revenue. The Board believes it is essential to the Group's
long-term viability to ensure a positive contribution to the
society in which it operates, aiding the long-term development of
Ukraine and creating a stable operating environment for the
Group.
(1) UkrStat
(http://ukrstat.gov.ua/express/expr2019/02/17.pdf)
In order to maintain its social licence to operate, Ferrexpo
provides financial support to a broad array of social programmes
and, in 2018, it invested approximately 1% of total Group revenue
in these programmes.
Independent Review of Charitable Donations to Blooming Land
As part of the Group's Corporate Social Responsibility ('CSR')
programme in Ukraine, since 2013 the Group has donated to a charity
called Blooming Land which operates through three sub-funds (the
"Charity"). The Charity's activities include diabetes prevention,
eyesight care and support for the elderly. In the year ended 31
December 2018, the Group made contributions to the Charity of
US$9.5 million (2017: US$24.0 million).
The Board suspended donations to the Charity in May 2018
following continued delays in receiving additional information,
which the Charity regarded as beyond the normal requirements
expected of a Ukrainian charity, and while it awaited the outcome
of a review into the Charity's 2017 audited financial
statements.
Following the publication of the Group's Interim Results in
August 2018, a number of irregularities were reported to the Board
including inconsistencies in copy bank statements provided by the
Charity to Deloitte, the Group's auditor.
Explanations were received from the Charity which were
considered incomplete and unsatisfactory and could not be
independently verified. As a result in February 2019, the Board
established the Independent Review Committee ("IRC") to look into
this and other matters which included seeking to determine that
Ferrexpo's donations were used for their stated purpose.
As at the date of this report, the work of the IRC and its
advisers in the UK and Ukraine remains ongoing. The IRC has made
some progress in receiving explanations regarding the
inconsistencies contained on the copy bank statements and has
received some third party evidence and explanations that could
explain bank statement inconsistencies as well as some of the
possible discrepancies in the application of funds by the Charity.
The IRC is undertaking further work to corroborate and verify the
evidence and explanations. Its interim conclusion is that the
Charity is not a related party of the Group, its Chief Executive
Officer (the majority shareholder of Ferrexpo) or its executive
management, as defined under applicable accounting standards or
Chapter 11 of the Listing Rules. At this stage, the IRC cannot yet
conclude as to the ultimate use of the funds by the Charity,
however, there are indications some could have been
misappropriated. Further work is required before any final
conclusion can be drawn. For further information see the IRC report
page 46.
The Board notes that the auditors have been unable to conclude
as to whether the Chief Executive Officer ("CEO") does or does not
have significant influence or control over Blooming Land. The Board
has formed a unanimous view, based on a lack of clear evidence to
the contrary and unambiguous representations given to the Board by
the CEO over many years, that the CEO does not have significant
influence or control over Blooming Land.
The Board together with the IRC are committed to understanding
the full extent of any issues arising from the review and will
continue to update shareholders as appropriate.
Given the extensive disclosures on the Blooming Land Charity in
this announcement, for ease of reading and to avoid repetition, the
following cross references are listed: Chairman's Statement (page
6), Principal Risks (page 25), Note 7 (page 106), Note 29 (page
149), Note 33 (page 156) and Note 34 (page 156) to the financial
statements.
Ukraine
In December 2018, Moody's upgraded Ukraine's sovereign credit
rating to Caa1 with a stable outlook. The upgrade was based on
improved economic fundamentals which have reduced vulnerability to
external shocks, expectations that recent reforms will improve
transparency and strengthen institutions, and higher resilience to
regional geographic risk.
Moody's expects Ukrainian real GDP growth of approximately 3.5%
in 2018. Against this background of GDP growth and gradual ongoing
improvements to the country's fiscal and regulatory environment,
the Board of Ferrexpo believes Ukraine is progressively moving in
the right direction although challenges remain.
Board Composition
Simon Lockett resigned from the Board in January 2019. The Board
would like to thank Simon for his contribution to the Group and
wish him every success in the future.
In February 2019, Lucio Genovese was reappointed to the Board as
a Non-executive Director. Lucio previously served on the Board from
2007 to 2014. The Board believes that Lucio's deep knowledge across
commodities, including iron ore, as well as his extensive
experience of operating in emerging markets, specifically in Russia
and the former CIS states, is of significant value to the
Group.
People
The Board would like to sincerely express its appreciation for
the management and staff, many of whom we have had the pleasure of
meeting on our Board site visits, for their continued hard work
which directly contributes to the Company's achievements. I am very
pleased with the manner in which Ferrexpo has withstood market and
country volatility since the IPO in 2007. The Group is emerging as
a strong competitor operating to ever higher world class
standards.
Steve Lucas
Chairman
PERFORMANCE REVIEW
Financial Review
Summary
Strong demand for iron ore pellets in 2018 enabled Ferrexpo to
achieve a record pellet premium. While pellet premiums increased
30% over 2017 levels, the C1 cost per tonne of production increased
34% in line with higher commodity input prices and local inflation,
while the Hryvnia appreciated marginally during the period adding
further upward cost pressure.
The Group increased pellet production by 2% to 10.6 million
tonnes (2017: 10.4 million tonnes) and maintained the grade of its
output with 94% of its production in the form of 65% Fe pellets.
Sales volumes were 10.2 million tonnes (2017: 10.5 million tonnes)
reflecting low water levels on the Danube River in the 2H 2018 and
slower than expected railings in December which delayed some sales
into 2019.
Overall, underlying EBITDAA for 2018 was US$503 million (2017:
US$551 million). Profit for the period was US$335 million (2017:
US$394 million) principally reflecting higher sales prices offset
by increased production costs, lower sales volumes and an operating
foreign exchange loss compared with a gain in 2017.
Capital investment (A) increased 31% to US$135 million (2017:
US$103 million) primarily reflecting sustaining capex and the
Group's Concentrate Expansion Programme ("CEP1"). Net debt reduced
by 14% to US$339 million as of 31 December 2018 (31 December 2017:
US$394 million). The Group has strong credit metrics with net debt
to underlying EBITDA (A) at 0.67 times, a seven-year low. The Group
successfully increased its primary debt facility during the year
which has smoothed and extended its debt maturity profile. This is
in line with our strategy to have a principal revolving, low cost,
long-term debt facility that amortises on a quarterly basis.
Finally, subject to shareholder approval, the Group is pleased
to announce an increase in dividends for the 2018 financial year to
a record 23.1 US cents per share, a 40% increase compared to 2017
(16.5 US cents).
Revenue
Group revenue increased 6.4% to US$1,274 million compared to
US$1,197 million in 2017.
In 2018, the Group's pellet sales contracts were all priced
based on a spot 62% Fe iron ore fines price, a negotiated pellet
premium adjusting for the cost of international freight, typically
the C3 index from Brazil to China. Subject to customer preference,
pellet premiums were negotiated annually, half yearly or
quarterly.
Ferrexpo's achieved price in 2018, after taking into account the
above price movements, increased by US$9 per tonne compared to
2017.
Due to strong market demand for the Group's 65% Fe pellets,
Ferrexpo achieved a record average pellet premium in 2018.
The average 62% Fe iron ore fines price fell marginally in 2018
to US$70 per tonne (2017: US$71 per tonne) while international
freight increased by 20% principally due to higher oil prices. The
average C3 freight rate increased by US$3 per tonne to US$18 per
tonne (2017: US$15 per tonne). During the year, the Group also
marginally increased shipments to Asia and Western Europe. As such,
turnover from seaborne freight services increased to US$90 million
compared to US$73 million in 2017.
Sales volumes for the year were 10.2 million tonnes compared to
10.5 million tonnes in 2017. Sales volumes were impacted by reduced
barge shipments towards the end of the year given the low water
levels on the Danube River in 2H 2018. Slower than expected rail
shipments in December and a delay of an ocean-going shipment into
1H 2019 also lowered sales volumes and increased year end working
capital. The Group expects these sales volumes to be caught up in
1H 2019. Pellet stocks as of 31 December 2018 were approximately
794,000 tonnes compared to a more normal level of 390,000 tonnes as
at the end of 2017.
Costs
Cost of Goods Sold
Ferrexpo's total cost of goods sold was US$508 million in 2018
compared to US$411 million in 2017. The 24% increase primarily
reflected higher commodity input prices, local inflation and an
increase in maintenance activities and mining costs.
C1 Cash Cost of Production(A)
The Group's average C1 cash cost of productionA was US$43.3 per
tonne in 2018 compared to US$32.3 per tonne
in 2017.
The increase in costs was primarily due to commodity and local
cost inflation. Commodity linked costs increased by US$3.3 per
tonne which included a 13% increase in electricity tariffs due to a
higher average ARA coal price, while higher fuel costs reflected a
US$19 per barrel, or 31%, increase in the average European Brent
spot price in 2018 compared to 2017. Higher gas prices also partly
mirrored the higher oil price, while increased grinding media costs
reflected higher steel prices.
Local inflation, including the impact of higher wages, increased
costs by approximately US$2.8 per tonne. Local producer price
inflation was 18% in 2018 compared to 2017. The local currency was
broadly stable against the US Dollar and appreciated 1% from 1
January 2018 to 31 December 2018. Approximately half of the Group's
operating costs, including rail costs, are in local currency and
are impacted by the Hryvnia exchange rate and domestic inflation.
For further information see Currency see page 9.
Together, commodity and local cost inflation increased the C1
cash cost of productionA by approximately US$6.1 per tonne.
Repair and maintenance costs increased by US$2.1 per tonne due
to higher levels of maintenance activities in 2018. The Group has
increased its repair and maintenance activities to further improve
equipment reliability and performance.
Higher stripping at FPM increased the C1 cost of productionA by
US$1.9 per tonne.
Royalties and other costs increased by 0.9 per tonne. Royalties,
which are based on the cost of concentrate production, increased by
US$0.7 per tonne compared to 2017, while higher gas consumption
increased costs by US$0.2 per tonne.
Table 1 breaks down the Group's C1 cash cost of productionA by
category; approximately 60% of costs are commodity related.
Table 1: C1 Cash Cost of Production A Breakdown
2018 2017
US$ per tonne % of C1 cost % of C1 cost
------------------------ ------------ ------------
Electricity 23% 28%
Gas 10% 10%
Fuel 9% 9%
Materials 16% 14%
Spare parts 9% 7%
Personnel 9% 8%
Maintenance and repairs 8% 8%
Grinding media 8% 9%
Royalties 5% 5%
Explosives 3% 2%
------------------------ ------------ ------------
The Group's C1 cost of productionA represents the cash costs of
production of iron pellets from own ore, divided by production
volume from own ore, and excludes non-cash costs such as
depreciation, pension costs and inventory movements, also the costs
of purchased ore, concentrate and gravel.
The C1 Cash Cost of Production (US$ per tonne) (A) is regarded
as an Alternative Performance Measure ("APM"). For further
information see page 165.
Selling and Distribution Costs
Selling and distribution costs were US$260 million compared to
US$220 million in 2017. The increase primarily reflected higher
seaborne freight rates (see Revenue) and a marginal increase in
shipment volumes to Asia and Western Europe; as such, seaborne
freight increased to US$90 million compared to US$73 million in
2017.
Rail costs to transport pellets to border points for export
increased during the year, reflecting a full year impact of a 15%
rail tariff increase in October 2017. As of 31 December 2018, the
Group owned 2,252 rail cars. Since then a further 153 rail cars
have been delivered to FPM, increasing the Group's ownership to
2,405 rail cars as of 28 February 2019. This should improve
availability and ensure smooth shipments especially during the
grain season in Ukraine.
Currency
Ferrexpo prepares its accounts in US Dollars, whereas the
functional currency of the Ukrainian operations is the Hryvnia.
In 2018, the Hryvnia appreciated from UAH28.07 per US Dollar on
1 January to UAH27.69 per US Dollar as of 31 December 2018. This
resulted in a non-cash operating forex loss of US$ 5.3 million
compared to a gain of US$6.7 million in 2017 (following the
depreciation of the Hryvnia from 27.19 to 28.07 per US Dollar in
2017).
Table 2: Ukrainian Hryvnia vs. US Dollar
UAH per US$
----------------- -----------
Spot 27.90
1 January 2018 28.07
31 December 2018 27.69
Average 2018 27.20
Average 2017 26.60
----------------- -----------
Source: National Bank of Ukraine.
Local balances at 31 December 2018 are converted into the
Group's reporting currency at the prevailing exchange rate. The
appreciation of the Hryvnia during the financial year 2018 resulted
in a US$12.1 million increase in net assets (2017: decrease of
US$41.2 million), as reflected in the translation reserve.
Operating Foreign Exchange Gains/Losses
Given that the functional currency of the Ukrainian subsidiaries
is the Hryvnia, an appreciation of the Hryvnia against the US
Dollar results in foreign exchange losses on the subsidiaries' US
Dollar denominated receivable balances (from the sale of pellets),
compared to a gain in 2017 due to the depreciation of the UAH. The
operating foreign exchange loss in 2018 was US$5.3 million compared
to a gain of US$6.7 million in 2017.
Non-operating Foreign Exchange Gains/Losses
Non-operating foreign exchange gains/ losses are mainly due to
the conversion of loans in currencies different to the functional
currency of certain subsidiaries of the Group, and are principally
from the conversion of Euro denominated loans (relating to loans to
the Group's logistics operations in Austria). During 2018, the Euro
slightly depreciated from 0.838 per US Dollar to 0.874 per US
Dollar, resulting in a non-operating foreign exchange loss of
US$1.6 million. In 2017, the Euro appreciated from 0.956 per US
Dollar to 0.838 per US Dollar which resulted in a non-operating
foreign exchange gain of US$9 million.
Profit Before Tax and Finance
Profit before tax and finance was US$433 million compared to
US$496 million in 2017. This primarily reflected higher sales
prices offset by lower sales volumes and cost inflation as well as
a net change of US$12.0 million of operating foreign exchange
differences (losses of US$5.3 million in 2018 compared to gains of
US$6.7 million in 2017).
Debt and Interest Paid
Gross debt as of 31 December 2018 declined 18% to US$402 million
compared to the prior year end (31 December 2017: US$492
million).
This reflected total debt repayments of US$309 million. This
included the US$113 million final amortisation of the Group's 2013
Pre-Export Finance ("PXF") facility, a US$173 million Eurobond
redemption (first out of two, with the second redemption due in
April 2019) and repayment of the remaining US$23 million due under
Export Credit Agency ("ECA") loans.
In August 2018, Ferrexpo announced that it had increased its
2017 PXF credit facility from US$195 million to US$400 million and
extended the tenor from three to four years. This is a revolving
committed facility with a one-year grace period. Quarterly
amortisation commences in 2020. The interest rate is 450 basis
points + three-month US$ LIBOR.
Due to the lower gross debt, finance expense declined 29% to
US$39 million during the period (2017: US$55 million). The average
cost of debt for the period ended 31 December 2018 was 8.2%
(average 2017: 8.0%). The increased average rate reflected
amortisation of the Group's 2013 PXF facility which had a lower
cost than the Group's outstanding US$173 million Eurobond.
Following final redemption of the Group's Eurobond in April 2019
for US$173 million (coupon 10.375%), 98% of its outstanding debt
will be at floating interest rates.
For further details see Total Liquidity (A) and Debt Maturity
Profile on page 12.
Tax
In 2018, the Group's tax charge was US$57 million, resulting in
an effective tax rate of 14.5%. This compares to an effective tax
rate of 12.3% in 2017 and a tax charge of US$55 million.
As a result of a higher achieved selling price in 2018, the
effective tax rate reflected a higher proportion of taxable profits
at the Group's Ukrainian subsidiaries. This increased the weighted
average statutory tax rate from 13.5% in 2017 to 15.5% in 2018.
For further information see Note 8 of the financial
statements
Profit for the Year from Continuing Operations
Profit for the year was US$335 million (2017: US$394 million).
This reflected lower operating profit and non-operating foreign
exchange losses offset by a US$16 million reduction in finance
expense while income tax expense was in line with 2017.
Cash Flows
Net cash flows from operating activities
Net cash flows from operating activities were US$292 million in
2018 compared to US$353 million in 2017. This reflected a working
capital outflow of US$116 million during the year compared to an
outflow of US$110 million in 2017.
Working capital included an increase of US$40 million (2017:
US$53 million) in stocks of lower grade iron ore which are to be
processed following the addition of beneficiation capacity.
Trade receivables were higher, reflecting higher pricing in 2H
2018 and an increase in inventories of US$48 million (2017: US$26
million). This reflected higher pellet stocks at the yearend as
well as higher spare parts and raw materials due to an increase in
maintenance activities.
VAT was received promptly during most of 2018. A delayed VAT
receipt in December 2018 of US$12 million, however, further
increased working capital. The VAT was subsequently received in
January 2019.
Capital Investment(A)
Capital expenditure in 2018 was US$135 million compared to
US$103 million in 2017. Of this, US$66 million was sustaining and
modernisation capex (2017: US$43 million) at FPM. Sustaining capex
also included a substantial refurbishment of one of the Group's
four pellet lines during the period.
FYM investment of US$32 million (2017: US$32 million) included
capitalised stripping, completion of mine infrastructure,
commencement of drill automation and development of a spare parts
warehouse for the Group as part of the integration of certain key
functions between the Group's operations.
Investment in FPM's CEP1 was US$24 million (2017: US$18 million)
which, once complete, will increase pellet production by
approximately 1.5 million tonnes per annum. In 2018, activities
included commissioning of a new medium fine crushing unit ("MFC1")
which has increased the capacity of FPM's crushers by up to 6
million tonnes per annum. This additional crushing capacity will be
fully utilised once the remaining sections to increase the
concentrator capacity are completed in 2020. The construction of a
concentrator stockyard is under way and expected to be completed by
the end of 2019. The stockyard will facilitate continuous operation
of the processing plant while parts of the plant undergo routine
maintenance.
Ferrexpo invested US$4 million (in line with 2017) in the
development and exploration of the Belanovo, Galeschyno and the
Northern Deposits.
The Group acquired 50 rail cars in December 2018 for
approximately US$5 million. While it invested approximately US$5
million of sustaining capex at its logistics company in Austria in
2018 (2017: US$4 million).
Ferrexpo continues engineering studies to expand its pelletising
capacity above its current nameplate capacity of 12 million tonnes
per annum towards 20 million tonnes per annum.
Dividends
A final special dividend for the year of 6.6 US cents (2017: 6.6
US cents) has been announced today and will be paid on 14 May 2019
to shareholders on the register at the close of business on 3 May
2019. A final ordinary dividend of 6.6 US cents per share is being
proposed (2017: 3.3 US cents). If the final ordinary dividend is
approved by shareholders, the total dividend related to 2018 will
be 23.1 US cents per share (2017: 16.5 US cents per share)(1) .
(1) In August 2018, the Group declared an ordinary interim
dividend of 3.3 US cents (1H 2017: 3.3 US cents per share) while in
December 2018 the Group declared a special interim dividend of 6.6
US cents (special interim dividend 2017: 3.3 US cents per
share).
Subject to approval at the Group's AGM, payment of the final
ordinary dividend will be made on 1 July 2019 to shareholders on
the register at the close of business on 14 June 2019.
The dividend will be paid in UK Pounds Sterling with an election
to receive US Dollars.
Total Liquidity(A) and Debt Maturity Profile
As of 31 December 2018, Ferrexpo's total available liquidity (A)
was US$268 million (2017: US$312 million) consisting of US$63
million of cash and US$205 million of the Group's US$400 million
committed PXF facility. In March 2019, the Group drew down US$185
million of the available US$205 million PXF facility.
In 2019, the Group has US$187 million of debt repayments
consisting of a US$173 million Eurobond (which was repaid on 4
April 2019) and US$14 million of Export Credit Agency repayments
across the year.
The Group has US$70 million of uncommitted trade finance
facilities available of which US$19 million was drawn as of 31
December 2018.
Net debt declined for the third year to US$339 million as of 31
December 2018 (31 December 2017: US$394 million). Net debt to
underlying EBITDA for the last 12 months was 0.67 times compared to
0.72 times as of 31 December 2017.
Total debt outstanding, as of 31 December 2018, was US$402
million (31 December 2017: US$492 million).
For further information See Debt and Interest Paid on page
10.
In 1Q 2020, the Group's US$400 million PXF facility commences
quarterly amortisations of approximately US$33 million over three
years.
During the year, Ferrexpo's long-term corporate and debt rating
was upgraded by credit rating agencies to B+ at Fitch (an upgrade
of two notches) and to B3 and B respectively at Moody's and S&P
(an upgrade of one notch). With all credit rating agencies,
Ferrexpo has a stable outlook and its rating is capped at the
maximum level above Ukraine's Sovereign rating.
Following the successful extension of its PXF facility in 2018,
Ferrexpo may look to further extend its debt maturity profile in
2019 using the PXF market or other debt capital markets.
MARKET REVIEW
In 2018, the average Atlantic pellet premium increased 30% to
US$59 per tonne compared to US$45 per tonne in 2017.
The first nine months of the year saw strong global demand for
steel resulting in increased production levels and margins
for steel mills. This increased demand for higher quality iron
ore, including pellet, as mills looked to drive productivity
improvements to maximise profit levels. In addition, ongoing
environmental reforms in China encouraged the use of direct charge
materials, such as pellet, to reduce the harmful impact of
sintering on air quality.
The 4Q of 2018 was impacted by rising trade tensions and slower
economic activity, especially in China. Steel output, however,
remained at relatively high levels as government imposed winter
production cuts in China were not as severe as expected. As a
result, steel demand and profit margins fell.
CRU expects global steel demand to be stable in 2019 and that
steel margins will recover from the lows seen in 4Q 2018; however,
it does not expect margins to recover to the highs seen in
2018.
Steel and Iron Ore Market Statistics in 2018
According to CRU crude steel production increased 2.5% in 2018
to 1,730 million tonnes compared to 1,687 million tonnes in 2017.
The increase of 44 million tonnes was driven by China, the rest of
Asia and America while production declined marginally in
Europe.
The benchmark 62% Fe iron ore fines price in 2018 was
characterised by low volatility compared to previous years with
average yearly prices not materially different to 2017. The
benchmark 62% Fe iron ore fines price CFR China traded in a
historically tight range of US$60 to US$80 per tonne in 2018.
In contrast to the benchmark 62% Fe fines price, premiums for
65% Fe high grade ore reached record levels during the year before
normalising in 4Q 2018. This largely reflected global steel mill
profitability peaking in September.
Overall, 2018 was a record year for high grade premiums. On
average, the 65% Fe iron ore fines price was 31% above the average
62% Fe iron ore fines price compared to 23% and 10% in 2017 and
2016 respectively.
Table 3: Average Price Differentials between Benchmark 62% Fe
Iron Fines and 65% Fe Iron Ore Fines
Avg 62% Fe Avg 65% Fe
iron ore fines iron ore fines
price CFR price CFR Avg 65% Fe %
US$ per tonne China China - Avg 62% Fe difference
-------------- -------------- -------------- ------------ ----------
2016 58 63 5 10%
2017 71 87 16 23%
2018 69 90 21 31%
-------------- -------------- -------------- ------------ ----------
Source: S&P Global Platts
Pellet utilisation rates in steel production vary regionally
across the world. Table 4 below, from Steel Consult International,
shows the consumption of pellet, lump and fines per tonne of hot
metal in Europe, Japan, the Middle East and China. Europe remains
the largest import market for pellets whilst the proportion of
sintering in China is high at close to 80% and North East Asia
utilises a higher proportion of lump given its proximity to lump
supply in Australia. The Middle East has a high proportion of
pellet as its steel production is derived from electric arc
furnaces (which use pellets as the principal source of iron
ore).
A 1% increase in the proportion of pellets consumed would
increase pellet demand by approximately 15 million tonnes per
annum.
Table 4: Average Ore Burden Mix to Produce Hot Metal (%)
% Sinter Pellet Lump
-------------- ------ ------ ----
EU 58% 36% 6%
Japan 65% 12% 23%
Middle East &
North Africa 9% 89% 2%
China 76% 10% 14%
-------------- ------ ------ ----
Source: Steel Consult International, November 2018
Demand for pellets is growing greatest in China which is
gradually moving towards a more developed iron ore market that
favours increased use of pellets to improve blast furnace
productivity, reduce its environmental emissions and produce more
sophisticated steel products (requiring higher quality inputs).
Traditional blast furnace pellet markets are Europe (principally
Germany) and North East Asia (Japan, South Korea and Taiwan),
reflecting their developed market status, including an increasing
focus on CO2 costs in Europe. The Middle East (Qatar and Saudi
Arabia) consumes a third of global pellet supply, up from 25% in
2010. CRU expects growing steel production from South East Asia
(especially Vietnam and Indonesia) over the medium to long term
which will almost entirely rely on seaborne iron ore inputs. This
region will also aim to operate larger, more efficient blast
furnaces which require at least 10% pellet in the blast furnace
burden mix.
Pellet Supply in 2018
The supply of pellet exports in 2018 was in line with 2017, with
total exports at approximately 132 million tonnes (vs. 133 million
tonnes in 2017). The biggest increase in pellet supply was from
Brazil, as the largest producer bought back previously idled
capacity. The Middle East also added extra capacity. The increases
in supply were offset by lower production from Canada and a decline
in exports from the CIS.Table 5 shows a breakdown of global pellet
exports by supplier; Ferrexpo is the third largest supplier with 8%
market share.
Table 5: Pellet Exporters in 2018
% Market share in
2018
-------------- ---------------
Vale 33.4%
LKAB 14.3%
Ferrexpo 7.7%
IOC 6.3%
India 5.8%
QCM 4.2%
Severstal 4.2%
Bahrain Steel 4.2%
US Steel 4.0%
Cliffs 3.8%
Metalloinvest 3.2%
CMP 2.2%
Grange 1.6%
Evraz 0.5%
Other 4.6%
Total 132MT
-------------- ---------------
Source: CRU, Market Outlook January 2019, Company
Pellet Supply in 2019
Supply of pellets in 2019 and 2020 is expected to be impacted by
closures of mines and pellet plants in Brazil due to heightened
concerns about the safety of upstream tailings dams.
Given these concerns, the largest supplier in Brazil, and the
world, has idled two pellet plants that together produced 11
million tonnes of pellets per annum. Additional ore supply which
fed other local pellet plants has also been offline since 1
February 2019, however, it has been reported that this supply will
return in 2Q 2019.
It is likely that the expected return to the market of further
pellet supply from Brazil (which has been offline since 2016 and
amounts to approximately 10 million to 20 million tonnes) will be
delayed, and there may be additional impacts on other projects
(including pellet feed operations) in the country which have
upstream tailings dams.
In the rest of the world, CRU expects a recovery in pellet
output in 2019 from incumbents in Sweden, Canada and Bahrain
(although as Bahrain is a merchant pellet plant, recovery is
dependent on the global availability of pellet feed) as well as
increases in supply from India and Iran. Together these producers
are expected to increase production by approximately 7 million to 9
million tonnes following various production difficulties in 2018.
In addition, a producer in Chile is expected to reduce production
due to ship loader difficulties at its port.
Ferrexpo believes, as a result of the above, that there could be
a reduction of around 5 million to 10 million tonnes of pellet
supply in the export market in 2019.
High Barriers to Entry into the Pellet Market
The pellet market has been a niche sub-sector of the iron ore
market for many years due to its high barriers to entry. Greenfield
pellet supply is constrained by high capital costs (especially when
compared to capital costs to establish sinter fines operations),
ore type and processing technology. Establishing a greenfield
pelletising operation from mine-to-port is estimated to require at
least US$3 billion of investment for approximately 10 million
tonnes, a capital intensity of US$300 per tonne.
Breakeven Cost Curve for Pellet Exporters
Graph 1 shows the breakeven pellet cost curve for delivery to
China. Market concentration is high, with the two largest pellet
suppliers in 2018 (coloured in green and red) holding a market
share of approximately 46%. Ferrexpo is the third largest exporter
and positioned in the bottom half of the cost curve.
The white crosses on the cost curve show the pelletising
operations which have been closed since 20 February 2019 and remain
closed as of 22 April 2019. Their absence will shift the cost curve
to the left. As such, subject to stable demand, pellet premiums
should increase to reflect the use of higher cost supply.
Graph 1: CRU Breakeven Cost Curve for Pellet Producers to China
2018
See graph at this link:
http://www.rns-pdf.londonstockexchange.com/rns/7180W_1-2019-4-23.pdf
* Delivery to China assumes all shipments from all producers go
to the Chinese market, which has a higher pellet premium than other
pellet markets.
y-axis: Business costs for pellet exports, 2018, US$/dmt CFR
China
x-axis: Cumulative pellet exports, 2018, Mt (dry)
Definition: Business costs are the sum of realisation costs and
site costs. Realisation costs include the cost of getting the
material to market, the marketing of the material and the financing
cost of selling the material. The power of business costs is that
by adjusting all product qualities relative to the same benchmark
(62% Fe fines product delivered to North China), it allows all
mines to be compared on a cost curve on a like-for-like basis. This
also means that by subtracting the benchmark price from the
business costs for a mine you get an estimate of cash flow from
that operation.
Conclusion to Market Review
While pellet premiums are largely influenced by steel mill
margins, increasing global focus on reducing air emissions as well
as expected constraints to the supply of pellets from incumbent
producers is likely to provide support for pellet premiums.
Prohibitively high barriers to entry means that significant new
pellet supply entering the market in the short to medium term is
unlikely.
Ferrexpo stands to benefit from operating in a niche market with
high barriers to entry given it is a high quality exporter, with
established operations, a low cost position relative to the
majority of its peers and is well positioned geographically to
supply major import markets.
OPERATIONAL REVIEW
MARKETING
Total sales volumes in 2018 were 10.2 million tonnes (2017: 10.5
million tonnes) with the Group's premium 65% Fe pellet representing
94% of total pellet output during the year (2017: 95%). Sales
volumes were impacted in 2H 2019 by low water levels on the Danube
River and one seaborne shipment falling into 2019.
Table 6 shows that the customer mix remained stable compared to
2017. The top three sales destinations remain Austria, Germany and
Japan.
Table 6: Sales Volume by Market Region
2018 2017
------------------------------------ ------ ------
Central Europe 47% 49%
North East Asia 17% 16%
Western Europe 16.5% 15%
China and South East Asia 13% 12%
Turkey, Middle East, India 6% 8%
North America 0.5% -
------------------------------------ ------ ------
Total sales volume (million tonnes) 10,227 10,467
------------------------------------ ------ ------
The Group has continued to implement its strategy of selling the
vast majority of its production under long-term contracts with
crisis-resistant customers. During 2018, in both Asia and Europe,
several long-term contracts were renewed or extended whilst new
markets continued to be developed towards long-term business in the
future. In this regard, during the year, the Group made its first
trial shipment of DR pellets to North America.
Sales contracts are typically of three years' duration although
the Group has sales contracts of varying tenors up to 14 years. A
small proportion of uncommitted volume is maintained for (1) new
customer development; (2) adjusting for production variations; and
(3) opportunistic spot sales.
The Group's pricing formula for its long-term contracts is based
on a spot index iron ore fines price; in 2018 and in prior years
this was the Platts 62% Fe iron ore fines price, plus a pellet
premium (which is typically negotiated) and an adjustment for the
cost of international freight, typically the C3 index.
For further information on sales see Revenue in the Financial
Review on page 8.
PRODUCTION
Health and Safety
Ferrexpo deeply regrets to report the fatality of Maxim Blinkov,
a contractor at FPM during the year. Mr Blinkov was fatally injured
after falling from a height in the processing plant (2017: one
fatality).
There were a total of 25 lost time injuries ("LTIs") across the
Group in 2018 (2017: 23), equating to an LTI frequency rate
("LTIFR") of 1.18, in line with 2017 (1.17). Table 7 details the
LTIFR as per million man hours worked across the Company's mining
and processing operations in Ukraine and its logistics subsidiary
in Austria for 2018 and 2017.
Table 7: Lost Time Injury Frequency Rate
LTIFR 2018 2017
---------------- ---- ----
- FPM 1.25 1.03
- FYM 0.66 0.74
- FBM 0.00 0.00
Mining entities 1.15 0.98
---------------- ---- ----
Barging 1.83 4.32
---------------- ---- ----
Group 1.18 1.17
---------------- ---- ----
Most of the accidents reported have been traced back to
non-compliance with internal safety procedures. Actions taken
during 2018 have been focused on contractors and employees.
Activities include a focus on significant risk management;
significant incident and near miss reporting; increased training
throughout the year for safety advisers; a focus on improvement in
the quality of accident investigations; a focus on FPM's
maintenance areas to improve workplace conditions and housekeeping;
an increase in external safety audits; increased minimum safety
standards for light vehicles and equipment; the employment of a
safety consultant with significant international experience; and
implementation of a Supervisor Safety Leadership Training
Programme. Lastly, there has been an increase in speed checks,
alcohol testing and operator and maintainer competencies.
Pellet Production
Pellet production increased by 2% in 2018 to 10.6 million
tonnes, compared to 10.4 million tonnes in 2017.
Overall, production levels were impacted by constraints in the
processing and pelletising plants. FPM completed a planned 65-day
pellet line refurbishment in 2Q 2018 and it has now refurbished
three out of its four pellet lines. The final pellet line
refurbishment is expected to take place in 2H 2019.
Graph 2 shows the increases in production and productivity
compared to 2017. The Group is pleased with the reduction in
unplanned downtimes, which should improve further as it continues
with its repair and maintenance programme. Once CEP1 is completed,
which includes de-bottlenecking the concentrator and building a
concentrate stockyard, FPM expects to produce enough pellet feed to
ensure its pelletiser can operate at full capacity of 12 million
tonnes per annum. CEP1 is expected to be completed in 2020.
Graph 2: Pellet Production 2017 vs. 2018
See graph at this link:
http://www.rns-pdf.londonstockexchange.com/rns/7180W_1-2019-4-23.pdf
The Group continues to maintain a high proportion of 65% Fe
pellets within its production mix at 94% of total production
compared with 95% in 2017. Table 8 summarises production in 2018
compared with 2017.
Table 8: Production Statistics
(000't unless otherwise stated) 2018 2017 Change
-------------------------------------------- ------ ------ ---------
Iron ore processed 27,083 27,230 (0,5)%
Average Fe content 33.80% 33.69% 0.11ppt
Concentrate produced ("WMS") 12,750 12,807 (0.4)%
Average Fe content 63.36% 63.12% 0.23ppt
Pellets produced from own ore 10,506 10,394 1.1%
62% Fe pellets 683 559 22.2%
Average Fe content 62.53% 62.58% (0,05)ppt
65% Fe pellets 9,824 9,835 (0.1)%
Average Fe content 64.89% 64.85% 0.04ppt
Pellets produced from purchased concentrate 101 50 102%
Total pellet production 10,607 10,444 1.6%
Total Group stripping volume (million m(3)
) 30,097 33,826 (11)%
-------------------------------------------- ------ ------ ---------
Note: Ferrexpo Basic Pellets ("FBP"), Ferrexpo Premium Pellets
("FPP") and Ferrexpo Premium Pellets plus ("FPP+"). In 2017,
Ferrexpo produced 37,000 tonnes of pellet feed for sale with an
average Fe content of 67.2% (2016: 123,000 tonnes, average Fe
67.5%). In 2018, there was no concentrate for sale.
Mining and Production Efficiencies
The Group has several projects under way which contribute to
cost savings, efficiency improvements and enhanced health and
safety standards. These include efficiency gains in shovel and
dragline dig rates as well as a transition to 100% liquid emulsion
blasting media. The transition to emulsion blasting media has
resulted in increased rock fragmentation. This has improved
excavator and shovel dig rates and reduces equipment wear and tear.
It also yields power savings and reduced maintenance costs in the
crushing plant.
Other efficiency projects include the use of automatic pit
drills, drones for surveys of the pit area and the commencement of
the creation of a centralised mining control hub for all mining
operations. This follows the consolidation of FPM and FYM's
maintenance centre for mobile equipment. The Group is also focused
on improving its fixed plant maintenance processes to ensure they
are best in class and deliver improved process plant
reliability.
Ferrexpo will continue to implement small-scale projects aimed
at improving productivity and efficiency to reduce operating
costs.
CO(2) Emissions
Ferrexpo's carbon intensity ratio fell in 2018 by 3% to 235 kg
of CO2 per tonne of pellets produced, primarily as a result of a 2%
increase in pellet production and a 1% decrease in electricity
consumption, the latter of which accounts for the majority of the
Group's Scope 1 and 2 CO2 emissions. The electricity emissions
factor (estimated by the European Bank for Reconstruction and
Development) relates to the volume of CO2 emitted per MWh of
electricity from the Ukrainian national grid. This decreased by 2%
in 2018, as the country continues to reduce its reliance on older
coal-fired power stations, which further helped reduce the
Company's Scope 2 emissions.
Ferrexpo continues to partially substitute natural gas with
sunflower husks in its pelletising kilns. In 2018, the Company
consumed 124,000 tonnes of husks (2017: 116,000 tonnes), which
maintained the use of sunflower husks at 19% of the total energy in
the Company's pelletiser.
Diesel consumption, which relates to the level of mining
activity, fell by 3% in 2018, despite a 4% increase in the total
rock mined during the year. This improvement is due to productivity
gains from the Group's mining fleet and increased usage of electric
excavators.
Table 9: CO(2) Emissions
Emissions in tonnes (unless otherwise stated) 2018 2017 Change
--------------------------------------------------- --------- --------- ------
Total CO(2) emissions (scope 1, 2 & 3) 2,583,178 2,614,449 (1.2)%
Scope 1 (direct emissions generated by Ferrexpo
from natural gas, diesel, coal, oil, explosives,
etc) 566,877 554,763 2.2%
Scope 2 (indirect emissions purchased by Ferrexpo
from electricity and steam) 1,925,670 1,974,997 (2.5)%
Pellets produced 10,607 10,444 1.6%
Intensity ratio (kilogramme per tonne of pellet
produced) (Scope 1 & 2 only) 235 242 (3.0)%
--------------------------------------------------- --------- --------- ------
Scope 3 (emissions derived from living matter such
as biofuels) 90,631 84,689 7.0%
Tailings Dam
Ferrexpo operates one tailings dam covering an area of 1,500
hectares.
The dam is constructed on flat topography and the method of
construction is the Modified Centreline methodology.
The dam is split into four sections with each section subdivided
into smaller sections of 400 meters by 400 meters. The walls of the
dam and of the sections within the dam are constructed using
engineered fill, including siliceous rock.
Due to this structure, if a breach occurs the leakage is
unlikely to occur from all sections at the same time. This means
that the amount of possible damage should be limited.
The dam has been designed by external consultants Ukrgiproruda,
with biannual inspections by the Ukrainian mining regulator.
Following the tailings dam breach in Brazil in January, Ferrexpo
appointed Knight Piesold, an international independent consultant,
to further review and verify the dam's design, construction and
monitoring.
PRINCIPAL RISKS
The list of the principal risks and uncertainties facing
Ferrexpo's business that are listed below is based on the Board's
current understanding.
Due to the very nature of risk it cannot be expected to be
completely exhaustive. New risks may emerge and the severity or
probability associated with known risks may change over time.
All risks and their mitigations are actively considered monthly
at the Group's Finance and Risk Management Committee meetings based
on detailed analysis.
Ferrexpo operates in the mining industry where there is an
inherent level of risk present due to the nature of its operations.
In addition, the iron ore fines price (which forms a major
component of the Group's received price) is volatile, while the
Group's asset base is located in Ukraine, an emerging market. As
such, Ferrexpo recognises and accepts the risks present in its
business and looks to mitigate them where possible. In general, in
2018, the overall level of risk present was similar to prior years
and movements in individual risks have not varied significantly
compared to 2017. Risks relating to 2019 are discussed below.
The Board of Ferrexpo has ultimate responsibility for the
identification of risks and associated mitigation strategies. The
Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, Chief Operating
Officer and Chief Marketing Officer manage specific risks on a
day-to-day basis related to their functions.
1. Realised Price
The Group's realised price is principally impacted by demand for
iron ore which is highly correlated to global demand for steel and
steel mill profitability. In 2018, global steel mill profitability
increased compared to 2017 levels, especially in the first nine
months of the year. Profitability in the 4Q of the year, however,
was impacted by rising trade tensions and slower economic activity,
especially in China. This resulted in a fall in global steel mill
margins. As of 31 January 2019, steel margins had improved in
China; however, no improvement was seen in Europe as yet.
Despite the above, most market analysts have recently upgraded
their iron ore price expectations for 2019. This follows the
January 2019 tailings dam breach in Brazil and the subsequent
reduction in mining volumes announced by the largest producer in
Brazil (and the world) of an expected 60 million to 70 million
tonnes annualized of current capacity closures as of 18 April 2019.
Most of this tonnage was used to produce high grade iron ore.
In 2018, in line with previous years, the pricing formula used
for long-term contracts in the pellet industry was, in general,
based on the Platts 62% Fe iron ore fines prices, a negotiated
pellet premium (usually agreed annually) and the cost of
international freight (usually referenced to the C3 index) .
In 2019, it appears most pellet exporters, including Ferrexpo,
have agreed with customers to base pellet pricing off the 65% Fe
iron ore fines price rather than the 62% Fe iron ore fines price.
This represents a change in precedent for the industry and allows
producers of 65% Fe pellets, such as Ferrexpo, to directly capture
the price premium for higher grade ore.
Ferrexpo's achieved price can vary significantly from period to
period as it is dependent on the global price for 65% Fe iron ore
fines, pellet premiums and freight (all of which Ferrexpo has
little or no control over as a price taker).
1.1 Lower Iron Ore Prices (external risk)
Root Cause and Impact
A decline in the iron ore fines price will reduce Group revenue,
profitability and cash generation. A reduction in cash generation
could impact the Group's ability to fund maintenance and
development capital investment (A) . Lower levels of maintenance
investment could result in lower production volumes, higher
production costs, reduced cash generation and a weakened balance
sheet.
The 62% Fe iron ore fines price averaged US$69 per tonne in 2018
compared to US$71 per tonne in 2017. Most market analysts have
recently upgraded their expectations for iron ore prices in 2019
based on supply disruptions expected from Brazil. Furthermore, it
is expected that required upstream tailings dam remediation across
the industry will likely last around three years, continuing to
constrain supply.
Currently, a consensus of analyst forecasts for the average
benchmark 62% Fe iron ore fines price in 2019 is approximately
US$71 per tonne(1) and US$64 per tonne in 2020.
(1) Analyst consensus is based on price forecasts from Citi,
Macquarie, Barclays, JPM, Credit Suisse, Deutsche Bank, Goldman
Sachs, CRU, HSBC, Investec and UBS as of 2 April 2019.
Steel demand and steel mill profitability have weakened which,
together with increased scrap usage, could impact overall demand
for iron ore and hence iron ore pricing. A weak demand environment
would support demand for low grade iron ore as steel mills look to
reduce their input costs and, therefore, reduce the premium paid
for high quality ores and pellets.
For further information on iron ore prices and the market
environment see pages 12-16.
Mitigation
Ferrexpo is a low cost producer relative to the majority of its
peers, positioned on the lower half of the pellet cost curve.
Ferrexpo's operating costs are partly correlated with commodity
prices. When the commodities cycle is in a downward phase, and
Ferrexpo typically receives a lower selling price, its cost base in
general also reduces. Furthermore, the Hryvnia is a
commodity-related currency and historically over the long term it
has depreciated during periods of low commodity prices, although
movements of the Hryvnia against the US Dollar can also be
influenced by short-term political factors.
Ferrexpo regularly reviews options to hedge the price of its
output; however, its current strategy is to not enter into hedging
agreements. Ferrexpo has maintained positive profit and cash
generation throughout the iron ore price cycle.
1.2. Pellet Premiums and Pellet Supply (external risk)
Root Cause and Impact
Ferrexpo receives a pellet premium for its product in addition
to the iron ore fines price. Currently, a substantial portion of
its profitability is due to this premium. The average Atlantic
pellet premium from 2011 to 2018 was US$38 per tonne.
Average pellet premiums in 2018 were 30% higher than in 2017 and
traded at a ten-year high. In 2019 it is expected that pellet
premiums will likely be in line with 2018; however, industry
pricing will be based on the 65% Fe iron ore fines price rather
than the 62% Fe iron ore fines price.
As the industry appears to be transitioning the pellet pricing
formula to be based on the 65% Fe iron ore fines price, it is
notable that in 2018, 2017 and 2016 the 65% Fe iron ore fines price
traded at a US$21 per tonne, US$16 per tonne and US$5 per tonne
respective price premium above the 62% Fe iron ore fines price.
Pellet premiums are primarily influenced by steel mill
profitability. CRU expects global steel demand to remain stable in
2019. Pellet premiums may also be influenced by increasing
requirements to reduce air emissions in the steel production
process as well as a supply shortages following the tailings dam
accident in Brazil in January 2019. This is likely to provide
support to pellet premiums in the short to medium term.
Meanwhile, prohibitively high barriers to entry are unlikely to
see significant new pellet supply entering the market in the short
to medium term.
Mitigation
Ferrexpo sells high quality pellets which underpins demand for
its product throughout the commodity cycle. Should the pellet
premium decline, Ferrexpo has one of the lowest pellet conversion
costs in the industry, which should ensure that it is able to
remain a competitive producer.
For further information on pellet premiums and the market
environment see pages 12 to 16.
1.3. Seaborne Freight Rates (external risk)
Root Cause and Impact
As iron ore is a bulk commodity, seaborne freight rates are an
important component of the cost to deliver product to a customer.
An increase in freight rates will reduce the net price received
from a customer while a reduction in freight rates will increase
the net price received from a customer.
Seaborne freight rates, such as C3, are published by the Baltic
Exchange. C3 freight represents the cost for ocean transportation
for iron ore from the Brazilian port of Tubarão (where the largest
seaborne pellet supplier is based) to Qingdao, China (the largest
steel producer in the world).
As Ferrexpo sells to international customers, the price it
receives includes reference to C3 or other appropriate global
benchmarks.
Freight rates are largely influenced by the price of oil and
demand for capesize vessels from competing bulk producers. In 2018,
the average C3 freight rate increased to US$18 per tonne from US$15
per tonne in 2017. In 2019, subject to oil prices, freight rates
may be impacted by lower demand due to reduced iron ore shipments
from Brazil given recent curtailments to production.
As of 1 January 2020, the International Maritime Organization
will enforce a new 0.5% global sulphur cap on fuel content in the
shipping industry from the present 3.5% limit. Subject to supply
and demand dynamics, including steel mill profitability, the
introduction of IMO 2020 could increase freight costs for iron ore
suppliers across the industry and reduce net prices and thus impact
profitability.
Mitigation
Ferrexpo has its own in-house freight and distribution
specialists who procure freight competitively on behalf of the
Group. Ferrexpo's geographic proximity to its European customers is
a competitive advantage compared to other iron ore producers.
2. Operating Risks
2.1. Operating Risks and Hazards incl. Mining, Processing and
Logistics (Company specific risks)
Root Cause and Impact
Ferrexpo operates large-scale mining operations and industrial
process facilities, which pose significant operating challenges and
environmental risks. The Group is exposed to geotechnical
incidents, including high wall failures and tailings dam breaches,
as well as catastrophic processing equipment failure. This could
lead to large-scale fatalities, production-related shortfalls or
shutdowns as well as logistics bottlenecks.
The Group's operations require significant sustaining capital
expenditure and repair and maintenance programmes to ensure safe
operation and availability of equipment. A reduction in sustaining
capital or repairs and maintenance expenditure can result in lower
mining volumes, processing plant breakdowns and pelletiser line
failures.
Production stoppages will increase costs and lower output. It
can also reduce the quality of the product and may lead to late
delivery to customers. Lower volumes, higher costs and financial
penalties due to poor quality and late delivery can impact the
Group's cash generation ability, reducing liquidity levels and
impacting capital investment (A) levels as well as balance sheet
strength. Poor pellet quality or late delivery of product can also
affect the Group's ability to perform according to customer
contracts and its ability to renew contracts in the future.
Mitigation
Since 2014, the Group has refurbished three out of its four
pellet lines. In 2019, the Group will continue to invest in its
repairs and maintenance programme, which will include the final
pellet line shutdown for 75 days in 2H 2019.
In 2018, Ferrexpo spent US$66 million on sustaining capex (2017:
US$79 million) and US$80 million on repairs and maintenance (2017:
US$78 million).
Ferrexpo operates one tailings dam covering an area of 1,500
hectares. The dam is constructed on flat topography and the method
of construction is the Modified Centreline methodology. The dam is
split into four sections with each section subdivided into smaller
sections of 400 meters by 400 meters. The walls of the dam and of
the sections within the dam are constructed using engineered fill,
including siliceous rock. Due to this structure, if a breach occurs
the leakage is unlikely to occur from all sections at the same
time. This means that the amount of possible damage should be
limited. The dam has been designed by external consultants
Ukrgiproruda, with biannual inspections by the Ukrainian mining
regulator. Following the tailings dam breach in Brazil in January
2019, Ferrexpo has appointed an international consultant, to
further review and verify the dam's design, construction and
monitoring.
Ferrexpo has also appointed an international consultant to
review the possibility of high wall pit failures.
Where possible, Ferrexpo owns its own logistics infrastructure.
As of 31 December 2018, this included 2,252 rail cars, which
reduces reliance on state rail cars for transportation of pellets
to border points, 156 barges to transport pellets into Central
Europe, and a 49.5% interest in the port of TIS Ruda on the Black
Sea which guarantees the Group independent access to seaborne
markets, avoiding reliance on the state port.
2.2. Health and Safety Risks (Company specific risk)
Root Cause and Impact
The mining and processing of iron ore is often associated with a
hazardous working environment as it includes the use of explosives
and the operation and repair of heavy machinery, amongst other
things. Failure to provide a safe work environment for the Group's
workforce and failure to ensure an improved and sustained
performance in safety behaviour can impact the Group's social
licence to operate. Fatalities and lost time injuries also result
in production stoppages as well as negatively impacting employee
morale.
During 2018, there was one fatality (2017: one). A total of 25
lost time injuries occurred across the Group during the year
compared to 23 in 2017. The lost time injury frequency rate per
million man hours worked was 1.18 (2017: 1.17).
Mitigation
Most of the accidents reported have been traced back to
non-compliance with internal safety procedures.
Actions taken during 2018 have been largely focused around
contractors and FPM employees. Activities include:
-- A focus on significant risk management;
-- Significant incident and near miss reporting;
-- Increased training throughout the year for safety advisers;
-- Focus on improvement in the quality of accident investigations;
-- Focus on FPM's maintenance areas to improve workplace conditions and housekeeping;
-- Increase in external safety audits;
-- Increased minimum safety standards for light vehicles and equipment;
-- Employment of a safety consultant with significant
international experience and implementation of a Supervisor Safety
Leadership Training Programme;
-- An important focus of safety training is to instil a culture
of accountability. The goal of these workshops is to emphasise and
ensure that all employees understand and appreciate the importance
of strict adherence to safety procedures and that protection of our
employees is paramount; and
-- An increase in speed checks, alcohol testing and operator and maintainer competencies.
Total employee remuneration is partly linked to safety
performance.
2.3. Operating Cost Increases (External and Company risk)
Root Cause and Impact
The production of iron ore pellets is a more capital-intensive
process than other types of iron ore production as it requires the
enrichment of relatively low grade ore into a high grade product.
As such, pellet producers typically have higher operating costs per
tonne of output than producers of iron ore fines or lump.
Approximately 60% of Ferrexpo's C1 cash cost of production (US$
per tonne) (A) is commodity related, including fuel, electricity,
gas, explosives and steel grinding media. In times of relatively
high iron ore prices the cost of production tends to increase due
to commodity cost inflation; however, during periods of low
commodity prices the cash cost is typically reduced. In addition,
over half of the Group's operating costs, including in-land
logistics costs, are incurred in Ukrainian Hryvnia. The Hryvnia is
a commodity-related currency and historically over the long term it
has depreciated during periods of low commodity prices, although
movements of the Ukrainian Hryvnia against the US Dollar can also
be influenced by short-term political factors.
As such, the Group's cost of production is sensitive to local
inflation, exchange rate fluctuations between the Hryvnia and the
US Dollar and US Dollar commodity cost inflation.
In the higher pellet premium environment the Group has taken the
opportunity to increase its repair and maintenance activities to
further improve equipment reliability and performance; this has
continued into 2019 and likely to continue into 2020. The Group is
also increasing its mining activity at FPM to access higher grade
ore.
In 2018, the Group's C1 cash cost of production (A) increased
from US$32.3 per tonne to US$43.3 per tonne. See pages 8 and 9 for
a description of the factors impacting operating costs.
Mitigation
Ferrexpo sits in the bottom half of the pellet cost curve. Many
of its costs which relate to commodity prices will impact its peers
to a similar extent. As such in times of higher commodity prices,
the Group should be able to maintain its cost competitiveness
relative to its competitors.
Ferrexpo looks to increase production volumes to ensure fixed
cost dilution and enable the Group to offset (to some extent)
external cost inflation. The Group has a Business Improvement
Programme aimed at increasing efficiencies and reducing costs by 1%
to 2% per annum.
Ferrexpo has established several sources of suppliers for key
products as well as several supply routes.
3. Country
3.1. Ukraine Country Risk (External risk)
Root Cause and Impact
Ukraine has been an independent country since 1991. During this
time the country has witnessed four changes in government and two
revolutions in 2004 and in 2014. It has also been subjected to the
annexation of Crimea, and there is an ongoing conflict in Eastern
Ukraine with over 12,000 deaths of Ukrainian nationals. The general
political instability has negative social and economic consequences
and is capable of damaging Ferrexpo's ability to operate without
disruption in Ukraine. As of 21 April 2019, a new president of
Ukraine was elected and parliamentary elections will be held in
October 2019.
Economic weakness can reduce the government's ability to fund
social services, leading to tensions within local communities. It
can also impact the government's ability to meet payment
obligations to exporters (such as VAT refunds) and/or lead to
higher taxes (including increased royalty payments). Services
provided by state monopolies such as the supply of electricity, gas
and freight transportation can also be disrupted in this
environment. This can affect Ferrexpo's ability to export product
reliably.
The Group holds mining licences and other permits required to
carry out mining operations. If mining licences were to be revoked
or not renewed, Ferrexpo's ability to continue to produce pellets
would be at risk.
Macro and political events in Ukraine can constrain Ferrexpo's
ability to raise finance. It can also reduce availability of high
skilled labour as emigration levels rise.
In December 2018, Moody's upgraded Ukraine's sovereign credit
rating to Caa1 with a stable outlook. Moody's stated Ukraine's
credit profile balanced the country's meaningful progress on
reforms, a gradually improving external liquidity position,
increasing resilience to geopolitical shocks and a moderating debt
burden against a still weak rule of law, pervasive corruption,
sporadic access to capital markets, and a short-term risk of a
disorderly political transition.
Transparency International ranks Ukraine as 120th out of 180
countries in terms of the level of perceived corruption (with 180th
being regarded as the most corrupt). This is the third year of
improvement in Ukraine's ranking. There is a risk, however, that
counterparties are involved in activities that are not in
compliance with relevant international standards. Further, a weak
judicial system can be susceptible to outside influences and can
take an extended period of time for courts to reach final
judgement.
Mitigation
Ferrexpo operates in accordance with relevant laws and utilises
internal and external legal advisers as required to monitor and
adapt to legislative changes.
In August 2018, Ferrexpo increased its 2017 Pre-Export Finance
("PXF") credit facility from US$195 million to US$400 million and
extended the tenor from three to four years.
Ferrexpo prioritises sufficient total liquidity (A) levels and
strong credit metrics to ensure smooth operations should
geopolitical or economic weakness disrupt the financial system of
the country.
Ferrexpo prioritises a strong internal control framework
including high standards of compliance and ethics. It operates a
centralised compliance structure supported and resourced locally at
the Group's operations. Ferrexpo has implemented policies and
procedures throughout the Group including training.
Ferrexpo looks to maintain a talented workforce through skills
training and by offering competitive wages, taking into account
depreciation of the Hryvnia against the US Dollar and local
inflation levels.
Ferrexpo is an important economic contributor to Ukraine and it
is integrated into the local and national economy.
3.2. Counter Party Risk (External risk)
Independent Review of Charitable Donations to Blooming Land
Root Cause and Impact
Ukraine is a frontier emerging market that has undergone
significant upheaval since the Euromaidan revolution in November
2013. This was followed by the annexation of Crimea by Russia in
2014 and the start of armed conflict in Eastern Ukraine, where over
12,000 Ukrainian nationals have died to date. During this period,
the country went through a severe economic recession with real GDP
declining 6.6% and 9.8% in 2014 and 2015 respectively. This was
followed by a major banking crisis with over 85 banks declared
insolvent by the National Bank of Ukraine while the local currency
devalued 67% against the US Dollar from 1 January 2014 to 31
December 2015.
Ferrexpo's Corporate Social Responsibility ("CSR") programme in
Ukraine was formally established in 2009 and focused on the areas
surrounding the mines.
In 2013, given the severe upheaval in the country and to support
its general social license to operate, the Group established a CSR
programme on a national basis. A charity called Blooming Land which
operates through three sub-funds (the "Charity") was used for this
programme.
The Charity's activities included diabetes prevention, eyesight
care and support for the elderly, including by hosting events
subcontracted out to event managers. The interim conclusion is that
Charity operated independently of Ferrexpo and it is not a related
party of the Chief Executive Officer or of the Group's executive
management.
For the year ended 31 December 2018, the Group made charitable
contributions of US$9.5 million to Blooming Land (2017: US$24.0
million). Donations to the Charity ceased in May 2018. Donations to
the Charity ceased in May 2018. From 2013 until May 2018, when
donations were ceased, the Group made total contributions to the
Charity of approximately US$110 million.
As with any CSR programme, there is a risk that funds donated
could be misapplied, including through misappropriation. Depending
on the nature of any such misappropriation or misapplication, there
is a risk that the Group's financial statements might not fairly
reflect the nature of the expenditures made to the Charity and may
fail to make provision for fines, penalties or other liabilities.
There is also a risk that related party transactions within the
Charity are not disclosed to the Group. Due to uncertainty
surrounding the status of the donations, further considerations are
presented in Note 29 Contingencies on page 149.
The Board developed controls to cover donations to the Charity
as set out in the 2017 full year accounts and continued to develop
these controls prior to the Group ceasing donations in May 2018.
During 2019 (see Note 34 Events after the reporting period on page
156) the IRC was formed and the circumstances leading up to its
establishment are described in the IRC Report on page 46.
For further information see Chairman's Statement (page 6), Note
7 (page 106), Note 29 (page 149), Note 33 (page 156) and Note 34
(page 156) to the financial statements.
Mitigation
The Board has closely monitored the relationship between the
Charity and the Group, and overseen the involvement of the Chief
Executive Officer who, in his role, was the main communication
between the Board and the Charity.
Enquiries were made over several years by the Group as part of
its relationship with the Charity. The Group implemented a number
of key controls to manage its relationship and expenditures which
have been improved and developed in particular throughout 2016,
2017 and 2018.
Throughout the relationship with the Charity, various other
steps have been taken, including a review by the Audit Committee
covering the operation of the sub-funds in 2015 and site
visits.
As part of the Group's procedures and outside the internal
control framework an additional external review was carried out in
May 2018 as to the relevance and reliability of the independent
audited accounts of the Charity received by the Board for the year
end 2017.
An Independent Review has been established by the Board to look
into, amongst other things, whether Blooming Land's use of
Ferrexpo's contributions was for the stated purpose. The review is
ongoing.
4. Tax
4.1 Tax (External risk)
Root Cause and Impact
Ferrexpo is a large taxpayer in Ukraine and also pays tax
internationally. The growing complexity of tax legislation around
the world can result in unforeseen tax payments. Ferrexpo is
subject to transfer pricing regulations both locally and
internationally. The Base Erosion and Profit Shifting ("BEPS")
project initiated by the G20 and OECD is likely to increase
scrutiny of cross-border tax transactions and may result in
challenges from different jurisdictions.
Legislation and regulations are not always clearly written and
are subject to varying interpretations and inconsistent enforcement
by local, regional and national Ukrainian tax authorities, and
other governmental bodies. The uncertainty of application and the
evolution of Ukrainian tax laws, including those affecting
cross-border transactions, could result in additional tax payments
having to be made by the Group which would reduce cash flows and
impact total liquidity (A) levels.
Mitigation
Ferrexpo conducts transparent and open dialogue with local,
regional and national tax authorities. Its tax strategy is in line
with best international standards and it is in compliance with all
known requirements. The Group regularly takes advice on tax matters
from Ukrainian and international tax experts.
For further information see Note 8 of the financial
statements.
5. Capital Allocation
Ferrexpo aims to maintain prudent leverage metrics with net debt
to underlying EBITDA as of 31 December 2018 at 0.67 times. The
Group's priority since 2015 has been to deleverage and it has
repaid over US$500 million of gross debt since 1 January 2016. As
such, the Board feels it is appropriate to readjust the use of
available free cash flows from primarily deleveraging to include a
more balanced focus on dividends and investment opportunities
whilst ensuring its credit metrics remain strong.
5.1. Investment Opportunities (Company risk)
Root Cause and Impact
Ferrexpo evaluates and, if appropriate, enters into high net
present value opportunities which it believes are potentially value
accretive to the Group and can reduce future operating risk. There
is a risk that Ferrexpo may make acquisitions or investments, which
may not be accretive to earnings or otherwise meet its operational
or strategic expectations. In addition, such an investment or
acquisition may divert management's attention away from ongoing
business activities.
Mitigation
Management has procedures in place to ensure any potential
investment opportunity undergoes thorough due diligence and meets
strict financial criteria. There is a Group Investment Committee
which analyses hurdle return rates to ensure risk is appropriately
mitigated both on project execution and in terms of the internal
rates of return. All investment decisions are approved by the
Board.
Viability statement
The Board monitors the Group's risk management and internal
control systems on an ongoing basis, and confirms that during the
year it carried out a thorough assessment of the principal risks
facing the Group, their potential impact and the mitigating
strategies in place, as described on pages 19 to 27.
The principal risks include those that would threaten the
Group's business model, future performance, liquidity or
solvency.
Time Horizon
The Board has reviewed the long-term prospects of the business,
which remain aligned with Ferrexpo's life of mine assumptions.
For the purposes of assessing the Group's viability in the
medium term, the Directors have chosen a five-year time period
given the long-life nature of mining assets, including the period
required to invest in such assets and taking into account the cash
flows generated by those assets, as well as the cyclical nature of
the commodities industry. As such, a five-year time period was
considered an appropriate length for the Board's strategic planning
period.
Stress Testing
In determining the viability of the business, the Directors have
stress tested the individual risks and combination of risks that
could materially impact the future viability of the business.
The Group is primarily exposed to changes in global iron ore
prices (the 65% Fe iron ore fines CFR China price and the pellet
premium) and cost inflation. Based on 2019 expected production
volumes of approximately 10.6 million tonnes, a US$5 per tonne fall
in the Group's received price would, if not mitigated, reduce the
Group's underlying EBITDA by US$5.3 per tonne. While a general
production cost increase of 10% would decrease Group underlying
EBITDA by US$4.8 per tonne and a 5% decrease in production volumes
would decrease underlying EBITDA by US$2.6 per tonne.
Other stress test scenarios included operational incidents that
have a significant impact on production volumes, a deterioration in
the Group's long-term cost position on the industry cost curve or
other operating constraints due to Ukrainian country risk.
The scenario analysis includes severe situations outside the
normal course of business, such as a breakdown in the linkage
between the movements of the iron ore price with other commodity
prices, notably the oil price which forms a significant component
of the Group's cost base or an appreciation of the Ukrainian
Hryvnia when the iron ore price is weak.
Mitigating actions include a reduction or cancellation of
discretionary expenditure such as capital investment, repairs and
maintenance, dividends or other operating costs, adjusting capital
allocation, reducing working capital requirements, altering mining
schedules and accessing additional funding.
The Directors take comfort in the Group's historical cash
generation ability, particularly in 2015 and 2016 at a time when
the iron ore price was trading at a cyclical low. Since 1 January
2016, the Group has reduced its net financial indebtedness by over
US$500 million and it currently has a strong financial profile.
Viability Statement
Based on the results of this analysis, the Directors have a
reasonable expectation that the Group will be able to continue to
operate and meet its liabilities as they fall due over the
five-year period of this assessment.
Prospects
The Directors, having assessed the principal risks related to
the Group's business model, believe the long-term prospects of the
Group remain sound. Principally this is due to Ferrexpo's
competitive cost position on the iron ore cost curve, its high
quality product that commands a price premium in a niche market
with high barriers to entry, a first class customer portfolio, a
well invested asset base and favourable industry dynamics
supporting pellet consumption.
Responsible business
Ferrexpo's policy towards Responsible Business covers its
efforts in Environmental, Social and Governance ("ESG") matters.
High ESG standards underpin a sustainable business that benefits
all stakeholders of the Group.
Through community engagement, environmental monitoring,
compliance training and health and safety improvements, Ferrexpo
aims to sustain a long-term future that not only develops its
natural resources for its own benefit, but also for the shared
benefit of those around us - employees and their families, local
communities and businesses, the natural environment around the
Company's mines, and tax revenues to national governments. Ferrexpo
has once again been recognised in the Ukrainian government's
published list of 'Top Taxpayers' and through its 40 years of
continuous operation the Group has been able to maintain a constant
presence in Central Ukraine, providing employment as the largest
company in the Poltava Region.
During the year, the Group maintained a focus on product quality
and increasing its output as well as enhancing its operating
processes. It also focused on softer processes such as health and
safety initiatives and compliance training, through which the
Company continues to sustain its social licence to operate.
I would like to thank all of the Company's employees,
contractors and other stakeholders for their collective efforts to
ensure our progress in ESG reporting.
Yuriy Khimich, Chairman, Corporate Social Responsibility
Committee
Governance and Management Framework
A key priority during the year was the development of a
reporting system for corporate responsibility performance data. As
a result, reporting became centralised and data has been collected
through the Group's accounting system.
The CSR Committee, which is accountable for most of the areas
covered by the Responsible Business Report, met four times in 2018,
and assists the Board in its oversight of responsible
business-related activities.
In 2018, the UK Corporate Governance Code was revised. One of
the new provisions of the Code is to enable greater board
engagement with the workforce to understand their views. As such,
Ferrexpo's Board has agreed to develop an Employee Listening
Programme which will be overseen by the CSR Committee going
forward.
The following diagrams highlight the CSR governance structure at
Ferrexpo and a framework of how responsible business considerations
(in green) are fully embedded within the corporate strategy.
Governance Structure
the Board
Oversight of responsible business matters and performance
Chairman - Yuriy Khimich Members - Steve Lucas, Kostyantin Zhevago, Bert
Nacken, Greg Nortje, Viktor Lotous
Executive committee
Focus on priorities and execution of responsible business activities
Health & safety Community Workforce Environment & sustainable
resources
---------------------------- --------------- ------------------------------------------
STRATEGIC RELATIONSHIPS - LICENCE TO OPERATE
Employees Communities Suppliers Customers Capital providers Government
and contractors and shareholders and regulators
-------------- -------------- ------------- -------------------- ----------------------
1 Yuriy Khimich - FBM General Director; Steve Lucas - Ferrexpo
plc Non-executive Chairman; Bert Nacken - independent Non-executive
Director; Greg Nortje - Chief Human Resources Officer; Kostyantin
Zhevago - CEO; Viktor Lotous - FPM Chief Operating Officer and Head
of Managing Board; The Group's Chief Operating Officer, Jim North,
though not a member of the CSR Committee, was present at all
Committee meetings during the year.
Non-Financial Information Statement
We aim to comply with the new Non-Financial Reporting
requirements contained in sections 414CA and 414CB of the Companies
Act 2006. The below table, and information it refers to, is
intended to help stakeholders understand our position on key
non-financial matters. This builds on existing reporting that we
already do under the following frameworks: CDP, Global Reporting
Initiative, Guidance on the Strategic Report (UK Financial
Reporting Council), UN Global Compact, UN Sustainable Development
Goals and UN Guiding Principles.
reporting
requirements policies and standards Additional information
--------------- ----------------------------------------------------------- ------------------------------ -------------
environmental Environment pages 33-35 Environmental
* Environmental statement www.ferrexpo.com/responsibilit risk
y/environment management
pages 19-27
--------------- ----------------------------------------------------------- ------------------------------ -------------
employees Equality, inclusion & Board
* Ethics and Responsible Business Policy diversity pages 32-33 Diversity
Health, safety & wellbeing Policy page
pages 32-33 55
* Code of Responsibility Learning & development People risk
pages 32-33 pages 19-27
Responsible conduct & Governance
* Health and Safety Policy culture pages 35-37 risk pages
Diversity, skills & 19-27
composition
www.ferrexpo.com/responsibility/people pages 32-33
--------------- ----------------------------------------------------------- ------------------------------ -------------
human rights Equality, inclusion &
* Human Rights Policy statement diversity pages 32-33
Health, safety & wellbeing
pages 32-33
* Data Privacy Policy Learning & development,
pages 32-33
Responsible conduct &
* Anti-Slavery and Trafficking Statement culture pages 35-37
Diversity, skills &
composition
* Information and Cyber Security Policy page 32-33
--------------- ----------------------------------------------------------- ------------------------------ -------------
social matters Independent Review Committee Community
* Donations Policy pages 46-47 and page 148 risk
pages 19-27
(see 3.1 and
* Helping communities 3.2)
www.ferrexpo.com/responsibility/community
--------------- ----------------------------------------------------------- ------------------------------ -------------
anti-corruption Customer privacy & data
and * Anti-bribery Policy security pages 35-37
anti-bribery Responsible conduct &
culture pages 35-37
* Anti-money Laundering and Counter Terrorist Financing Operational risk pages
Policy 19-27
www.ferrexpo.com/responsibilit
y/governance
* Fraud Risk Management Policy
--------------- ----------------------------------------------------------- ------------------------------ -------------
Principal Risk Management pages
risks and 19-27
impact on
business
activities
--------------- ----------------------------------------------------------- ------------------------------ -------------
Non-financial
kpi * Key Performance Indicators
--------------- ----------------------------------------------------------- ------------------------------ -------------
Engaging Our Stakeholders
Assessing key issues
Where issues are considered to be material to Ferrexpo
stakeholders, they are included in the Group's priorities and
managed as part of the responsible business strategy. The diagram
opposite details the key issues:
Key to materiality matrix
-- People
-- Economic indicators
-- Community
-- Environment
INCREASING CONCERN TO STAKEHOLDERS
* Occupational health * Employment and turnover * Health and safety performance
* Contracts and collective bargaining * Financial performance
* Direct value generated
* Learning and development of personnel * Energy usage * Community recreational facilities
* Diversity * Greenhouse gases and climate change * Sustainable usage of resources and Business
Improvement Plan
* Resettlement and closure plans
* Responsible purchasing
------------------------------------------ --------------------------------------------------
* Emissions * Community projects
* Water management * Code of conduct
* Waste generation
------------------------------------------ --------------------------------------------------
INCREASING CURRENT OR POTENTIAL IMPACT ON FERREXPO
Our Approach to Being a Responsible Business
Operational Our responsible approach Our
Level stakeholders
logistics people Economic indicators government
workforce * Safety and business ethics investors
marketing * Financial performance suppliers
processing workforce
resource * Occupational health communities
base * Local investment (including purchasing) and customers
recruitment
mining * Diversity capital
providers
* Direct value generated
* Local hiring
* Code of conduct
* Training and development
* Responsible purchasing
* Employment and turnover
* Contracts and collective bargaining
------------ ----------------------------------------------- ------------------------------------------------- -----------------
community environment
* Community support donations * Energy
* Government relations * Water
* Resettlement and closure plans * Greenhouse gases
* Other air emissions
* Land use and rehabilitation
------------ ----------------------------------------------- ------------------------------------------------- -----------------
PEOPLE
Ferrexpo is a major employer in the Poltava Region and the
Company's workforce represents a large proportion of the population
of the local town of Horishni Plavni. Ferrexpo's success is
therefore closely linked to the relationship it has with its
workforce and it is important that the Company develops its
workforce to achieve this goal.
The Ferrexpo team comprises 9,170 people globally, with the
majority of this workforce located at our iron ore mines in
Ukraine. As a business we aim to recruit and retain a talented
workforce, to create a stable and consistent environment across our
operations, as evidenced through the length of service for
employees at the Company's operating assets in Ukraine - 58% of the
workforce at FPM and 40% at FYM have worked with Ferrexpo for at
least five years, representing increases on last year from 55% and
32% respectively. Ferrexpo aims to provide its employees with a
fair and inclusive environment to work in, and to promote diversity
where possible.
Safety and Wellbeing
It is with regret that the Company reports that a fatality
occurred at its Ukrainian operations in October 2018, whereby a
contractor engaged in maintenance work on the Company's pelletiser
plant was involved in a fall from height incident. A thorough
investigation into this incident has resulted in stricter
guidelines for the maintenance of raised walkways, in addition to
greater oversight of contractor safety by Ferrexpo's onsite
management team.
An important focus for the Company was on safety throughout
2018, in an effort to improve safety statistics from the prior
year. Two notable achievements were recognised in Ferrexpo's safety
record in 2018 - FYM managed to operate without a lost time injury
("LTI") for 10 months of the year, and the Company's barging
subsidiary on the Danube River, DDSG, registered a 50% reduction in
the number of LTIs compared to previous years.
The Company's main operating entity, FPM however, noted a
year-on-year deterioration in its lost time injury frequency rate
("LTIFR") from 1.03 to 1.28, due to an increase in employees
involved in LTIs from 11 to 17. An analysis of these incidents has
identified that road traffic accidents and interactions with
heavy-lifting equipment as key areas for improvement, with a number
of process improvements identified, such as an increase in the
frequency of inspections of the condition of all slings and other
heavy-lifting equipment. Furthermore, from January 2019, all
vehicles at Ferrexpo's operations will be required to have safety
belts fitted, which was not previously required under Ukrainian
legislation.
Safety-related activities in 2018 focused on improved reporting
procedures, such as ensuring that initial incident reports are
available within 24 hours in order to identify risks quickly, and
Serious Incident Reports ("SIRs") also now include potential
serious incidents in order to capture as many risk areas as
possible in the Company's risk registers. This improved reporting
and risk identification can be seen in the increase in SIRs to 25
in 2018 (from ten), with deliverable action points from each
report.
For a comparison of safety performance - Safe Work Australia, an
Australian government agency, states that the industry standard for
mining of metal ores in Australia is a LTIFR of 4.0. Ferrexpo
therefore continues to maintain an injury rate below this
benchmark.
Through improved risk identification processes and reporting,
the Company also registered a 30% decrease in the severity rate of
incidents in 2018, an important lead indicator for progress
in safety.
Drug and Alcohol Testing
Ferrexpo operates in a region where drug and alcohol addiction
is a serious social concern, and the Company maintains a strict
zero-tolerance policy on the use of alcohol and recreational drugs
in the workplace, with regular testing for employees, mandatory
checks for new applicants and on-the-spot testing for anyone
suspected of being under the influence during work hours. During
2018, a total of 3,889 checks were undertaken (2017: 3,731), with a
failure rate of 4% in 2018 - down one third on the prior year. For
employees considered eligible, the Company operates a
rehabilitation programme to help those affected by alcohol and drug
addiction, which follows internationally recognised frameworks for
recovery, such as Alcoholics Anonymous and the 12 Steps Programme.
As at the end of 2018, a total of 66 individuals classified as
being 'at-risk' were being treated under this initiative (2017: 64
individuals).
Training
Over 11,500 training courses were completed by employees in
2018, the equivalent of 1.28 courses per employee, up 20% from
2017. The number of safety training courses undertaken rose by 17%
to 4,433, as well as a significant increase in functional training
(+146% to 4,943). The number of training hours per employee also
rose by 26% to 27 hours in 2018.
The above increase in functional training is the result of
several new training initiatives implemented, including
environmental management (132 employees), and cross-functional
training for employees to operate multiple pieces of mobile
equipment such as excavators and light vehicles (385 people).
In line with the Company's focus on safety in 2018, new training
courses were provided in first aid for 940 employees in the
processing plant, risk identification and risk management (129
employees), as well as emergency medical assistance (71
employees).
Ferrexpo also provides training for contractors working at its
operations, with 775 contractors trained in safety and other skills
(2017: 1,143).
Diversity
Ferrexpo monitors diversity in its workforce, to help develop a
balanced and positive working environment. Women represent 29% of
the Company's workforce (2017: 29%), with the percentage of female
managers declining slightly in 2018 following a grading project by
the Company's HR function to grade all positions across the Group
and reclassify management roles according to a specific grade.
Female managers represented 18% of total managers in 2018 (2017:
20%). The Company has a number of ongoing initiatives to further
the careers of women at Ferrexpo, details of which will be
available in the Company's Responsible Business Report, which will
be published later this year. In another area of diversity, 4% of
the Company's workforce are registered disabled, in line with a
government requirement in Ukraine.
KPIs
GOAL PERFORMANCE
------------------------- --------------------------------------
To operate fatality One fatality in 2018 (2017: 1)
free
------------------------- --------------------------------------
Maintain injury frequency LTIFR maintained at same level as 2017
rate below peers (1.18), compared to industry standard
of 4.0.
(1) For more information on LTIFR statistics see:
https://www.safeworkaustralia.gov.au/statistics-and-research/lost-time-injury-frequency-rates-ltifr
CASE STUDY
Lock-Out Tag-Out Systems
In an initiative to modernise and improve conditions for plant
maintainers in its processing facilities, Ferrexpo is implementing
the Lock-Out Tag-Out ("LOTO") system whereby maintainers can
physically lock equipment in the off position whilst it is being
repaired.
Control panels are also being moved to be located adjacent to
equipment they control, in an effort to improve lines of sight for
operators to see if equipment is being worked on. A major focus in
2019 will be to improve workers' visibility by replacing darker
coloured Personal Protective Equipment ("PPE") with lighter,
brighter versions of the same clothing.
For more information on Ferrexpo's approach to its workforce,
please see the Company's Responsible Business Reports on the
Company's website (www.ferrexpo.com).
ENVIRONMENT
Ferrexpo operations have a bearing on a wide range of
environmental factors - air quality, water quality, land use and
rehabilitation, and biodiversity, with the Company committed to
monitoring each area and managing its footprint.
Carbon Dioxide Emissions
Carbon dioxide (CO2) emissions from Ferrexpo's operations in
Ukraine principally revolve around the consumption of three key
consumables - the diesel that powers the Group's mining fleet in
its mines, the electricity that drives the Group's processing
plant, and the natural gas that heats the Company's pellets in its
pelletiser. These three consumables accounted for 92% of Group CO2
emissions in 2018 (2017: 92%). Additional sources of CO2 from the
Company's activities are consumed in the Company's barging
subsidiary DDSG, which transports pellets to customers along the
Danube River, as well as steam that is used for heating and is
purchased from the local supplier.
Consumption of natural gas increased in 2018 as the Company
increased the kiln temperatures in its pelletiser as part of a
planned programme to increase pellet quality. Diesel consumption
throughout the Group decreased by 3%, despite rock mining tonnes
increasing by 4% during the year. This decrease in diesel usage
relates to improved mining productivity and utilising a greater
number of electric shovels at FPM, which represents over 80% of the
Group's rock mining activities. Electricity is provided by the
Ukrainian national grid, which continues to be modernised, with
reduced reliance on older coal-fired power stations, meaning that
the estimated carbon factor for electricity generated fell by 2% in
2018. Furthermore, total electricity consumption fell by 1% in
2018, meaning that electricity was the single largest contributor
towards total Group CO2 production falling in 2018.
Other Emissions
Ferrexpo closely monitors emissions at its operations in
Ukraine, divided into two categories: stationary sources
(processing and pelletising plants, tailings facilities, and waste
dumps) and mobile sources (mining equipment and other sources).
Emissions from stationary sources in 2018 were as follows:
-- NO2 emissions rose by 21% to 3,493 tonnes as the Company
increased kiln temperatures in 2018 to improve pellet quality,
resulting in increased natural gas and sunflower husk
consumption.
-- SO2 emissions rose by 41% to 1,894 tonnes after a trial to
add lime to the ore as it is processed was halted, when it was
discovered that the lime was causing excessive wear to the
processing plant.
-- Solid emissions fell by 8% in 2018 to 3,619 tonnes after the
successful rehabilitation of waste dumps at FYM resulted in a
reduction of dust emissions.
Emissions from mobile sources fell by 2% for the majority of
gases, the result of a 2% to 4% decrease at FPM and a 1% to 2%
increase at FYM.
Waste and Tailings Production
Ferrexpo operates its own tailings facility at its mining
operations in Ukraine that has been in operation since 1974, and
covers an area of over 1,500 hectares. The Company produced 9.7
million tonnes of tailings representing an 8% decrease on 2017. The
tailings storage facility is a single dam facility, split into four
sections, with each section comprising multiple smaller cells
measuring 400m by 400m. The walls of the tailings facility are
constructed using engineered fill, including siliceous waste from
the mine, which has the required strength characteristics for use
in such facilities. The dam has been designed by external
consultant Ukrgiproruda, with biannual inspections by external
consultants. Ferrexpo's tailings facility differs in its design
from the valley fill type of facility often utilised by iron ore
mines in Brazil.
Overburden removal increased by 4% to 88 million tonnes as the
Company increased its focus on the Poltava mine to further improve
pellet quality. Overburden is transported by haul truck to waste
dumps that are designed by the Company's mine planning department,
with designs approved by Ukrgiproruda.
Energy Consumption
Ferrexpo's mining and barging operations consumed 18.084 PJ of
energy in 2018, a 1% increase on 2017, which corresponds to the
equivalent of 604 MJ per tonne of pellets created (+4% vs.
2017).
Overall energy consumption increased as the Company increased
the kiln temperature in its pelletiser in order to improve pellet
quality. Sunflower husks continue to represent 19% of the
pelletiser's energy mix.
Water Consumption and Treatment
The majority of Ferrexpo's water extraction relates to
groundwater inflows and rainfall into its open pit mining
operations in Ukraine, which directly relates to the level of
precipitation incurred each year. Total water extraction rose by 5%
in 2018 to 33.8 million cubic metres, with this increase related to
the 50% increase in rainfall noted at the mine in 2018 (619mm). The
majority (59%) of water extracted is immediately discharged as part
of the Company's dewatering operations. FPM continues to reuse the
majority of water it extracts (92%), which represents 38% of Group
water extraction.
Ferrexpo closely monitors water quality at both its mining
operations across a suite of 13 chemical indicators, and can
confirm that it remained within the strict quality control limits
set by the Ukrainian authorities throughout the year.
(All figures tonnes
unless otherwise stated) 2018 2017 % change
-------------------------- --------- --------- --------
Group CO2 emissions 2,583,178 2,614,449 -1%
-------------------------- --------- --------- --------
Scope 1 (direct) 566,877 554,763 +2%
-------------------------- --------- --------- --------
Scope 2 (indirect) 1,925,670 1,974,997 -2%
-------------------------- --------- --------- --------
Scope 3 (biofuels) 90,631 84,689 +7%
-------------------------- --------- --------- --------
Pellets produced (million
tonnes) 10.607 10.444 +2%
-------------------------- --------- --------- --------
Intensity ratio (Scope
1 and 2 only) 235 242 -3%
-------------------------- --------- --------- --------
KPIs
GOAL PERFORMANCE
----------------------- -------------------------------------------------
Reduce carbon footprint Direct CO2 emissions rose 2% but total Scope
1 and 2 emissions per tonne of pellets decreased
by 3%
----------------------- -------------------------------------------------
Increase percentage Sunflower husks continue to represent 19% of
of renewable energy energy mix in pelletiser, in line
usage in fuel mix with 2017
For more information on Ferrexpo's environmental initiatives,
please see the Company's Responsible Business Reports on the
Company's website (www.ferrexpo.com).
economic indicators and ethical business
Ferrexpo operates in a business environment that increasingly
requires higher standards from leadership teams, and this is
achieved through continuous improvements in compliance regulations
and compliance training. Through good corporate governance, the
Company can foster a strong bond with its stakeholders.
Direct Economic Value Generated
The Company generated revenues of US$1,300 million in 2018, and
from which generated value for the national governments through
taxes and royalties paid of US$73 million, in addition to support
at the local level through US$86 million in wages and salaries, and
doing business with local suppliers that operate in the communities
located close to the mine.
Ferrexpo aims to do business with local companies in Ukraine
where possible, to help support communities and develop the local
economy through indirect jobs and the local multiplier effect.
Examples of Ukrainian businesses that Ferrexpo has long-standing
relationships with include local drilling contractors, the railway
car manufacturing plant in Kremenchuk and the local clothing
garment manufacturers in the town of Horishni Plavni.
Tax Compliance
Ferrexpo complies with the tax laws in each jurisdiction that it
operates, in contributing to a number of economies globally. Every
year the Company publishes a report on taxes paid to governments,
with each report published in the first half of the year, the most
recent being the report for 2017 that was published on 27 June
2018. The report for 2018 will be published in Q2 2019, in line
with previous years.
Ethical Business
Ferrexpo's success depends on building trust and strong
relationships with internal and external stakeholders by conducting
business in a fair, transparent, legally compliant and ethical
manner. High ethical standards apply to everyone across the Group
without exceptions. It is important that Ferrexpo's business
partners and stakeholders can rely on the Company's integrity and
have confidence in their relationship with Ferrexpo.
Ferrexpo's compliance programme has been designed to promote
ethical standards and compliance. It is aligned with Ferrexpo's
strategy and business objectives and clearly articulates and
assigns responsibility for compliance outcomes. Ferrexpo directs
its compliance efforts and resources in accordance with the risks
that the Company faces, which are reviewed and prioritised through
a biannual risk assessment process. The presence and effectiveness
of existing controls are verified by an independent internal audit
function, which reports to the Board of Directors.
The Board of Directors oversees the Group's Compliance Programme
directly and through its Committees, receives regular compliance
reports. The elements of the compliance programme, including
Ferrexpo's Code of Conduct and training, apply equally to the Board
as well as to all Ferrexpo employees. In 2014, the Executive
Compliance Committee was founded and meets regularly to oversee the
compliance of the Group with applicable laws, regulations and
ethical standards in relation to Ferrexpo's employees, neighbours,
the environment and other stakeholders. In 2018, a Local Compliance
Committee established to foster the culture of compliance at the
Company's operations in Ukraine.
Ferrexpo has an independent compliance function led by the Group
Compliance Officer including four local compliance officers in
Ukraine and one at the Group's logistics subsidiary. Compliance
teams regularly attend national and international compliance
conferences to keep up to date with best practice in this field.
The Group Compliance Officer establishes, reviews and monitors the
Group's compliance programme.
The Company has instituted a Code of Conduct available publicly
at Ferrexpo's website, which sets out the Company's requirements in
relation to a number of areas such as Anti-bribery &
Anti-corruption, Conflicts of Interest, Health & Safety and
Human Rights. Ferrexpo's policies and procedures, developed and
implemented across the Group, are based on the foundation of the
Code of Conduct.
Ferrexpo believes that training is fundamental for an effective
compliance programme. Ferrexpo's employees, directors and officers,
as well as certain categories of contractors, receive training on
various aspects of the Code of Conduct. Since the Company published
its revised and updated Code on Corporate Responsibility and
Business Ethics in 2015, a total of five newly created training
courses in compliance have been introduced across the business,
leading to the completion of over 2,500 modules by employees in
2018 alone. Two additional courses were initiated by Ferrexpo's
Compliance Department in 2018, relating to anti-bribery and data
privacy. Completion rates for the courses introduced in 2018
reached 84% as of December 2018, with the completion of the
remaining employees targeted for 2019. For those who do not have
access to e-learning, Ferrexpo's compliance teams convey
compliance-related messages through posters, internal newspapers,
the intranet, and other available communication channels.
Ferrexpo acknowledges that any improper conduct by its business
partners could damage Ferrexpo's reputation and potentially expose
the Company and individual employees to liability and penalties.
Ferrexpo therefore has procedures in place to ensure that its
potential business partners are carefully selected and are
following anti-corruption laws, observe human rights, and that
relationships with them do not breach any applicable sanction laws
and regulations. In 2018, the Group has developed a Business
Partners' Code of Conduct, which will be rolled out in 2019.
The Group has a system of reporting compliance and
ethics-related concerns, available to all employees and third
parties. Ferrexpo encourages its employees to raise any questions
or concerns with their managers, another manager or with the
Compliance Team. It is also possible to submit a query to
compliance@ferrexpo.ch or through Ferrexpo Integrity Line available
at http://ferrexpo.com/IntegrityLine and by telephone (with numbers
for each country available via this link). Ferrexpo does not allow
retaliation for raising concerns and will take disciplinary action
up to and including dismissal for intimidation or harassment of
individuals who report business conduct concerns.
External Transparency Initiatives
Ukraine continues to make progress with implementing the
Extractive Industries Transparency Initiative ("EITI") since it
joined in 2013, with EITI determining that the country has made
'meaningful' progress in its review published in June 2018. In
September 2018, the Ukrainian parliament also passed the law "On
ensuring transparency in extractive industries", which sets out
legal principles for the collection, disclosure and dissemination
of data on Ukraine's extractive industries.
KPIs
GOAL PERFORMANCE
----------------------------- --------------------------------------------
Supporting economies where Over US$150 million paid in taxes, royalties
we operate and salaries
----------------------------- --------------------------------------------
Educate workforce in Code Further two additional compliance courses
of Conduct and best practice initiated in 2018, with completion rates
principles on both new compliance courses reaching
84%
1 Source is: UkrStat (http://ukrstat.gov.ua/express/expr2019/02/17.pdf)
CASE STUDY
Compliance Week
Ferrexpo's compliance work in 2018 included face-to-face
training sessions at the Company's operations in Ukraine. This has
the clear advantage over online-based training as it enables
compliance officers to adapt compliance teaching materials to their
audience. In November 2018, the Company held its first site-wide
'Compliance Week', with Compliance training sessions at each of
Ferrexpo's operating entities (FPM, FYM and FBM), together with the
senior leaders of the Group, and holding daily briefings, which
collectively resulted in face-to-face meetings with over 250
employees. Other activities included anti-corruption lessons at
local schools and an anti-corruption art exhibition. One of the
highlights of the Compliance Week was a Compliance Forum entitled
'Integrity in What We Do', which was hosted by Ferrexpo in tandem
with the Ukrainian Network of Integrity and Compliance and Business
Ombudsman Council. The forum featured presentations by Ferrexpo's
employees and guest speakers about ethical leadership, case studies
on the cost of non-compliance, and best practice in compliance
programmes.
Community
Ferrexpo's footprint in Ukraine is much more than mining and
processing iron ore. The towns and villages located close to the
mine rely on the Company for employment, as well as support for
both local businesses and communities.
Ferrexpo's Corporate Social Responsibility ("CSR") programme in
Ukraine was formally established in 2009 and focused on the areas
surrounding the mines. The Group supports the local community and
the country which is recovering from a deep recession caused by
geopolitical tensions. Living standards have reduced considerably
over recent years.
Ferrexpo's local community work and charitable donations can be
divided into three key areas: (1) work done directly with local
community projects, (2) direct transfers to vulnerable individuals
in the local community requiring support (such as veterans and
individuals requiring medical treatment), and (3) donations to
Blooming Land, an independent third party responsible for the
coordination of the Group's national CSR programme.
KPIs
GOAL PERFORMANCE
------------------------------- ---------------------------------------------
Contribute to development, Direct assistance through Ferrexpo Charitable
education Fund of US$15.1 million (2017: US$28.4
and skills of local population million)
------------------------------- ---------------------------------------------
Provide targeted assistance 574 families and individuals provided
with direct aid in 2018, in line with
2017 (575)
Total donations to these three areas amounted to US$15.1 million
in 2018, compared to US$28.4 million in 2017.
Ferrexpo's engagement with the communities local to its mines
does not focus on one area of society, instead the Company prefers
to support a diverse and broad range of activities, from funding
sports activities at local sports facilities, to supporting medical
institutions, schools and kindergartens, to supplementing the local
council's budget.
Specific local projects in 2018 include:
-- The financial support of students at universities in
Kremenchug, Dnipro and Kryvyi Rih, as well as students at higher
educational colleges in Horishni Plavni, which are institutions
from which the Company continues to recruit its future leaders.
-- In terms of sports and recreation, Ferrexpo provides
financial support to the local football club in Horishni Plavni, FC
Gornyak, which currently has 200 children and teenagers involved in
its youth teams. In addition, Ferrexpo has helped build and
maintain indoor tennis facilities that are used extensively
throughout the harsh winters in Ukraine. In total,
Ferrexpo-supported sports facilities in Horishni Plavni registered
1,364 participants in sports competitions in 2018, with 34
professional trainers involved in a variety of sports.
-- Financial support of the Organisation for the Protection of
the Rights of Children with Disabilities ('Tenderness'), which
cares for 95 children in local communities.
-- Individual aid to those in need of medical treatments,
assistance for utility bills and families with multiple children.
The Company received applications from, and provided assistance to,
574 individuals and families under this programme in 2018, in line
with its efforts in 2017.
-- Ferrexpo's support for local sportsmen and sportswomen helped
local individuals to succeed in 2018 - including gold and bronze
models at the European Rowing Championships, gold medals at the
shooting World Cup in Germany, and a number of first prizes at the
All Ukrainian judo tournament held in Kiev.
Blooming Land Charity
In 2013, given the severe upheaval in the country and to support
its general social license to operate, the Group established a CSR
programme on a national basis. Blooming Land (the "Charity") was
used for this programme and its activities included diabetes
prevention, eyesight care and support for the elderly. For further
information see the Chairman's Statement on page 6 and the
Independent Review Committee Report on page 46.
As discussed in the Independent Review Committee Report,
Ferrexpo is currently conducting an independent review in relation
to the Group's relationship with the Charity. This includes
reviewing certain irregularities which have been identified in copy
banks statements and other documentation provided by the Charity,
and also the application of funds by the Charity.
The Group will continue its current programme of charitable
donations at a local level supporting individuals and communities
surrounding the mines. These programmes are managed by FPM and
supervised by the CSR Committee.
For further information
See Chairman's Statement (page 6), Principal Risks (page 25),
Corporate Governance Report (page 39), Independent Review Committee
Report (page 46), Audit Committee Report (page 48) and Note 7 (page
106), Note 29 (page 149), Note 33 (page 156) and Note 34 (page 156)
to the Financial Statements.
Corporate governance report
Chairman's introduction
Dear Shareholder
I am pleased to present our Corporate Governance Report, which
sets out our governance structure and highlights the governance
activity of the Board and its principal Committees during the
course of the year.
The Board remains committed to maintaining good corporate
governance practices throughout the Ferrexpo Group and is reviewing
its existing arrangements in light of the revision of the UK
Corporate Governance Code in 2018. The structure, policies and
procedures we have adopted, which are described in this report, the
Directors' Report and the reports of the various Committees,
reflect this commitment, but we recognise the need to keep them
under review and to make changes where necessary to ensure that
standards are maintained.
The Board of Ferrexpo has constantly managed the risk facing the
business. This includes taking into account the country of
operation and all associated counterparty risks.
This year saw a particular focus on charitable donations. The
Board has taken a number of steps to improve the control and
oversight in this area, particularly since 2016 (as detailed in
Principal Risks on page 25 and the Audit Committee Report on page
48).
As noted in the Independent Review Committee Report, the Board
has established the Independent Review, which is being conducted to
look into matters relating to or arising from the donations made to
the Charity by the Group. The Committee is chaired by Mr Lisovenko
and its other members are Mr Lucas, Ms Reilly and Mr Nacken. It is
assisted by independent legal advisers in the UK and Ukraine and
independent specialist forensic accounting experts (BDO).
At the time of writing, the work of the Independent Review
Committee and its advisers in the UK and Ukraine remains
ongoing.
Given the extensive disclosures on the Blooming Land Charity in
this annual report, for ease of reading and to avoid repetition,
the following cross references are listed:
See Chairman's Statement (page 6), Principal Risks (page 25),
Responsible Business (page 29), Corporate Governance Report (page
39), Independent Review Committee Report (page 46), Audit Committee
Report (page 48), and Note 7 (page 106), Note 29 (page 149), Note
33 (page 156) and Note 34 (page 156) to the financial
statements.
Post year end, Simon Lockett resigned from the Board in January
2019. In February 2019, Lucio Genovese was re-appointed to the
Board as a Non-executive Director. Lucio previously served on the
Board from 2007 to 2014. The Board believes that Lucio's deep
knowledge across commodities, including iron ore, as well as his
extensive experience of operating in emerging markets, specifically
in Russia and the former USSR, is of significant value to the
Group.
Steve Lucas
Chairman
22 April 2019
Statement of Compliance
(In Accordance with Listing Rule 9.8.6R)
During the year to 31 December 2018 the Company applied all Main
and Supporting Principles, and complied with the provisions, of the
2016 UK Corporate Governance Code (the "Governance Code", which is
available at www.frc.org.uk).
Information Pursuant to the EU Takeover Directive
The Company has provided the additional information required by
Rule 7.2.6 of the FCA's Disclosure and Transparency Rules
(Directors' interests in shares; appointment and replacement of
Directors; powers of the Directors; restrictions on voting rights
and rights regarding control of the Company) in the Directors'
Report and the Remuneration Report.
Information Pursuant to the EU Non-financial Reporting
Directive
The information required by Rule 7.2.8A and B of the FCA's
Disclosure and Transparency Rules (Board Diversity Policy) is
provided in the Nominations Committee Report on page 54.
Leadership
Governance Structure
The board
Audit Committee Remuneration Nomination Committee Corporate Chief Executive
Committee Committee of Independent Safety and Officer and
Directors Social Executive
Responsibilities ("CID") Responsibility Committee1
include: Responsible Responsible Committee
* Monitoring integrity of financial statements. for for Responsibilities ("CSR Committee") Responsible
reviewing identifying include: for:
and and * Ensuring compliance with Chapter 11 of the Listing Responsible * Execution of Board-approved strategies.
* Reviewing internal control and risk management approving nominating Rules and the Relationship Agreement. for formulating
systems. all aspects (for Board and monitoring
of approval) the * Delegated authority levels for senior management.
remuneration candidates * Authorising (if appropriate) related party implementation
* Relationship with external auditor. for to fill Board transactions on behalf of the Board. of the Group's
Executive vacancies, policy on * Development and implementation of Group policies.
Directors having due CSR issues
and members regard to * Conflicts of interest procedure under the 2006 as they affect
For more information of the the need for Companies Act. operations. * All material matters not reserved for the entire
Audit Committee Executive appropriate Board.
Report page Committee. balance and For more
47 diversity. information
For more For more information CSR section
information As of January See page 41 pages 29 to For more information
Directors' 2019, all 38 See page 62
Remuneration nominations
Report page are being
56 handled by
the Board
pending
appointment
of further
Independent
Non-executive
Directors
to the
Committee.
For more
information
Nominations
Committee
Report page
54
1 The Executive Compliance Committee, the Finance and Risk
Management Committee, and the Executive Related Party Matters
Committee all report to the Executive Committee.
The Board
The Board is responsible for setting the Group's objectives and
policies, providing effective leadership within the framework of
prudent and effective controls required for a public company. The
Board has a formal schedule setting out the matters requiring Board
approval and specifically reserved to it for decision. These
include:
-- approving the Group strategy and budget;
-- annual and long-term capital expenditure plans;
-- contracts for more than a certain monetary amount;
-- monitoring financial performance and critical business
issues;
-- approval of major projects and contract awards;
-- approval of key policies and procedures including for
dividends, treasury, charitable donations and corporate social
responsibility;
-- approval of procedures for the prevention of fraud and
bribery; and
-- through the Committee of Independent Directors ("CID"),
monitoring and authorising related party transactions.
Certain aspects of the Board's responsibilities have been
delegated to the Committees shown in the chart above to ensure
compliance with the Act, FCA Listing Rules and the Governance Code.
The terms of reference for each of the Audit Committee, Nominations
Committee, Remuneration Committee and CSR Committee are available
on the Company's website at
http://www.ferrexpo.com/about-us/corporate-governance/board-committees.
It is the responsibility of the CEO and the Executive Committee
to manage the day-to-day running of the Group.
Role Descriptions
The division of responsibilities between the Chairman and the
CEO has been clearly established in writing and is agreed by the
Board. A summary of the roles of the Chairman, the CEO, the Senior
Independent Director, the independent Non-executive Directors and
the Company Secretary is set out in the following table. The table
also includes an overview of the role of the Executive Committee
and of the CID. The roles of the Audit and Nominations Committees
are set out later in this Corporate Governance Report, the role of
the CSR Committee in the Strategic Report on page 29, and the role
of the Remuneration Committee in the Remuneration Report on page
57.
Role Description
------------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------------
Chairman The Chairman is responsible for leadership of the Board,
ensuring its effectiveness, setting its agenda, ensuring
that it receives accurate, clear and timely information,
and ensuring effective communication with shareholders.
The Chairman also ensures that there is a constructive
relationship between the Executive and Non-executive Directors.
From time to time the Chairman holds meetings with the
Non-executive Directors without the Executive Directors
present.
------------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------------
CEO The role of the CEO is to provide leadership of the executive
team, to develop proposals for the Board to consider, and
to oversee and implement Board-approved actions. Mr Zhevago
has no other directorships of quoted companies. He has
other business interests and is a member of the Ukrainian
parliament.
------------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------------
Senior Simon Lockett was the Senior Independent Director until
Independent January 2019. The Board is currently recruiting for the
Director vacancy. In conjunction with the other independent Non-executive
Directors, the Senior Independent Director assists in communications
and meetings with shareholders concerning corporate governance
matters. He also chaired the Committee of Independent Directors.
At least once a year, the Senior Independent Director meets
the Non-executive Directors, without the Chairman present,
to evaluate the Chairman's performance. The Senior Independent
Director was available to discuss with shareholders any
issues that the Chairman had been unable to resolve to
shareholders' satisfaction.
------------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------------
Non-executive The Non-executive Directors provide an independent and
Directors objective viewpoint to Board discussions and bring experience
from a variety of industry backgrounds. Their role is to
provide constructive support and challenge to executive
management. Acting either as the Board or as members of
its Committees, the Non-executive Directors: approve budgets;
discuss and contribute to strategic proposals and agree
on corporate strategy; monitor the integrity, consistency
and effectiveness of financial information, internal controls
and risk management systems; monitor management's execution
of strategy against agreed targets and determine their
remuneration accordingly (see the Remuneration Report on
page 65); and monitor executive succession planning (for
Board succession planning, see the Nominations Committee
Report on page 54).
------------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------------
Company Secretary The Company Secretary is responsible for ensuring that
Board procedures are followed and that applicable rules
and regulations are complied with. The Company Secretary
is also responsible for advising the Board on governance
issues and for ensuring, with the Chairman, that information
reaches Board members in a timely fashion, so that they
are alerted to issues and have time to reflect on them
properly before deciding how to address them. All Directors
have access to the advice and services of the Company Secretary.
------------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------------
Executive Committee The Executive Committee is a key decision-making body of
the Group, responsible for managing and taking all material
decisions relating to the Group, apart from those set out
in the Schedule of Matters Reserved for the Board. It has
delegated responsibility from the Board for the execution
of Board-approved strategies for the Group, for ensuring
that appropriate levels of authority are delegated to senior
management, for the review of organisational structures
and for the development and implementation of Group policies.
The Executive Committee meets regularly during the year.
------------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------------
Committee of The CID is composed of the Senior Independent Director,
Independent the Chairman of the Board and the other independent Directors.
Directors The Committee considers and, if appropriate, authorises
on behalf of the Board related party transactions within
the terms of Chapter 11 of the Listing Rules of the Financial
Conduct Authority and otherwise ensures compliance with
Chapter 11 and with the Relationship Agreement entered
into between Fevamotinico S.a.r.l., Mr Zhevago, The Minco
Trust and the Company. The CID holds delegated authority
to consider and, if appropriate, approve transactions where
there is a risk of a conflict of interest for any member
of the Board under the Companies Act 2006. The CID keeps
under review the authorisation and approval process relating
to such transactions (which have previously been reviewed
in detail by the ERPMC (see "Conflicts of Interest" below
under "Effectiveness")) and satisfies itself that, as required
under the Relationship Agreement, related party transactions
have been properly conducted on an arm's length basis on
normal commercial terms and in compliance with Chapter
11, and that no disclosures have been omitted or misstated
in the financial statements.
------------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------------
Board Composition
As of 31 December 2018, the Board (excluding the Chairman)
comprised two non-independent Executive Directors and four
Non-executive Directors, all of whom are considered by the Board to
be independent in accordance with Provision B.1.1. of the
Governance Code. This structure ensures that the Executive
Directors are subject to appropriate independent and constructive
challenge by the Non-executive Directors, and that no single
Director can dominate or unduly influence decision making.
Composition of the Board and Committees as of 31 December 2018
is presented in the table below:
Board member Role Audit Remuneration Nominations CID CSR1
------------ -------------------------------- ----- ------------ ----------- ---- ----
S Lucas Non-executive Chairman ---- -- --
------------ -------------------------------- ----- ------------ ----------- ---- ----
K Zhevago Chief Executive Officer --
------------ -------------------------------- ----- ------------ ----------- ---- ----
C Mawe Chief Financial Officer
------------ -------------------------------- ----- ------------ ----------- ---- ----
S Lockett Senior Independent Non-executive -- -- -- ----
Director
------------ -------------------------------- ----- ------------ ----------- ---- ----
V Lisovenko Independent Non-executive -- -- --
Director
------------ -------------------------------- ----- ------------ ----------- ---- ----
B Nacken Independent Non-executive -- ---- -- --
Director
------------ -------------------------------- ----- ------------ ----------- ---- ----
M Reilly Independent Non-executive ---- -- --
Director
------------ -------------------------------- ----- ------------ ----------- ---- ----
1 The CSR Committee also includes some members of senior
management; see the Strategic Report on page 29.
-- Committee member.
---- Committee Chairman.
The Board considers that it is of a sufficient size to ensure
that the requirements of the business are met without placing undue
reliance on any one Director.
Leadership
Board Activity in 2018
Five scheduled Board meetings were held in 2018, all in
Switzerland (supplemented by other meetings, telephone conferences
and written resolutions as required from time to time). Regular
matters discussed at these meetings included:
-- oral reports from the Chairmen of the Committees meeting
before the Board meeting, and minutes of earlier meetings of the
Committees;
-- Chief Executive Officer's report including production and
operations, iron ore market conditions, and updates on the position
in Ukraine;
-- Chief Financial Officer's report including status vs. budget,
forecasts, cash flow position, and funding update;
-- Bank F&C: update on attempts to recover funds held at the
bank following its insolvency;
-- related party matters (including Directors'
interests/conflicts);
-- investor relations report (including shareholder
feedback);
-- strategy, business plan and budget;
-- formal risk review;
-- compliance matters;
-- CSR matters, including health and safety, and community
spending (as well as matters relating to Blooming Land); and
-- Board refreshment/succession planning/independence/Committee
composition.
Matters reviewed as required included:
-- review of half year or annual results, going concern and
viability, dividend policy/recommendations, investor
presentation;
-- Board/Chairman/Director performance evaluation;
-- review of AGM statement, and proxy agency
comments/recommendations;
-- annual review of bank relationships within and outside
Ukraine; and
-- annual review of treasury policy.
The Board also held sessions at which the relevant executive
heads of department led a more detailed discussion on aspects of
operations, finance, HR and management succession planning, sales
and marketing, and communications. In 2018, this included a
presentation by the Chief HR Officer to members of the Remuneration
Committee to consider the implications of changes to the Corporate
Governance Code.
The Board visited the Group's operations in Horishni Plavni
(formerly known as Komsomolsk) between 3 and 5 October 2018. During
that time the Board inspected various parts of the operations,
received various presentations from executive management in respect
of operations and strategy, and held an informal meeting at which
many of its standard agenda items were covered.
The Board meets for dinner on the evening immediately prior to
each scheduled Board meeting. This provides an opportunity for
Directors to discuss key matters in a more informal setting, and
therefore assists in promoting an open and constructive
relationship between members of the Board.
The Board is supported by the Executive Committee which meets
approximately monthly. All of the information that is submitted to
the Board by management is reviewed and approved by the Executive
Committee.
Effectiveness
Board Balance and Independence
The composition of the Board is regularly reviewed by both the
Nominations Committee and the Board itself. The Board is considered
to have maintained, throughout the period of refreshment between
2015 and 2018, a proper balance in terms of skills, experience,
independence and knowledge of the Company. As at the date of this
report, there is a Chairman, two Executive Directors and four
independent Directors, and the Board and Committee structure is
such that decision making is not dominated by a single individual
or small group.
Controlling Shareholder - Relationship Agreement
Kostyantin Zhevago is a beneficiary of The Minco Trust, which
owns 100% of Fevamotinico S.a.r.l., the majority shareholder in the
Company. Consequently, Mr Zhevago, The Minco Trust and Fevamotinico
S.a.r.l. (collectively "the Controlling Shareholder") have entered
into a Relationship Agreement with the Company in order to ensure
that the Group is capable of carrying on its business
independently, that transactions and relationships between the
Group, Fevamotinico S.a.r.l., The Minco Trust and Mr Zhevago are at
arm's length and on normal commercial terms, and that there shall
be at all times a majority of Directors independent of Fevamotinico
S.a.r.l., The Minco Trust and Mr Zhevago on the Board (the
"Relationship Agreement"). Under the Relationship Agreement Mr
Zhevago would be entitled, if he was not the CEO, to appoint
himself or another person as his representative Director. The
Relationship Agreement terminates if, inter alia, the shareholding
of Mr Zhevago and his associates in the Company falls below 24.9%.
This Relationship Agreement complies fully with the UK Listing
Rules. The Board monitors compliance with the Relationship
Agreement through the Committee of Independent Directors (see under
"Conflicts of Interest" below), which reviews the work of the
Executive Related Party Matters Committee ("ERPMC") (both bodies
are independent of Mr Zhevago), with the CID reviewing the minutes
of the ERPMC and all related party transactions with regard to the
Class Tests and the potential need to consult the Sponsor. The
ERPMC is authorised to approve transactions that are in the
ordinary course of business, without unusual terms; others are
referred to the CID. More generally, the CID keeps under review the
independence of the Board and compliance with the Governance Code,
as the Relationship Agreement requires.
Statement of Compliance with UK Listing Rules, Rule 9.8.4
(14)
-- Ferrexpo has entered into a Relationship Agreement with its
Controlling Shareholder, as required by LR 9.2.2A R (2)(a).
-- Ferrexpo has complied with the independence provisions
contained in the Relationship Agreement during 2018.
-- So far as Ferrexpo is aware, the Controlling Shareholder and
its associates have also complied with the independence provisions
during 2018.
-- So far as Ferrexpo is aware, the procurement obligation set
out in LR 9.2.2B R (2)(a) (which requires the Controlling
Shareholder to procure the compliance of the "non-signing
Controlling Shareholders" (in this case, the other beneficiaries of
The Minco Trust) and their associates with the independence
provisions) has also been complied with during 2018.
Conflicts of Interest
The Board has an established procedure (see "Controlling
Shareholder - Relationship Agreement" above) to deal with
Directors' conflicts of interest and the recording, reporting and,
where appropriate, approval of related party transactions and
review of relevant disclosures. This procedure is in line with
published guidance, the Articles and the provisions in section 175
of the Companies Act 2006 on conflicts of interest. Schedules of a
Director's actual or potential conflicts and related party
transactions have been compiled based on disclosures made by the
Director. These are updated and reviewed on a regular basis by the
Executive Committee, the ERPMC (which is composed of certain
members of the Executive Committee and other members of senior
management not including Mr Zhevago) and the Committee of
Independent Directors ("CID"). Any changes to the schedules are
noted, and confirmed as correct, at the next Board meeting. The CID
has delegated authority to carefully consider and (if deemed
appropriate in the circumstances) approve on behalf of the Board
transactions where there is a risk of a conflict of interests. This
procedure operates effectively in identifying potential conflicts
and ensuring that they are managed appropriately and that
conflicted individuals are not involved in the relevant
decision-making process. The Group aims to follow emerging best
practice in this area.
Training and Professional Development
The Chairman is responsible for agreeing training and
development requirements with each Director to ensure they have the
necessary skills and knowledge to continue to contribute
effectively to the Board's discussions. All Directors receive
updates given to the Board as a whole on changes and proposed
changes in laws and regulations affecting the Group, as and when
necessary. In February 2018, the Chairman of the Remuneration
Committee had a training session with Deloitte. Site visits are
held for the whole Board annually, so as to ensure that all
Directors are familiar with the Group's operations, and Directors
may visit the operations of the Group independently to the extent
to which they feel this is necessary. During the year, as in
previous years, the Board spent two days visiting the site in
Ukraine. In addition, training may be provided by the Group's
advisers in respect of specific areas of interest to the Board,
including general economic and market conditions, developments in
corporate governance regulations and best practice and any other
matters as agreed by the Chairman.
All Directors may take independent professional advice at the
expense of the Group in the furtherance of their duties.
Induction
On appointment, all Directors are advised of their duties,
responsibilities and liabilities as a Director of a public listed
company. In addition, an appropriate induction programme is
provided to each Director upon appointment, taking into
consideration the individual qualifications and experience of the
Director.
As Lucio Genovese re-joined the Board it was agreed that no
formal programme of induction was required on appointment but Mr
Genovese will be updated on relevant matters as required.
Information Flow
The Chairman is responsible for ensuring that all Directors
receive timely and accurate information in order to enable them to
discharge their obligations effectively. Working with the Company
Secretary, the Chairman ensures that agendas, briefing notes and
reports for each Board meeting are agreed and distributed to the
Board in advance and in sufficient time to allow proper
consideration of their contents. The papers include reports on the
Group's operations, and take into account the factors set out in
section 172 of the Companies Act 2006 (Directors' duty to promote
the success of the Company), and such factors are also considered
by the Executive Committee when making any proposals and
recommendations to the Board. Decisions made by the Board are set
within the framework of the Directors' statutory duty to promote
the success of the Company for the benefit of its members as a
whole.
Minutes of each Board and Committee meeting are prepared shortly
after the meeting and their contents agreed with the Chairman (or
relevant Committee Chairman) before being circulated more widely to
the Board where appropriate. Actions arising from the meetings are
recorded and communicated as appropriate, and updates on
outstanding actions are discussed at subsequent meetings. Directors
have the right to request that any concerns they have are recorded
in the appropriate Committee or Board minutes.
Time Commitment
Non-executive Directors would normally expect to spend at least
two days a month, on average, on Ferrexpo's affairs, and in the
case of the Senior Independent Director, the Committee Chairmen and
in particular the Chairman of the Board, considerably more than
that. The attendance of the Directors at Board and Committee
meetings during 2018 is shown in the table below.
The Non-executive Directors are required to confirm at least
annually that they are able to commit sufficient time to the
affairs of the Company, and all of our Non-executive Directors have
given this confirmation in respect of 2018.
Board and Committee Attendance in 2018
Board
------------ ---------
Director Scheduled Audit Rem Nom CID CSR
------------ --------- ----- --- --- --- ---
S Lucas 5/5 2/2 5/5 1/4
------------ --------- ----- --- --- --- ---
K Zhevago 5/5 4/4
------------ --------- ----- --- --- --- ---
C Mawe 5/5
------------ --------- ----- --- --- --- ---
V Lisovenko 5/5 5/5 4/4 5/5
------------ --------- ----- --- --- --- ---
S Lockett 5/5 4/5 4/4 2/2 5/5
------------ --------- ----- --- --- --- ---
B Nacken 5/5 5/5 4/4 5/5 4/4
------------ --------- ----- --- --- --- ---
M Reilly 5/5 5/5 4/4 5/5
------------ --------- ----- --- --- --- ---
Performance Evaluation
The annual performance evaluation of the Board and its
Committees was carried out internally in 2017-2018 by the Chairmen
of these bodies. The evaluation process involved the completion of
questionnaires by Board and Committee members, with responses
collated and analysed by the Chairmen with assistance from the
Company Secretary. The Chairman of the Board then discussed the
feedback from the questionnaires, and the comments made, with each
Director individually before relaying the conclusions to the Board.
There was also an externally facilitated evaluation (the Company's
second) that was conducted between August and November 2018, the
report of which was reported to the Board in November. The
evaluation was conducted by External Board Evaluation Ltd and it
has no other connections to the Group. The process consisted of a
series of one-to-one interviews. All the Directors were interviewed
along with senior executives of the organisation. This led to the
production of a number of observations and recommendations followed
by to "next step" actions and dissemination to non-Board member
participants.
The 2018 evaluation concluded that the Board and its Committees
continued to work effectively; that the Board was high quality and
well engaged and well equipped to deal with challenges faced by the
business; and that there is an open culture which responds well to
constructive challenge. Contentious issues are discussed and
debated and the CEO encourages full and frank discussion. The
process revealed areas that could be improved. These included
greater interaction between the Board, the Executive Committee and
the senior management team; more timely provision of information in
order to confront and tackle known issues; improved prioritisation
of matters for Board time; and greater Board contribution to the
development and testing of strategy.
The Senior Independent Director and the other Non-executive
Directors have evaluated, and will continue to monitor, the
performance of the Chairman.
Independent Review Committee Report
On 4 February 2019, Ferrexpo announced an independent review
(the "Independent Review") into matters relating to the Group's
donations to a charity called Blooming Land which operates through
three sub-funds (the "Charity").
Blooming Land coordinated the Group's CSR programme on a
national basis in Ukraine, alongside Ferrexpo's local CSR programme
which supports communities and individuals surrounding the
mines.
The Independent Review is being conducted by a sub-committee of
the Board ("IRC") with assistance from external advisers. The IRC
is chaired by Vitalii Lisovenko and its other members are Steve
Lucas, Mary Reilly and Bert Nacken.
Further detail on the background to the Group's relationship
with the Charity is set out in Principal Risks, 3.2 Counterparty
Risks on page 25.
Steps Resulting in the Establishment of the IRC
The Board suspended donations to the Charity in May 2018 as a
result of continued delays in receiving information surrounding the
Charity's activities, which the Charity regarded as beyond the
normal requirements expected of a Ukrainian charity, and whilst it
awaited the outcome of a review into the 2017 audited financial
statements of the Charity.
As part of the half year review, transactions between the
Charity's sub-funds and Khimreaktiv LLC, a related party of the
Group's Chief Executive Officer, were identified. These were
clarified and the funding flows were disclosed in the half year
accounts. For further information see Note 33 of the Financial
Statements.
As part of the full year audit process, later in August 2018, a
number of irregularities were reported to the Board including
inconsistencies in copy bank statements provided by the Charity to
the Group's auditors.
These inconsistencies were reviewed by the Committee of
Independent Directors ("CID") and the Board, however, the
explanations provided by the Charity were considered incomplete and
unsatisfactory and could not be independently verified. Following
an inability under local law, in the view of the Charity, to
provide the original bank statements, the Independent Review was
established in February 2019 led by the IRC.
Terms of Reference
The IRC operates under terms of reference prepared with input
from its legal advisers and has been approved by the Board. These
authorise the IRC to review and progress all matters relating to or
arising from the charitable donations made the Charity by the
Group, including:
-- reviewing the initial discrepancies in the copy bank
statements brought to the attention of the Board and determining
the action and further review needed as a result of the
explanations provided by the Charity;
-- gaining assurance over the use of the Group's funds donated
to the Charity including where possible the end recipients of the
donations and the purposes for which the donations have been used.
The Group has made donations to the Charity over the last 6 years
totalling US$110 million;
-- reviewing the relationship and transactions between the
Charity and Khimreaktiv LLC (an entity connected with Rosava which
in turn is controlled by Kostyantin Zhevago, the Chief Executive
Officer and ultimate majority shareholder of the Group);
-- determining whether any significant influence as defined
under IAS 24 may exist between Ferrexpo's CEO and the Charity;
and
-- considering any potential legal or regulatory exposures of
the Group and assessing what claims (if any) the Group may have
against third parties or other persons relating to the matters
arising from the Group's relationship with the Charity.
The IRC operates independently of the Group's CEO. An Executive
Director will attend a meeting of the IRC only when formally
requested to do so by the IRC, and in cases where the IRC considers
that the Executive Director can provide additional information
which is relevant to the IRC's decision making process.
Activity of the IRC
Since its formation, the IRC has met regularly. The activities
of the IRC have included defining the scope of the Independent
Review, appointing appropriately qualified independent forensic
accountants (BDO LLP) and legal counsel in the UK (Herbert Smith
Freehills) and Ukraine (Arzinger and Asters) and reviewing interim
reports provided by the before mentioned advisers. Additionally,
the IRC through its advisors has conducted interviews with key
Group personnel, reviewed key documents and approvals (including
the copy bank statements provided by the Charity to Deloitte), and
secured electronic documents for review and undertaken visits to
some of the sites of the charitable events.
The IRC has considered the relationship of the CEO and the Group
executive management with the Charity, including the CEO's business
network, and concluded, based on the interim findings of the
Independent Review to date and representations from the Chief
Executive Officer, that neither the CEO nor the Group's executive
management control or exercise significant influence over the
Charity as defined under applicable accounting standards or under
Chapter 11 of the Listing Rules and, as a result, the Charity is
neither a related party of the CEO nor of the Group's executive
management..
The IRC has made progress in receiving explanations regarding
the differences contained in the copy bank statements, together
with explanations for other inconsistencies identified by BDO,
which might provide credible explanations for some of the
differences and inconsistencies. However, the credibility of these
explanations can only be assessed by access to certified bank
statements. As at the date of this report, the Company has not yet
been provided access to these.
The IRC has also received third party evidence (including
governmental confirmations) to explain some but not all of the
possible discrepancies identified by BDO in the application of
funds by the Charity. The IRC is undertaking further work to
corroborate this evidence and to evaluate those discrepancies.
At this stage, the IRC cannot conclude as to the ultimate use of
all of the funds by the Charity, however, there are indications
that some could have been misappropriated. Further work is required
before any final conclusions can be drawn.
For further information
See Chairman's Statement (page 6), Principal Risks (page 25),
Responsible Business (page 29), Corporate Governance Report (page
39), Audit Committee Report (page 48), and Note 7 (page 106), Note
29 (page 149), Note 33 (page 156) and Note 34 (page 156) to the
financial statements.
Vitalii Lisovenko
Chairman of the Independent Review Committee
22 April 2019
Audit Committee Report
I am pleased to present to you the Report of the Audit Committee
for 2018. As usual, and in accordance with Provision C.3.4 of the
Governance Code, the Board asked the Audit Committee to advise it
as to whether the Annual Report and Accounts are fair, balanced and
understandable and provide the information necessary for
shareholders to assess the Company's position and performance,
business model and strategy. In providing our advice (which is set
out under "Financial Reporting" on page 53), we were mindful of
ensuring that the Annual Report and Accounts are read in the
context of the current circumstances facing the Company.
This report sets out the following information:
-- The composition of the Audit Committee and the balance of
skills and experience represented on it.
-- The Committee's activities in 2018.
-- Key estimates and critical judgements exercised by the
Committee.
-- Ferrexpo's systems of internal controls and risk
management.
-- The assessment of the external auditors' independence and
effectiveness.
-- The "fair, balanced and understandable" assessment.
Our Viability Statement is set out in the Strategic Report on
page 28.
During the year, the Audit Committee met five times and reviewed
the Annual Report and associated preliminary year-end results and
the interim results, focusing on key areas of judgement and
complexity and accounting policies. An important matter covered in
these meetings was charitable donations made to Blooming Land (the
"Charity"). At every meeting, the Audit Committee reviewed the
progress of the implementation of improved controls around the
donations to Blooming Land and requested detailed information from
the Charity in order to understand how the donations from the Group
were utilised to further its CSR policies.
For details of the relationship with the Charity
See Chairman's Statement (page 6), Principal Risks (page 25),
Responsible Business (page 29), Corporate Governance Report (page
39), Independent Review Committee Report (page 46), and Note 7
(page 106), Note 29 (page 149), Note 33 (page 156) and Note 34
(page 156) to the financial statements.
The Audit Committee and the Board have taken a number of steps
to improve the control and oversight of the Charity particularly
since 2016. The Board suspended donations to the Charity in May
2018 as a result of delays in receiving information requested by
the Group, and while the Group awaited the outcome of a review into
the 2017 audited financial statements of the Charity.
In accounting for the Charity, a critical judgement relates to
control of the Charity. After detailed analysis, including work
carried out by the IRC, the Audit committee considered that the
Charity operates independently of Ferrexpo.
The internal control and risk management procedures at Ferrexpo
are set out later in this report and the main risks themselves are
on pages 19 to 27 of the Strategic Report. Throughout the year, the
Committee has robustly assessed the principal risks facing the
business.
The significant issues and judgements considered by the
Committee in respect of the 2018 Annual Report are set out on page
50. In considering these matters, the Committee took into account
the regular financial and internal audit reports made to the Board
throughout the year, as well as discussing the issues with
management and the external auditors at intervals throughout the
year.
Detailed disclosure is given in the relevant notes to the
financial statements of the significant areas in which estimates
and critical judgements had to be made. In order to satisfy itself
that the accounting for these issues was reasonable and
appropriate, and that disclosure in the financial statements was
suitable and clear in each case, the Committee reviewed the papers
setting out the procedures followed by the auditors and the
responses of management, and questioned and debated them with the
CFO, the Group Financial Controller and, if relevant, operational
management, and with the auditors at the Committee's meetings.
These discussions were also informed by the Committee members' own
expertise, particularly with regard to the economic and financial
situation in Ukraine and operating practice in other large mining
companies. At the end of this process, the Committee was satisfied
with the accounting treatment and disclosure of each issue and with
management's exercises of critical judgement as disclosed in Note 4
on page 102.
Mary Reilly
Chairman of the Audit Committee
22 April 2019
Membership and Meetings
During the year, the Audit Committee comprised four independent
Non-executive Directors: Mary Reilly (Chairman of the Committee),
Simon Lockett (who resigned from the Board as of 28 January 2019),
Vitalii Lisovenko and Bert Nacken. All members of the Audit
Committee (and especially Bert Nacken with his long experience of
the mining industry) are considered to possess appropriate
knowledge and skills relevant to the activities of the Group, and
Mary Reilly is considered to have recent and relevant financial
experience, including of accounts and auditing, due to her career
as an audit partner with Deloitte LLP and her experience as a
member of the audit committees of other companies. The Audit
Committee met on five occasions during 2018. The attendance record
of the Committee members is shown in the table on page 48.
In addition to its members, other individuals and external
advisers, and the Chairman of the Board, may be invited to attend
meetings of the Committee at the request of the Committee Chairman.
The Committee regularly meets the external auditors at the end of
its scheduled meetings, without Executive Directors or management
being present.
Activity During 2018
Key activities of the Audit Committee during 2018 are set out
below.
Date Matters discussed
-------- ---------------------------------------------------------
February
* Reviewed community support donation disclosures,
controls and audit reports.
* Received an update on Blooming Land.
* Received an update of the 2017 audit.
* Reviewed a presentation on the going concern and
long-term viability assessments.
* Reviewed risk register.
* Reviewed compliance report.
* Reviewed an update on Directors' Interests and
Related Parties.
-------- ---------------------------------------------------------
March
* 2017 year-end review.
* Reviewed significant risks.
* Reviewed auditors' responsibility statement.
* Reviewed auditors' independence statement.
* Reviewed risk register.
* Considered the auditors' opinion.
* Reviewed Annual Report.
* Reviewed Viability Statement.
* Reviewed Internal Controls.
* Reviewed Audit Committee report.
* Reviewed auditors' draft reports.
* Reviewed compliance report.
* Reviewed an update of the Audit Committee terms of
reference.
* Received an update on community support donations
including Blooming Land.
-------- ---------------------------------------------------------
May
* Received an update on community support donations
including Blooming Land.
* Reviewed Internal Audit recommendations.
* Reviewed the Internal Audit Plan.
* Reviewed Internal Audit quality survey results.
* Updated Internal Audit charter.
* Reviewed risk register.
* Reviewed compliance report.
* Reviewed Directors' Interests and Related Parties
table.
* Reviewed preliminary audit plan 2018.
-------- ---------------------------------------------------------
July
* Reviewed risk register.
* Reviewed external audit - half year results.
* Reviewed community support donations including
Blooming Land and outstanding matters previously
requested by the Board.
* Reviewed related party transactions.
-------- ---------------------------------------------------------
November
* Received an update on Blooming Land.
* Considered KPI assessment of external auditors.
* Reviewed external audit planning report.
* Received an update on Viability Statement.
* Reviewed Whistleblowing Report.
* Reviewed Preliminary Internal Audit Plan 2019.
* Reviewed risk register.
* Noted compliance report.
* Reviewed Directors' Interests and Related Parties
table.
-------- ---------------------------------------------------------
Key Estimates and Critical Judgements
The significant issues and judgements considered by the
Committee in respect of the 2018 Annual Report are set out
below:
Issues Judgements/actions taken
--------------------------- ------------------------------------------------------------
Operating expenses: In the absence of conclusive evidence that funds
nature of the Group's have not been used as intended, the Group has judged
community support that it remains appropriate for it to present its
donations (Financial community support donations to the Charity as such
Note 7) in the consolidated financial statements within
operating expenses on the basis that all material
donations made by the Group have been applied as
previously reported by the Charity to the Group.
--------------------------- ------------------------------------------------------------
Related party disclosures The Board concluded that neither the Group nor
- completeness and the Chief Executive Officer controls or exercises
arm's length nature significant influence over Blooming Land or its
(Financial Note 33) sub-funds (the "Charity") pursuant to relevant
accounting standards IFRS 10 Consolidated financial
statements and IAS 28 Investments in joint ventures
and associates or under Chapter 11 of the UK Listing
Rules. The appropriateness of the Group's related
party transactions and the completeness and accuracy
of the disclosures in Note 33 was reviewed by the
Committee of Independent Directors ("CID").
--------------------------- ------------------------------------------------------------
Taxation: tax legislation Having considered the background of a recent claim
in Ukraine (Financial made in Ukraine in respect of a tax audit with
Note 11) a focus on the Group's cross-border transactions,
the Committee shares management's confidence that
Ferrexpo will successfully defend its methodology
applied to determine the prices between its subsidiaries
in the courts in Ukraine.
--------------------------- ------------------------------------------------------------
Property, plant and The Committee endorses the estimates underlying
equipment: deferred management's decision to capitalise US$11.8 million
stripping costs (Financial of pre--production stripping during the financial
Note 13) year 2018 in order to ensure availability of ore
in future periods.
--------------------------- ------------------------------------------------------------
Inventories: lean The Committee notes that stocks of "lean" and weathered
and weathered ore ore have continued to increase, but accepts that
(Financial Note 16) it is still the Group's intention to process them
once additional processing capacities are available.
--------------------------- ------------------------------------------------------------
Internal Control and Risk Management
The Board has overall responsibility for the Group's system of
internal control, which includes risk management, and monitoring
and reviewing its effectiveness. The system of internal control is
designed to identify, evaluate and manage significant risks
associated with the achievement of the Group's objectives. Because
of the limitations inherent in any system of internal control, this
system is designed to meet the Group's particular needs and the
risks to which it is exposed, rather than eliminate risk
altogether. Consequently it can only provide reasonable, and not
absolute, assurance against material misstatement or loss.
The day-to-day responsibility for managing risk and the
maintenance of the Group's system of internal control is
collectively assumed by the Executive Committee. Key risk and
control issues are reviewed regularly by the Executive Committee,
Finance and Risk Management Committee ("FRMC"), CSR Committee and
Audit Committee. On behalf of the Board, the Executive Committee
and FRMC have established a process for identifying, evaluating and
managing the significant risks faced by the Group. This process was
followed throughout 2018 and up to the date of approval of this
Annual Report. The Group has also adopted a risk-based approach in
establishing the Group's system of internal control and in
reviewing its effectiveness. To assist in managing key internal
risks, it has established a number of Group-wide procedures,
policies and standards and has set up a framework for reporting
matters of significance.
Controls over Community Support Donations
In 2018, Ferrexpo continued to support communities on a local
and national basis (see "Responsible Business" section of the
Strategic Report on pages 29 to 38) Community support activities
take place exclusively in Ukraine, and donations were made within a
Board-approved framework agreed annually at the time of setting the
budget; they are subject to the internal control and approval
limits applicable within the individual subsidiaries of the Group,
which are set by the Board.
The Board exercises control of the local charitable spending via
its CSR Committee, which oversees and directs these activities.
Donations to Blooming Land (the "Charity) were approved to the
Board and were not considered part of the remit of the CSR
Committee.
In relation to Blooming Land, controls included:
-- Board approval of the use of the Charity.
-- Board approval of the annual budgeted expenditure.
-- Board or CID approval from late 2015 of individual payments
to the Charity and from September 2017 approval of individual
payments to the Charity by the Non-executive Directors or a
committee of Non-executive Directors.
-- A requirement for all expenditure to be supported by third
party documentation.
-- A requirement for any independent charities supported by
Ferrexpo to provide fully audited accounts;
-- Confirmation by Blooming Land of receipt, application and end
use of funds for relevant community support purposes for each
payment, typically US$500,000.
-- Confirmation by Blooming Land, its three Sub-Funds and the
sub-contracted event managers, of compliance with relevant local
and international legislation.
-- Consideration of relevant due diligence on the charities
involved, including third-party checks on the relevant managers and
funds.
-- Receipt and consideration of reporting by an independent firm
of Ukrainian auditors on the financial statements of Blooming
Land.
-- Verification of individual charitable event expenditures on a
sample basis.
-- Attendance at certain charitable events by Ferrexpo and third
parties.
The Audit Committee reviewed reporting from the external
auditors in relation to their procedures on CSR as part of their
audit of the Group.
Developments in 2018
The Board had taken a number of steps to improve the control and
oversight of the Charity in 2017. The following additional controls
were introduced in 2018:
-- A Governance Framework for 2018, setting out the respective
roles and responsibilities for the Board, the Board's
sub-committees and management in relation to charitable
donations.
-- A 'decision-making checklist' to assist with the assessment
of funding requests received from Blooming Land and whether to
subsequently approve such requests.
-- A requirement for all expenditure to be supported by third
party documentation.
-- A requirement for any independent charities supported by
Ferrexpo to provide fully audited accounts.
-- A letter requested and received from Blooming Land providing
further details on its activities and explanations for the use of
event managers.
Donations to the Charity were suspended in May 2018 as a result
of delays by the Charity in providing requested information to the
Group, and while the Group awaited the outcome of a review into the
Charity's 2017 audited financial statements. Blooming Land had also
failed to implement certain control improvements requested by the
Group.
On 4 February 2019, Ferrexpo announced an independent review
into matters relating to the Group's donations to the Charity. At
this stage, the Independent Review Committee cannot conclude as to
the ultimate use of all of the funds by the Charity, however, there
are indications that some could have been misappropriated. Further
work is required before any final conclusions can be drawn.
For further information see Chairman's Statement (page 6),
Principal Risks (page 25), Responsible Business (page 29),
Corporate Governance Report (page 39), Independent Review Committee
Report (page 46), and Note 7 (page 106), Note 29 (page 149), Note
33 (page 156) and Note 34 (page 156) to the financial
statements.
Internal Controls - General
Key elements of the internal control and risk management system
include:
-- Regular review of risk and identification of key risks at the
Executive Committee which are reviewed by the Audit Committee and
by the Board.
-- The Executive Compliance Committee ("ECC"), an executive
sub-committee which meets regularly (eight times in 2018), is
charged, on behalf of the Executive Committee or Audit Committee,
as appropriate, with ensuring that systems and procedures are in
place to comply with laws, regulations and ethical standards. The
ECC is attended by the Group Compliance Officer and, as necessary,
by the local compliance officers from the operations, who present
regular reports and ensure that the ECC is given prior warning of
regulatory changes and their implications. The ECC enquires into
the ownership of potential suppliers deemed to be "high risk", and
oversees the management of conflicts of interests below Board level
and general compliance activities (including under the UK Bribery
Act 2010, the Modern Slavery Act, the Criminal Finances Act, and
the EU General Data Protection Regulation).
-- Clearly defined organisational and reporting structure and
limits of authority for transaction and investment decisions,
including any with related parties.
-- Clearly defined processes for the review and approval of
related party listings and transactions and appropriate review and
approval from the CID and its delegated management sub-committee
the ERPMC. Additional procedures are in place locally to ensure the
completeness and arm's length nature of related party transactions,
such as background checks and tender processes.
-- Clearly defined information and financial reporting systems,
including regular forecasts and an annual budgeting process with
reporting against key financial and operational milestones.
-- Investment appraisal underpinned by the budgetary process,
where capital expenditure limits are applied to delegated authority
limits.
-- The Investment Committee (an executive sub-committee) which
meets as required in order to consider and approve capital
expenditures within limits delegated by the Executive Committee and
the Board.
-- A budgetary process and authorisation levels to regulate
capital expenditure. For expenditure beyond specified levels,
detailed written proposals are submitted to the Investment and
Executive Committees and then, if necessary, to the Board for
approval.
-- The Finance and Risk Management Committee ("FRMC") (an
executive sub-committee) reviews financial information and
management accounts, and meets regularly.
-- Clearly defined treasury policy (details of which are given
in Note 26 to the financial statements on pages 137 to 145)
monitored and applied in accordance with pre-set limits for
investment and management of the Group's liquid resources,
including a separate treasury function.
-- Internal audit by an in-house auditor based in Ukraine (see
below) who monitors, tests and improves internal controls operating
within the Group at all levels and reports directly to the Chairman
of the Audit Committee, and to the CFO for line management
purposes.
-- A standard accounting manual is used by the finance teams
throughout the Group, which ensures that information is gathered
and presented in a consistent way that facilitates the production
of the consolidated financial statements.
-- A framework of transaction and entity-level controls to
prevent and detect material error and loss.
-- Anti-fraud measures through an internal security department
operating in the Group's key operating subsidiaries.
-- A whistleblowing policy is in place under which staff may in
confidence, via an independent, secure website, raise concerns
about financial or other impropriety, which are followed up by
internal audit and reported on to the Audit Committee.
The Board, with assistance from the Audit Committee, regularly
reviews the policies and procedures making up the internal control
and risk management system, and any significant matters reported by
the Executive Committee. The risk register, which includes details
of the controls in place to manage and mitigate identified risks,
is considered at every scheduled Board and Audit Committee meeting,
with specific risks discussed in detail as and when required.
The Board has delegated its responsibility for reviewing the
effectiveness of the internal control and risk management system to
the Audit Committee. In making its assessment, the Audit Committee
considers the reporting provided to it during the year in relation
to internal control systems and procedures, including the risk
register, and may request more detailed investigations into
specific areas of concern if appropriate.
The Committee and the Board continued to keep the Bank F&C
situation under review throughout the year (see Note 29 to the
financial statements on page 150).
Full details of the Group's policy on risk and uncertainties are
set out in Note 26 to the financial statements on pages 137 to 145.
See also the Principal Risks section of the Strategic Report on
pages 19 to 27.
Internal Audit
There is an internal audit function with a Group-wide remit, and
the Head of Internal Audit, who has mining and international
experience, reports directly to the Chairman of the Audit Committee
and administratively to the CFO.
The Committee reviews at least annually the effectiveness of the
internal audit function by assessing outcomes against plan targets,
and is satisfied, following its 2018 assessment, with the rigour of
the audit projects and with management's response to the Head of
Internal Audit's findings. An internal audit programme for 2019 was
approved by the Audit Committee in November 2018.
An internal audit programme for 2018, approved by the Audit
Committee, focused on the operational risks relating to the sales
and marketing, fuel management, repair and maintenance, HR,
compliance, IT, high wall failure, and fraud risk assessment. The
Committee received a report from the Head of Internal Audit twice
during the year, and reviewed the progress of the internal audit
plan with the auditors and the Head of Internal Audit. The reports
include the Head of Internal Audit's assessment of the operation
and effectiveness of relevant elements of the Group's internal
control systems, and therefore form part of the Committee's ongoing
monitoring and assessment of such systems.
External Audit
Auditor Independence and Assessment of Audit Process
Effectiveness
The Audit Committee and the Board place great emphasis on the
independence and objectivity of the Group's external auditors when
performing their role in the Group's reporting to shareholders.
The effectiveness of the audit process and the overall
performance, independence and objectivity of the auditors are
reviewed annually at the end of the annual reporting cycle by the
Audit Committee, taking into account the views of management. The
outcome of the March 2018 review was relayed to the relevant
partners of Deloitte LLP. This review takes the form of an
assessment (using a questionnaire) of the auditors' performance
under various headings: the robustness of the audit, the quality of
delivery, and the calibre of the audit team. The auditors also
provide to the Audit Committee information about policies and
processes for maintaining independence and monitoring compliance
with relevant current requirements, including those regarding the
rotation of audit partners and staff, the level of fees that the
Group pays in proportion to the overall fee income of the firm, and
other regulatory requirements. The Committee reviewed these
arrangements during the year and believes that they are still
appropriate.
The Company has complied with the Statutory Audit Services Order
issued by the UK Competition and Markets Authority for the
financial year ended 31 December 2018.
Non-audit Services
The Audit Committee operates policies in respect of the
provision of non-audit services and the employment of former
employees of the auditors. These policies ensure that the external
auditors are restricted to providing only those services which do
not compromise their independence under EU guidance. The policy on
the provision of non-audit services prohibits the use of the
auditors for the provision of transaction or payroll accounting,
outsourcing of internal audit and valuation of material financial
statement amounts. Any assignment that is proposed to be given to
the auditors above a value of US$20,000 must first be approved by
the Audit Committee or its Chairman (who are routinely notified of
all non-audit services).
Fees for audit-related and non-audit-related services performed
by the external auditors during 2018 are shown in Note 7 to the
financial statements on page 106.
Financial Reporting
The Board has asked the Committee to advise whether it considers
the 2018 Annual Report and Accounts, taken as a whole, to be fair,
balanced and understandable and that it provides the information
necessary for shareholders to assess the Company's position and
performance, business model and strategy. In providing its advice,
the Committee noted that the factual content of the Annual Report
and Accounts has been carefully checked internally, and that the
document has been reviewed by senior management in order to ensure
consistency and overall balance. The Committee has also conducted
its own detailed review of the disclosures in the Annual Report and
Accounts taking into account its own knowledge of Ferrexpo's
strategy and performance, the consistency between different
sections of the report, the accessibility of the structure and
narrative of the report, and the use of key performance indicators.
The Committee is satisfied that, taken as a whole, the Annual
Report and Accounts is fair, balanced and understandable and that
it provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess
the Company's position and performance, business model and strategy
and has advised the Board accordingly.
The Committee has also advised the Board on the process which
has been undertaken in the year to support the longer-term
Viability Statement required under the Governance Code. The
Viability Statement is set out in the Strategic Report on page 28
and a statement setting out the Board's assessment of the Company
as a going concern is contained in the Directors' Report on page 76
and Note 2 to the financial statements on page 98.
Whistleblowing Policy
The Audit Committee is responsible for reviewing the Group's
whistleblowing arrangements, and receives regular reports from the
Head of Internal Audit which detail any new whistleblowing
incidents and, where appropriate, steps taken to investigate such
incidents.
Nominations Committee Report
Dear shareholder
I am pleased to present the Nominations Committee Report for
2018.
The Committee met formally twice during the year. At these
meetings the Board composition and refreshment of the Board was
discussed as well as the Group's Diversity and Inclusion programme.
It was also agreed to undertake an externally facilitated Board
performance evaluation for the year to 31 December 2018 (for
further information see Performance Evaluation on page 45).
During the year, members of the Committee were active in
interviewing candidates for various Board roles and in recommending
the appointment of Lucio Genovese who joined the Board in February
2019.
The Committee is currently searching for a Non-executive
Director to succeed Simon Lockett, who resigned from the Board on
29 January 2019, as the Senior Independent Director. It is expected
that an appointment will be made during 2019. As a result of Mr
Lockett's resignation, as of the date of this report, the Committee
is currently composed of the Chairman of the Board.
The Nominations Committee remains composed of an independent
Non-executive Director and the Chairman of the Board.
Steve Lucas
Chairman of the Nominations Committee
22 April 2019
Membership and Meetings
The Nominations Committee is chaired by Steve Lucas and its
other member was Simon Lockett. The Nominations Committee meets at
least once a year, as required by its terms of reference, and met
formally twice in 2018 besides holding periodic meetings with
search agents and interviews with candidates.
Appointment Process and Succession Planning
The Committee is aware of the Governance Code recommendation
that non-executive membership of the Board should not extend beyond
nine years in an independent capacity.
During the year, the Committee discussed and interviewed for
various positions on the Board. Executive search consultants were
used in the search. After consulting the Nominations Committee
about the skills and experience required, the consultants drew up a
long list of candidates from which a short list was chosen to be
invited for interview by the Nominations Committee. The Nominations
Committee then recommended Lucio Genovese as the preferred
candidate and he was interviewed by other members of the Board
before being formally appointed on 12 February 2019.
The executive search consultants used in relation to the
appointment of Lucio Genovese were Odgers Berndtson, which has no
other connection with the Company.
Re-election
Lucio Genovese, who was appointed to the Board on 12 February
2019, will stand for election by shareholders at the Company's AGM
in May 2019. In accordance with the provisions of the Governance
Code, all other Directors will stand for re-election by
shareholders at the same meeting.
Board Diversity Policy
The Nominations Committee and the Board recognise the importance
of boardroom diversity in terms of cultural and professional
background, expertise and gender, and believe that the present
composition of the Board is satisfactory according to those
criteria, although it is always seeking to improve on existing
diversity where possible. The Committee seeks to apply this policy
by ensuring that all available suitable candidates are taken into
account when drawing up short lists of candidates for appointment
to the Board, and seeks only to engage executive search consultants
who have signed up to the Voluntary Code of Conduct for executive
search firms. The final decisions to make appointments to the Board
are, however, made on merit against objective criteria, so as to
ensure that the strongest possible candidates for the role are
recruited.
The Committee will continue to ensure that gender and other
diversity is considered when conducting future searches for Board
positions, and will take account of the recommendations of the
Hampton-Alexander and Parker reviews regarding gender balance and
ethnic diversity on boards.
Management and Staff Diversity
As stated under "Diversity" in the "People" section of the
Strategic Report on page 33, Ferrexpo's policy is to employ a
diverse workforce.
Gender Diversity
Currently 29% of the workforce is female. 18% of management
positions are held by women, and our aim is to increase this figure
to 24% by 2021. Efforts to increase the representation of women
more generally are expected to be assisted by a recent change in
Ukrainian law to allow women to be employed in certain operational
roles from which they were previously excluded. During the year,
Ferrexpo Belanovo Mining was very proud to train the first women in
Ukraine to be heavy duty truck drivers. Five women completed their
training programmes and in December 2018 transferred to the FPM,
FYM and FBM mining departments to be employed as dump truck
drivers.
Additionally, in 2018 some of FPM's community support programmes
were aimed at helping women.
Disability
In Ukraine, Ferrexpo is required by law to ensure that
registered disabled people make up at least 4% of its workforce.
This requirement was met in 2018.
relations with shareholders
The Chairman is responsible for ensuring that the views of
shareholders are communicated to the Board as a whole, and reports
on his discussions with shareholders as part of the standard agenda
for scheduled Board meetings. Information about the views of major
investors is provided to the Board on a regular basis by the CEO,
the CFO and the Head of Investor Relations. J.P. Morgan Cazenove,
the Group's brokers, also provide regular reports to the Board on
changes to the shareholdings of the Group's major investors.
The Executive Directors and other senior executives maintain
appropriate contact with institutional shareholders on a range of
issues affecting the Group's performance, and meet with
institutional investors and analysts following the announcement and
presentation of the annual and interim results. The Chairman, the
CEO, the CFO and the Head of Investor Relations meet major
shareholders and analysts regularly to discuss performance,
strategy and governance, and the Senior Independent Director and
other Non-executive Directors are available for discussions with
shareholders if required. The Board uses the Annual General Meeting
("AGM") each year to communicate with shareholders and welcomes
their participation. The Chairmen of the Audit, Remuneration and
Nominations Committees normally attend the AGM and are ready to
answer questions from shareholders, as required. Notice of the AGM
and related papers are sent to shareholders at least 20 working
days before the meeting. The voting results of the AGM are
available on the Company's website following the meeting.
Information on matters of interest to investors can be found on
the Group's website at www.ferrexpo.com.
The Board approved this report on 22 April 2019.
Steve Lucas
Chairman
Remuneration report
A Statement to Shareholders from the Chairman of the
Remuneration Committee1
(1) This report has been prepared by the Remuneration Committee
(the "Committee") on behalf of the Board in accordance with the
requirements of the Listing Rules of the UK Listing Authority,
Schedule 8 of the Large and Medium-sized Companies and Groups
(Accounts and Reports) (Amendment) Regulations 2013 and the UK
Corporate Governance Code.
On behalf of the Board, I am pleased to introduce the Directors'
Remuneration Report for the year ended 31 December 2018.
As in previous years, this report is split into two distinct
sections. The first sets out Ferrexpo's remuneration policy which
was approved by shareholders at the 2017 AGM; and is reproduced in
full for ease of reference and to provide context to the decisions
taken by the Committee during the year. The second reviews how the
Company's remuneration policy was implemented in 2018 and will be
implemented in 2019. This section will be subject to an advisory
vote at the forthcoming AGM. The elements subject to audit are
highlighted throughout.
In 2018, the iron ore market was notably less volatile and iron
ore pellet demand remained strong with pellet premiums rising 30%
above 2017 levels. The Group's production volumes rose by 2%
compared with 2017, and reflected planned pellet line refurbishment
in 2Q and higher levels of required fixed plant maintenance. Higher
commodity input prices, local inflation and increased mining and
maintenance activities beyond management control impacted the
Group's C1 cash cost of production which increased by 34% to
US$43.3 per tonne (2017: US$32.3 per tonne). Sales volumes were
also hampered by temporary logistics difficulties in respect of
railage to the port and low water levels on the Danube River. The
Committee believes that this performance is fairly reflected in
executive remuneration outcomes for the year, as set out in this
report and taking into consideration the specific arrangements
regarding Mr Zhevago (the "CEO") outlined below.
It is the policy of the Board to align executive and shareholder
interests by linking a high proportion of executive remuneration to
performance, basing rewards on a balanced portfolio of performance
measures, and assessing remuneration packages against the relevant
market to ensure that Ferrexpo can attract, motivate and retain
talented executives. The CEO's incentive is derived entirely from
his shareholding in the Company, and his remuneration is paid to
him at a flat rate of US$240,000 per year. The Board considers that
his large shareholding in the business is sufficient to strongly
align the CEO's interests with those of other shareholders.
In determining bonus outcomes under the Short Term Incentive
Plan ("STIP") for 2018, the Committee took account that some
factors affecting the outcomes of the Business scorecard were
beyond the direct control of executives but noted with deep regret
that a fatality was experienced at Ferrexpo Poltava Mining ("FPM")
in 2018. The overall outcome under the STIP ranged from 55.6% to
83.5% of maximum, including 75.2% of maximum for the Chief
Financial Officer ("the CFO"), Mr Mawe. This outcome includes the
application of a negative 5 per cent Modifier on the overall STIP
outcome for all executives in consideration of the tragic fatality
and the impact on business outcomes arising from higher production
costs and lower than planned sales.
No significant changes were made to the implementation of the
remuneration policy during the year, but in light of recent changes
to the UK Corporate Governance Code, the Committee will be
considering the introduction of a post-employment shareholding
guideline as part of its review of the Company's remuneration
policy during 2019. The Committee has already introduced a two-year
holding period on vested LTIP shares with clawback provisions, for
awards granted from 2018 onwards. This extends incentive time
horizons and provides further alignment with shareholder interests.
In total, this results in a five-year combined LTIP vesting and
holding period.
From a disclosure perspective, we have included Schedule 8
revisions around enhancing the pay scenario chart disclosure (see
page 60) and quantifying the impact of share price appreciation on
long-term incentive outcomes (see page 64).
The Committee strives to align the interests of the executives
with shareholders, and the Board keeps under review the structure
and level of remuneration afforded through share-based incentives
and ownership in relation to variable and fixed pay. During the
year the Remuneration Committee did not exercise any upwards or
downwards discretion with respect to the vesting of any element of
the remuneration package.
BERT NACKEN
Chairman of the Remuneration Committee
22 April 2019
PART A: POLICY SECTION (NOT SUBJECT TO AUDIT)
COMMITTEE
The terms of reference for the Committee were updated during the
year to comply with changes made to the UK Corporate Governance
Code. The revised terms of reference were approved by the Board,
and its duties include the determination of the policy for the
remuneration of the Executive Directors, the members of the
Executive Committee, and the Company Secretary as well as their
specific remuneration packages, including pension rights and, where
applicable, any compensation payments. In determining such policy,
the Committee is expected to take into account all factors which it
deems necessary to ensure that members of the senior executive
management of the Group are provided with appropriate incentives to
encourage strong performance and are, in a fair and responsible
manner, rewarded for their individual contributions to the success
of the Group.
The composition of the Committee and its terms of reference
comply with the provisions of the Corporate Governance Code and are
available for inspection on the Group's website at
www.ferrexpo.com.
Key Principles of the Remuneration Policy
Ferrexpo's remuneration policy is designed to help attract,
motivate and retain talented executives to help drive the future
growth and performance of the business. The policy aims to:
-- align executive and shareholder interests;
-- link a high proportion of remuneration to performance;
-- reward based on a balanced portfolio of performance measures
(e.g. Total Shareholder Return ("TSR") relative to sector peers,
annual business priorities, financial and operational targets and
individual performance); and
-- provide rewards that are competitive in the relevant markets
to help attract, motivate and retain talented executives.
In determining the Company's remuneration policy, the Committee
takes into account the particular business context of the Group,
the industry segment, the geography of its operations, the relevant
talent market for each executive, the location of the executive and
remuneration in that local market and best practice guidelines set
by institutional shareholder bodies. The Committee will continue to
give full consideration to the principles set out in the UK
Corporate Governance Code in relation to Directors' remuneration
and to the guidance of investor relations bodies.
Executive Director Policy Table
This section of our report summarises the policy for each
component of Executive Director remuneration which was effective
from the date of the 2017 AGM for both current and future Executive
Directors (but see also "Remuneration Policy for New Appointments"
on page 61). The framework governing the LTIP was approved by
shareholders at the 2018 AGM.
The Chief Executive's remuneration package includes an
honorarium of US$240,000 per year (net of applicable income taxes)
with no performance-related pay as described earlier in this
report, and his incentive is derived entirely from his shareholding
in the Company.
The Board considers this large shareholding in the business to
be a significant factor in aligning the performance of the CEO with
other shareholders' interests, and is satisfied that this structure
is appropriate. At the current time, most of the policies set out
below, other than those related to benefits and pensions, are
therefore not applicable to the current CEO and apply exclusively
to the CFO. The principles below are, however, also considered as a
framework for any future Executive Director appointments and apply
where appropriate to the members of the Executive Committee.
Purpose and link Performance metrics
to strategy Operation Opportunity
-------------------------- ------------------------------ ------------------------------ -------------------------
Fixed Pay Base salaries are Base salary increases Business and,
reviewed annually, are applied in line where relevant
Base Salary with reference to with the outcome of for current Executive
To attract and the individual's role, the review, which Directors, individual
retain talent experience and performance; will not exceed 5% performance are
by ensuring base business performance; p.a. (or, if higher, considerations
salaries are competitive salary levels for the applicable inflation in setting base
in the market equivalent posts at rate) on an annualised salary.
in which the individual relevant comparators; basis over the period
is employed. cost of living and over which this policy
inflation; and the applies. Increases
range of salary increases above this level may
applying across the be applied where appropriate
Group. to reflect changes
in the scale, scope
and responsibility
attaching to the role
and market comparability.
-------------------------- ------------------------------ ------------------------------ -------------------------
Pension Executive Directors The employer contribution Not performance
To provide retirement will, as appropriate, will be a percentage related.
benefits. be offered membership of pensionable salary
of a scheme which and associated benefits
complies with relevant (excluding variable
legislation (where pay). The employer
necessary, additional contribution will
pension entitlements normally be up to
will be provided) 15% of salary subject
or cash in lieu of to compliance with
pension. local statutory requirements.
-------------------------- ------------------------------ ------------------------------ -------------------------
Benefits Benefits are paid Benefits' values vary Not performance
Competitive in to comply with local by role and eligibility related.
the market in statutory requirements and costs are reviewed
which the individual and as applicable periodically. Increases
is employed. to attract or retain to the existing benefits
executives of a suitable will not normally
calibre. They include exceed applicable
life insurance and inflation. Increases
medical insurance. above this level may
Where appropriate, be applied, where
additional benefits appropriate, to reflect
may be offered, including, changes in role, scope,
but not limited to, location and responsibility.
allowances for accommodation,
relocation, tax advice
and legal advice.
-------------------------- ------------------------------ ------------------------------ -------------------------
Variable Pay Targets are set at Maximum opportunity Performance related.
the start of the year of 150% of salary.
Short-Term Incentive against which performance The target opportunity Performance measures
Plan ("STIP") is measured. The Committee is up to two-thirds can include financial,
To focus management determines the extent of maximum and the non-financial
on delivery of to which these have threshold opportunity and personal achievement
annual business been achieved. The is up to one-third criteria measured
priorities which Committee can exercise of maximum. over one financial
tie into the long-term discretion to adjust year.
strategic objectives the formulaic outcome
of the business, within the limits Details of the
which include, of the plan for factors performance measures
but are not limited outside of management and weightings
to, developing control where it believes for the STIP in
the reserve base, the outcome is not 2018 are set out
increasing production, truly reflective of in Part B under
reducing costs, performance or in "2018 STIP outcome".
reducing the risk line with overall
profile of the Company performance. The Committee
business, expanding has discretion
the customer portfolio, Payments are typically to make changes
expanding geographically. made in cash; however, in future years
the Committee may to reflect the
determine that a portion evolving nature
of the bonus be deferred of the strategic
and be in the form imperatives that
of cash or shares. may be facing
the Company.
Malus and clawback
provisions will apply
in the event of a
material misstatement
of results, a failure
of risk management,
a material calculation
error or gross misconduct.
-------------------------- ------------------------------ ------------------------------ -------------------------
Long-Term Incentive The LTIP framework The LTIP provides Vesting of LTIP
Plan ("LTIP") was approved by shareholders for annual awards awards is subject
To motivate participants at the 2018 AGM. To of performance shares, to the Company's
to deliver appropriate the extent that an options or cash up relative TSR against
longer-term returns LTIP award vests, to an aggregate limit a comparator group
to shareholders this will include of 200% of salary over a period
by encouraging the applicable dividends in normal circumstances. of at least three
them to see themselves on the shares earned This limit may be years and continued
not just as managers, during the vesting exceeded in exceptional employment. In
but as part-owners period. Subsequent circumstances but addition, for
of the business. dividends on shares will not exceed 300% any shares to
held by participants of salary. vest, the Committee
are paid in shares. must be satisfied
The threshold opportunity that the recorded
For LTIP awards from is 20% TSR is a fair
2018 onwards a two-year of maximum. reflection of
holding period applies Ferrexpo's underlying
to Executive Directors' business performance.
vested
LTIP shares. Details of the
performance targets
Malus and clawback for the LTIP are
provisions will apply set out in Part
in the event of a B under "LTIP
material misstatement granted in 2018".
of results, a failure
of risk management, The Committee
a material calculation reviews the LTIP
error or gross misconduct. performance conditions,
in advance of
granting each
LTIP cycle. Over
the life of this
policy relative
TSR will be retained
as the primary
performance measure.
-------------------------- ------------------------------ ------------------------------ -------------------------
Rationale for Performance Measures
The STIP is based on performance categories that are key to
delivering on our long-term strategy. Performance measures are set
at the beginning of the financial year to reflect business
priorities and other corporate objectives, and can include
financial, non-financial and personal achievement criteria.
Performance targets are set at such a level as to be stretching
but achievable, with regard to the particular strategic priorities
and economic environment in a given performance period. The STIP
target is based on the annual budget approved by the Board. Where
appropriate, the Committee sets a performance zone (threshold to
stretch) around the target, which it considers provides an
appropriate degree of "stretch" challenge and an incentive to
outperform. The Committee believes that using multiple targets for
the purposes of the STIP provides for a balanced assessment of
performance over the year.
For the LTIP, the Committee believes that relative TSR is the
most objective external measure of the Company's success over the
longer term. Relative TSR helps align the interests of Executive
Directors with shareholders by incentivising share price growth
and, in the Committee's view, provides an objective measure of
long-term success. The Committee has discretion to review the
comparator index if any of the constituent companies is affected by
corporate events such as mergers and acquisitions. The Committee
also reviews the constituents and their weightings prior to the
start of each LTIP cycle in order to ensure that they remain
appropriate. Details of the comparator group will be set out in
Part B of the Remuneration Report for the year immediately
following the year in which the grant is made.
With effect from the grant of 2010 LTIP awards (which vested in
2013), Executive Directors and members of the Executive Committee
are encouraged, in line with the practice among FTSE-listed
companies, to build up a holding of shares of equivalent value to a
year's base salary (in the case of Executive Directors) or six
months' base salary (for other members of the Executive Committee).
Executives are encouraged to retain their vested LTIP shares on an
after-tax basis until the applicable guideline level is achieved.
This is in addition to a mandatory two-year holding period on
vested LTIP shares for awards granted from 2018 onwards. As
indicated earlier in the introductory letter to this report, to
align with the changes in the UK Corporate Governance Code, the
Committee is considering the introduction of a post-termination
shareholding policy when the remuneration policy is renewed in
2020.
Remuneration of Senior Executives Below the Board
The policy and practice with regard to the remuneration of
senior executives below the Board is consistent with that of the
Executive Directors.
Senior executives participate in the LTIP with the same
performance measures applied as for the CFO. Long-term incentive
awards may be granted to participants below the Board without
performance conditions, for example, if it is considered necessary
to attract executives of the appropriate calibre.
Payments Resulting from Existing Awards
The Executive Director concerned is eligible to receive payment
resulting from the vesting of any award made prior to the approval
and implementation of the remuneration policy detailed in this
report.
Non-executive Director Policy Table
This section of our report summarises the policy for each
component of Non-executive Director remuneration.
Purpose and link to
strategy Operation Opportunity Performance metrics
---------------------------- --------------------------- -------------------------- -------------------
Fees
To attract and retain Annual fee for the Changes to Non-executive Not performance
talent by ensuring Chairman. Director fees are related.
fees are market competitive applied in line with
and reflect the time Annual base fee for the outcome of the
commitment required Non-executive Directors. review undertaken
of Non-executive Directors Additional fees are by the Chairman and
in different roles. paid to the Senior Executive Directors.
Independent Director
and the Chairmen of The maximum aggregate
the Committees as fees, per annum, for
well as for representation all Non-executive
on subsidiary Boards, Directors allowed
where appropriate, by the Company's Articles
to reflect additional of Association is
responsibility. GBP5,000,000.
Fees are reviewed
from time to time,
taking into account
the time commitment,
responsibilities and
fees paid by comparable
companies, and also
taking into consideration
geography and risk
profile.
---------------------------- --------------------------- -------------------------- -------------------
Additional fees may be payable to Non-executive Directors in
exceptional circumstances, e.g. if there is a material increase in
time commitment. Non-executive Directors are not eligible to
participate in any incentive plans, or receive benefits or any
additional elements of remuneration to that stated above.
Pay-for-Performance: Scenario Analysis
The CEO does not participate in any incentive plan, for the
reasons stated in the introduction to this report. Under all
scenarios, therefore, his remuneration remains as set out in
Section B of this report. For the CFO, who is the remaining
Executive Director, the graph below provides estimates of the
potential future reward opportunity and the potential split between
the different elements of remuneration under four different
performance scenarios: "Below threshold", "Target" and "Maximum"
and "Maximum assuming 50% share price growth".
In illustrating potential reward opportunities, the following
assumptions have been made:
Scenario STIP LTIP Fixed pay
-------------------- -------------------- ------------------------- ---------------
Maximum assuming 50% Maximum STIP (150% Performance warrants Base salary,
share price growth of salary) full vesting pension
and share price increase and benefits
of 50% as at
versus the share price 1 January 2019
at grant
-------------------- -------------------- ------------------------- ---------------
Maximum Maximum STIP (150% Performance warrants
of salary) full vesting1
-------------------- -------------------- ------------------------- ---------------
Target On-target STIP (100% Performance warrants
of salary) threshold
vesting (20%)1
-------------------- -------------------- -------------------------
Below threshold No STIP payable Threshold not achieved
(nil)
-------------------- -------------------- ------------------------- ---------------
1 Excludes increase in value arising from share price growth.
Potential reward opportunities illustrated above are based on
the policy and current practice, applied to the base salary in
force at 1 January 2019. For the STIP, the amounts illustrated for
the CFO are those potentially receivable in respect of performance
for 2019. For the LTIP, awards do not normally vest until the end
of three years following the beginning of the year in which they
were granted. The LTIP award opportunity for the CFO above is
assumed to be of similar monetary value as the award made but which
he declined in 2018. It should also be noted that the Committee
reviews the efficacy of the LTIP prior to grant each year, which
could affect the LTIP awards made to the CFO in 2019.
Remuneration Policy for New Appointments
The Committee's approach to setting remuneration for new
Executive Directors is to ensure that the Company's pay
arrangements are in the best interests of Ferrexpo and its
shareholders. To do this, the Company takes into account internal
pay levels, the external market, location of the executive and
remuneration received at the previous employer. The Committee
reserves discretion to offer appropriate pension and benefit
arrangements, which may include the continuation of benefits
received in a previous role. Variable pay awards (excluding any
potential "buy-out" awards, described below) for a newly appointed
Executive Director will be as described in the policy table,
subject to the same maximum opportunities. Different performance
measures may be set initially for the STIP and LTIP awards, taking
into account the responsibilities of the individual, and the point
in the financial year at which he or she joined, and subject to the
rules of the plan. The rationale will be clearly explained in each
case.
In addition, the Committee may make an award in respect of a new
appointment to "buy out" existing incentive awards forfeited on
leaving a previous employer. In such cases, the compensatory award
would typically be on a like-for-like basis with similar time to
vesting, performance measures and likelihood of the targets being
met. The fair value of the buy-out award would not be greater than
the awards being replaced. To facilitate such a buy-out the
Committee may grant a bespoke award under the Listing Rules
exemption available for this purpose.
In cases of appointing a new Executive Director by way of
internal promotion, the Group will honour any contractual
commitments made prior to his or her promotion to Executive
Director.
In every case, the Board will pay both the appropriate, but also
the necessary, rate of pay to attract an executive who in the view
of the Board will contribute to shareholder value.
The approach to setting Non-executive Director fees on
appointment is in line with the approach taken for the fee review
set out in the Non-executive Director policy table earlier in this
report, and will also take into account fee levels for existing
Non-executive Directors.
Details of Executive Directors' Service Contracts
The Executive Directors are employed under contracts of
employment with Ferrexpo AG, a Group company (the "employer"). The
Committee sets notice periods for the Executive Directors at 12
months or less, which reduces the likelihood of having to pay
excessive compensation in the event of poor performance.
The principal terms of the Executive Directors' service
contracts (which have no fixed term) not otherwise set out in this
report are as follows: save in circumstances justifying summary
termination, Mr Zhevago's service contract with the employer is
terminable on not less than six months' notice to be given by the
employer or by Mr Zhevago, and Mr Mawe's service contract with the
employer is terminable on not less than 12 months' notice to be
given by the employer or not less than six months' notice to be
given by Mr Mawe.
Notice period
----------------------------
Executive Director Position Date of contract From employer From employee
------------------ -------- ---------------- ------------- -------------
K Zhevago CEO 1 November 2008 6 months 6 months
------------------ -------- ---------------- ------------- -------------
C Mawe CFO 7 January 2008 12 months 6 months
------------------ -------- ---------------- ------------- -------------
Under the service contracts, the Executive Directors are
entitled to 25 working days' paid holiday per year.
The Executive Directors' service contracts contain a provision
exercisable at the option of the employer to pay an amount on early
termination of employment equal to the respective notice period. If
the employer elects to make such a payment (which in practice it
will do if the speed and certainty afforded by this provision are
thought to be in the best interests of shareholders), the Executive
Director will be entitled under his contract to receive all
components of his base salary, accrued but untaken holiday and
expenses for the extent of the notice period, including for Mr Mawe
a pro-rated performance-related payment under the STIP (where the
employer terminates employment), which reflects the practice in the
Group at the time when Mr Mawe was appointed. Mr Mawe's entitlement
to a pro-rated performance-related payment where the employer
terminates his employment will not be replicated in the service
contracts of future Executive Directors. In addition to the
contractual rights to a payment on loss of office, any employee,
including the Executive Directors, may have additional statutory
and/or common law rights to certain additional payments, for
example in a redundancy situation.
Policy for Loss of Office Payments
The following principles apply when determining payments for
loss of office for the Executive Directors and any new Executive
Directors.
The employer will take account of all relevant circumstances on
a case-by-case basis including (but not limited to): the sums
stipulated in the service contract (including base salary during
his or her notice period, accrued but untaken holiday, and
allowances/benefits but excluding STIP (save in the case of Mr
Mawe); whether the Executive Director has presided over an orderly
handover; the contribution of the Executive Director to the success
of the Company during his or her tenure; and the need to compromise
any claims that the Executive Director may have. The Company may,
for example, if the Committee considers it to be necessary:
-- enter into agreements with Executive Directors which may
include the provision of legal fees or the settlement of
liabilities in return for a single one-off payment or subsequent
payments subject to appropriate conditions;
-- terminate employment other than in accordance with the terms
of the contract (bearing in mind the potential consequences of
doing so); or
-- enter into new arrangements with the departing Executive
Director (for example, consultancy arrangements).
If the individual is considered a "good" leaver (e.g. for
reasons of death, ill-health, injury or disability; his employing
company ceasing to be a member of the Group; the business (or part)
of the business in which he is employed being transferred to a
transferee which is not a member of the Group; or any other reason
which the Committee in its absolute discretion permits) any
outstanding LTIP awards will be pro-rated for time and performance
conditions will be measured. The Committee retains discretion to
alter these provisions (as permitted by the relevant plan rules) on
a case-by-case basis following a review of circumstances, in order
to fairness to both shareholders and participants. In considering
the exercise of discretion as set out above, the Committee will
take into account all relevant circumstances which it considers are
in the best interests of the Company; for example, ensuring an
orderly handover, performance of the executive during his tenure as
Director, performance of the Company as a whole and perception of
the payment amongst the shareholders, general public and employee
base.
In the event of a change of control, the vesting period under
the LTIP ends and awards may be exercised or released to the extent
to which the performance conditions have, in the Committee's
opinion, been achieved up to that time. Pro-rating for time applies
but the Committee has discretion to allow awards to be exercised or
released to a greater or lesser extent if it considers it
appropriate having regard to the circumstances of the transaction
and the Company's performance up to the date of the
transaction.
It is the Committee's policy to review contractual arrangements
prior to new appointments in light of developments in best
practice. The Executive Directors' service contracts are available
to view at the Company's registered office.
External Appointments
It is the Board's policy to allow the Executive Directors to
accept directorships of other quoted companies, provided that they
have obtained the consent of both the CEO and Chairman of the Board
and which should be notified to the Board. No external
directorships of quoted companies are currently held by Executive
Directors.
Details of Non-executive Directors' Letters of Appointment
The Chairman and Non-executive Directors have each entered into
a letter of appointment with the Company. The Non-executive
Directors are each appointed for an initial period of three years,
and their appointments may then be renewed on a three-yearly basis,
subject to re-election when appropriate by the Company in general
meeting; in 2011 the Company adopted the practice of annual
re-election of all Non-executive Directors. The key terms of
current letters of appointment are as follows:
Non-executive Director Position Date of first appointment Date of re-election
---------------------- ---------------------- ------------------------- -------------------
S Lucas Chairman 19 May 2016 Annual re-election
---------------------- ---------------------- ------------------------- -------------------
B Nacken Non-executive Director 1 August 2014 Annual re-election
---------------------- ---------------------- ------------------------- -------------------
V Lisovenko Non-executive Director 28 November 2016 Annual re-election
---------------------- ---------------------- ------------------------- -------------------
M Reilly Non-executive Director 27 May 2015 Annual re-election
---------------------- ---------------------- ------------------------- -------------------
L Genovese1 Non-executive Director 12 February 2019 Election
---------------------- ---------------------- ------------------------- -------------------
1 Lucio Genovese was appointed to the Board on 12 February 2019
and will stand for election at the 2019 AGM.
Employee Context
In making remuneration decisions, the Committee also considers
the pay and employment conditions throughout the Group. Prior to
the annual pay review and throughout the year, the Committee
receives reports from the CEO setting out the circumstances
surrounding, and potential changes to, broader employee pay. The
CEO consults as appropriate with key employees and the relevant
professionals throughout the Group. This forms part of the basis
for determining changes in Executive Director and senior executive
remuneration which also takes into consideration factors detailed
earlier in this report.
Consideration of Shareholder Views
The Committee takes into consideration views expressed by
shareholders regarding remuneration, either at the AGM, or by
correspondence, or at one-to-one or Group meetings and shareholder
events or otherwise by considering these views at the relevant
Committee meetings which are subsequently reported to and
considered by the Board as a whole. The Committee takes shareholder
feedback into careful consideration when reviewing remuneration and
regularly reviews the Directors' remuneration policy in the context
of key institutional shareholder guidelines and best practice. It
is the Committee's policy to consult with major shareholders prior
to making any major changes to its executive remuneration
structure.
PART B: REMUNERATION IN 2018 (SUBJECT TO AUDIT)
The following section provides details of how the remuneration
policy was implemented during the year. Throughout this report, the
remuneration of Mr Zhevago and Mr Mawe (the Executive Directors) is
disclosed in local currencies to facilitate year-on-year
comparisons, uninfluenced by exchange rate fluctuations.
Committee Membership in 2018
The Committee comprises four independent Non-executive
Directors. Bert Nacken is the Chairman of the Committee. The other
members are Mary Reilly, Vitalii Lisovenko and Simon Lockett. The
Committee met four times during the year. Attendance at meetings by
individual members is detailed in the Corporate Governance Report
on page 45. A summary of the topics discussed at meetings in 2018
is detailed below:
-- Review of remuneration of members of the Executive Committee,
including salaries, STIP and LTIP policy.
-- Review of incentive outcomes.
-- Review of pension arrangements across the Group.
-- Review of the policy governing recovery provisions relating
to incentive awards.
-- Review of feedback from the 2018 AGM voting season.
-- Review of general market considerations surrounding executive
remuneration packages and structure.
-- Review of changes in the UK Corporate Governance Code and
implications for the operation of the Committee.
-- Performance evaluation of the Committee.
The CEO and the Chief Human Resources Officer (the "CHRO")
usually attend meetings of the Committee at the invitation of the
Chairman of the Committee, and the Company Secretary acts as
secretary to the Committee. No Director is present when his own
remuneration is being discussed.
Advisers
The Committee currently retains Mercer | Kepler to provide
advice on remuneration policy, with particular emphasis on the
structure of long-term incentives for senior management and the
provision of benchmark reports on executive and non-executive
remuneration. Mercer | Kepler is a member of the Remuneration
Consultants Group and adheres to its code of conduct. To help
ensure a consistent approach to remuneration across the Group,
Mercer | Kepler also provided advice to the Company in respect of
matters relating to the remuneration of other employees. Other than
remuneration advice, no other services were provided by Mercer |
Kepler. Kepler's parent company, Mercer, advised the Group on
international healthcare plans. The fees paid to Mercer | Kepler in
respect of work carried out for the Committee in 2018 totalled
GBP18,925 based on time and materials. The Committee evaluates the
support provided by its advisers periodically and is satisfied that
Mercer | Kepler provides independent and objective remuneration
advice to the Committee and does not have any connections with
Ferrexpo which may impair its independence.
The CEO and the CHRO provide guidance to the Committee on
remuneration packages of senior executives employed by the Group
(but not in respect of their own remuneration).
Single Total Figure of Remuneration - Audited
The table below sets out in a single figure for each currency of
payment the total remuneration received by each Executive Director
for the year ending 31 December 2018 and the prior year.
K Zhevago (CEO) C Mawe (CFO)
----------------------------- -------------------------------- ----------------------------------
All figures shown in currency
of payment 2018 2017 2018 2017
----------------------------- --------------- --------------- ---------------- ----------------
1 Salary US$240,000 US$240,000 CHF651,525 CHF651,525
----------------------------- --------------- --------------- ---------------- ----------------
2 Benefits nil nil CHF191,339 CHF167,790
----------------------------- --------------- --------------- ---------------- ----------------
3 STIP - - CHF735,000 CHF728,644
----------------------------- --------------- --------------- ---------------- ----------------
4 LTIP - - GBP291,975 GBP395,685
----------------------------- --------------- --------------- ---------------- ----------------
5 Pension CHF10,941 CHF14,662 CHF68,922 CHF65,326
----------------------------- --------------- --------------- ---------------- ----------------
Total US$240,000 US$240,000 CHF1,646,786 CHF1,613,285
plus CHF10,941 plus CHF14,662 plus GBP291,975 plus GBP395,685
----------------------------- --------------- --------------- ---------------- ----------------
6 Total (single currency) US$251,195 US$254,891 CHF2,028,018 CHF2,115,062
----------------------------- --------------- --------------- ---------------- ----------------
The figures have been calculated as follows:
1 Base salary: amount earned for the year.
2 Benefits: the taxable value of benefits received in the year
(accommodation allowance and healthcare).
3 STIP: this is the total bonus earned on performance during the
year. Further details are provided on pages 66 to 68.
4 LTIP: the market value of shares that vested on performance to
31 December of the relevant year (2018: 100% vested on performance;
2017: 100% vested on performance). The market value is based on the
share price on the date of vesting: 31 December 2018 of 194.65
pence. Further details are provided on page 68. The impact of share
price appreciation on the value of the LTIP is reflected in the CFO
LTI Value at Vesting chart on below.
5 Pension: valued in accordance with sections 230 to 232 of the
Finance Act 2004 for cash balance arrangement schemes. Other
formulae (such as 20 times the increase in the value of accrued
benefit over the year) are not considered appropriate since this is
not a classic defined benefit scheme (see "Pensions and Other
Benefits" below), and for expatriate staff the pension is repaid as
a lump sum on leaving the country.
6 Average exchange rates: 2018 - US$1 = CHF0.9773, CHF1 =
GBP0.7659; 2017 - US$1 = CHF0.9846, CHF1 = GBP0.7890.
CFO LTIP Value at Vesting
Share
price Share Value Value
at price based based Impact of
Number Vesting date at date on grant on vesting share price
Date of grant of shares percentage of grant(1) of vesting price price appreciation
-------------- ---------- ----------- ------------ ----------- ---------- ----------- -------------
GBP294,435
21/04/2015 135,000 100% 75p 293.1p GBP101,250 GBP395,685 (74%)
-------------- ---------- ----------- ------------ ----------- ---------- ----------- -------------
GBP247,275
20/04/2016 150,000 100% 29.8p 194.65p GBP44,700 GBP291,975 (85%)
-------------- ---------- ----------- ------------ ----------- ---------- ----------- -------------
1 The grant price used for the purpose of the table above is the
three-month average share price during the prior financial year to
the year of grant, in line with the face value methodology used in
the Remuneration Report.
The table below sets out in a single figure for each currency of
payment the total remuneration received by each Non-executive
Director for the year ending 31 December 2018 and the prior
year.
All figures shown in currency
of payment, US$000
-----------------------------------
2018 2017
----------------- ----------------
Fees Total Fees Total
------------------------------- ------- -------- ------ --------
Non-executive Directors1
------------------------------- ------- -------- ------ --------
S Lucas2 440 440 440 440
------------------------------- ------- -------- ------ --------
M Reilly3 170 170 170 170
------------------------------- ------- -------- ------ --------
B Nacken4 170 170 170 170
------------------------------- ------- -------- ------ --------
V Lisovenko 135 135 135 135
------------------------------- ------- -------- ------ --------
S Lockett5 190 190 92 92
------------------------------- ------- -------- ------ --------
Former Non-executive Directors
------------------------------- ------- -------- ------ --------
M Field6 0 0 73 73
------------------------------- ------- -------- ------ --------
O Baring7 0 0 158 158
------------------------------- ------- -------- ------ --------
1 The Non-executive Director base fee is US$135,000 p.a. and
US$35,000 p.a. for chairmanship of a Committee. This fee structure
became effective on 1 September 2016.
2 Steve Lucas receives a Chairman fee of US$440,000 p.a.
3 Mary Reilly receives an additional fee of US$35,000 p.a. for
her role as Chairman of the Audit Committee.
4 Bert Nacken receives an additional fee of US$35,000 for his
role as Chairman of the Remuneration Committee.
5 Simon Lockett resigned from the Board on 28 January 2019. In
2018, in addition to a Non-executive Director base fee, he received
fees of US$55,000 p.a. since 1 September 2017, for his role as
Senior Independent Director.
6 Sir Malcolm Field joined the Board on 10 March 2016 and during
2017 he received a time pro-rated additional fee of US$35,000 p.a.
for his role as Chairman of the Bank F&C Review Committee. He
also received a fee of US$4,625 in 2017, calculated on a time spent
basis, in respect of work carried out on the Bank F&C review.
He retired from the Board on 25 May 2017.
7 Oliver Baring retired from the Board on 23 November 2017. He
received, in addition to a Non-executive Director base fee until
his retirement, additional fees of US$60,000 p.a. for his role as
Senior Independent Director until 30 August 2017.
Implementation of Remuneration Policy
Salary
Base salaries are reviewed annually, with reference to the
individual's role, experience and performance; business
performance; salary levels at relevant comparators; and the range
of salary increases applying across the Group. During the year the
Committee considered pay levels against international mining
comparators and other FTSE-listed companies of similar size with
executives based in similar geographic locations. Following this
review the Committee decided not to increase executive salaries in
2018. Mr Zhevago's remuneration also remained unchanged at
US$240,000.
Base salary at:
------------------------
1 January 1 January
Executive Director Position 2019 2018 Increase
------------------- --------- ----------- ----------- --------
K Zhevago CEO US$240,000 US$240,000 0%
------------------- --------- ----------- ----------- --------
C Mawe CFO CHF651,525 CHF651,525 0%
------------------- --------- ----------- ----------- --------
Pensions and Other Benefits - Audited
The Group does not operate a separate pension scheme for
Executive Directors. Mr Mawe and Mr Zhevago are members of the
Ferrexpo AG pension plan, which is a mandatory insurance scheme
under Swiss law, provided for all employees of Ferrexpo AG, to
which the Company contributes an average of 6% of their annual base
salaries. Contributions operate according to a sliding scale,
increasing as the employee gets older to a maximum of 10%.
Increase
in
value
for 2018 Total
less Director's cash value
at end of
Normal contribution 2018
retirement
date (CHF000) (CHF000)
---------- ------------- ----------------- ------------
K Zhevago 07.01.2039 11 93
---------- ------------- ----------------- ------------
C Mawe 31.01.2027 69 903
---------- ------------- ----------------- ------------
No additional benefit is receivable on early retirement.
Mr Zhevago is entitled to, but in 2018 made no claim in respect
of, furnished accommodation in Switzerland (and elsewhere in Europe
if necessary for the performance of his duties), and up to US$5,000
for professional tax advice. Ferrexpo AG provides Mr Mawe with
CHF167,790 of accommodation allowance and CHF23,549 of health
insurance per annum which is subject to periodic review in line
with CPI inflation.
Pension and other benefits will operate as set out in the
Executive Director remuneration policy earlier in the report.
2018 STIP Outcome - Audited
The Company, as a single product producer of iron ore pellets
with a focused customer portfolio, sets its performance targets to
ensure that the CFO and senior executives are motivated to enhance
shareholder value both in the short term and over the longer term.
Key performance targets for 2018 were set for the CFO and senior
executives and were weighted to reflect the contribution of the
individual to the achievement of that target. Targets during the
year related to financial performance, operational performance, and
sales and product marketing performance, as well as personal
targets relating to operational and financial management
objectives. Safety (behavioural safety initiatives and improvements
in risk management and lost time accident statistics) was included
as a modifier, decreasing the total result in the event of a
fatality.
In last year's report, detailed targets and objectives were not
disclosed prospectively as they were considered to be commercially
sensitive at that time. We indicated that retrospective disclosure
of these targets would be given in this year's report where this is
no longer the case, and this is included in the table below.
Financial and operational targets were normalised, as in previous
years, to take account of market and raw material cost price
developments and mining plans as appropriate, to the extent that
these were not under the direct control of management.
Target STIP opportunity (as a percentage of salary) may be
varied as appropriate to take account of changes in role,
responsibility or scope.
No payment is made under the STIP if performance is below
threshold. For the CFO, threshold performance earns a bonus of 50%
of salary, on-target performance 100% and stretch performance
150%.
The level of achievement against each of the targets for 2018,
as determined by the Committee for the CFO, is summarised
below.
Business Scorecard (60% of STIP)
Bonus
Weighting Max awarded
for as a as a
CFO Threshold Target Stretch Scorecard % %
KPI Measure/target % 50% 100% 150% outcome Assessment of salary of salary
------------ --------------- --------- --------- ------ ------- --------- ------------- ---------- ----------
Underlying cash
Financial EBITDA (US$) 15% 433 452 533 459 Above target 22.5% 15.7%
------------ --------------- --------- --------- ------ ------- --------- ------------- ---------- ----------
NOPAT (US$) 15% 283 326 368 337 Above target 22.5% 16.9%
---------------------------- --------- --------- ------ ------- --------- ------------- ---------- ----------
Production Above
Operational volume (Mt) 5.0% 10,395 10,595 10,995 10,506 threshold 7.5% 3.9%
------------ --------------- --------- --------- ------ ------- --------- ------------- ---------- ----------
Full cash costs
(C1) (US$/t) 5.0% 47.6 46.6 44.6 47.5 Threshold 7.5% 2.8%
---------------------------- --------- --------- ------ ------- --------- ------------- ---------- ----------
FPM Total movement
cost (US$/t) 5.0% 2.18 2.04 1.91 1.99 Above target 7.5% 5.9%
---------------------------- --------- --------- ------ ------- --------- ------------- ---------- ----------
FYM Total movement
cost (US$/t) 5.0% 1.99 1.86 1.75 1.90 Threshold 7.5% 4.2%
---------------------------- --------- --------- ------ ------- --------- ------------- ---------- ----------
Sales Realised
and DAP/FOB Stretch
Marketing price (US$) 5.0% -5.0 -3.0 -1.5 0.70 achieved 7.5% 7.5%
------------ --------------- --------- --------- ------ ------- --------- ------------- ---------- ----------
Seaborne freight
per wmt compared Stretch
to C3 (US$/t) 5.0% 4.5 3.0 1.5 0.82 achieved 7.5% 7.5%
---------------------------- --------- --------- ------ ------- --------- ------------- ---------- ----------
60.0% 90.0% 64.4%
---------------------------- --------- --------- ------ ------- --------- ------------- ---------- ----------
Zero harm -
5% deduction
due to Discretionary
Safety fatality modifier -5.0%
------------ --------------- --------- --------- ------ ------- --------- ------------- ---------- ----------
Scorecard
outcome 59.4%
---------------------------- --------- --------- ------ ------- --------- ------------- ---------- ----------
The Committee considered the CFO's performance against
Financial, Operational, Sales and Marketing targets during 2018.
The Committee noted that production volumes in 2018 were impacted
by planned pellet line refurbishments and higher than expected
required maintenance. Temporary rail logistics problems and low
water on the Danube River impeded sales which caused a drag on
financial targets despite these targets being adjusted upwards to
take account of actual market and raw material input cost price
developments which were beyond the direct control of management.
The Committee also noted with deep regret that a fatal incident was
experienced at FPM in the year when a contractor fell while working
at height. This loss has had an immense impact on all involved and
the Board continues to work closely with executive management to
build leadership capability and improve safety performance. As a
result of this incident the Committee applied a penalty of (-5%) to
the overall scorecard outcome for the CFO.
Taking into consideration all these factors, the Committee
determined an overall business scorecard result for the CFO of
59.4% of salary.
Personal Objectives (40% of STIP)
Bonus
Max awarded
Weighting as as
for a % a %
CFO Threshold Target Stretch Scorecard of of
KPI Objectives % 50% 100% 150% outcome Assessment salary salary
----------- ----------- --------- ----------- -------------- ------------- --------- ------------ ------ -------
Minimise
additional
tax Adjustment
arising Adjustment Adjustment of plus Tax charge
Personal from tax of plus 12% of plus 7% 2% tax Stretch less than
objectives audits 10.0% tax due of tax due due achieved plus 2% 15.0% 15.0%
----------- ----------- --------- ----------- -------------- ------------- --------- ------------ ------ -------
Significantly
better
Better than than market PXF facility
Comparative market terms terms given arranged
terms to given to to peers and 2019
peers and peers and and not Bond fully
not more not more more than financed
Refinance than +5% than +4.5% +4.0% above at 4.5%
2019 bond 10.0% above libor above libor libor Target above libor 15.0% 10.0%
----------------------- --------- ----------- -------------- ------------- --------- ------------ ------ -------
Cash issues
(Opex and
Cash issues Capex)
(Opex and discussed Working
Capex) with Exco capital
discussed and effective effectively
with Exco solutions managed
and effective developed with
solutions and 100% specific
developed of actions and
with part taken to effective
implementation mitigate actions
to mitigate financial taken and
financial impact Exco fully
impact of of production involved
production volumes in managing
Cash management No volumes and/or and/or highlighted
to mitigate mitigation sales sales Above Opex and
price risk 10.0% needed shortfall shortfall target Capex issues 15.0% 13.5%
----------------------- --------- ----------- -------------- ------------- --------- ------------ ------ -------
Group cash
balance
effectively
managed
to enable
the payment
of normal
and special
Enable budgeted dividend
dividend ahead of
payments Lowered to schedule
approved mitigate Ahead of Stretch to
by the Board 10.0% risk On schedule schedule achieved shareholders 15.0% 15.0%
----------------------- --------- ----------- -------------- ------------- --------- ------------ ------ -------
Total 40.0% 60.0% 53.5%
------------------------ --------- ----------- -------------- ------------- --------- ------------ ------ -------
Total (Composite result of business scorecard and personal
STIP objectives achievement) 150.0% 112.9%
----------- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- ------ -------
The Committee considered the CFO's personal performance against
his personal targets during 2018 as shown above and confirmed a
result of 53.5%. The Committee confirmed that the CFO had achieved
all his personal targets relating to managing the Group's overall
tax position, refinancing the Group's bond due in 2019, and
management of the Group's cash position which enabled the payment
of normal and special dividends to shareholders. The Committee also
considered that the CFO had continued to take actions to deleverage
the Group's balance sheet, reducing working capital and had
achieved various compliance-related targets in the normal course of
his duties. It was also noted that the CFO had, through various
personal actions, contributed towards an increase in the Group's
credit rating by the main rating agencies and had enhanced
relationships with banking partners, thus enabling a new PXF
facility and trade finance facilities to be arranged.
Taking into account his overall scorecard results and
achievement of specific personal targets, the Committee awarded a
total cash bonus of 112.9% of salary to the CFO.
STIP Framework for 2019
The STIP framework for 2019 is in line with the principles of
the remuneration policy and the 2018 framework. Financial and
operational targets, including cost reduction measures and personal
KPIs, continue to be set as in previous years. Mr Mawe's 2019 STIP
opportunity is 150% of salary for maximum performance, and 100% for
target performance. The measures and weightings for the STIP in
2019 are shown in the table below. Due to commercial sensitivity,
details of performance targets will be disclosed retrospectively
and in certain instances may be aggregated. The CEO does not
participate in the STIP.
Weighting
for
KPI CFO
--------------------------------------- ---------
Financial (EBITDA, NOPAT) 30.0%
--------------------------------------- ---------
Operational (production, sales volume) 30.0%
--------------------------------------- ---------
Personal 40.0%
--------------------------------------- ---------
Total 100.0%
--------------------------------------- ---------
2016 LTIP Award Vesting - Audited
The performance period for the 2016 LTIP awards ended on 31
December 2018. The 2016 LTIP rewarded TSR outperformance of a
tailored comparator group, as set out below. Under the 2016 LTIP,
20% of maximum vests for TSR performance in line with the index,
with full vesting for TSR outperformance of 8% p.a.
Ferrexpo's TSR performance relative to the weighted index was
assessed by Mercer | Kepler. From 1 January 2016 to 31 December
2018, Ferrexpo's TSR outperformance was 11.9% p.a. resulting in
100% of the 2016 LTIP awards vesting.
Executive Director Vesting Vesting
Interests Interests date share
held Vesting vesting price Value
------------------- --------- ------- --------- ---------- ------- ----------
Chris Mawe 150,000 100% 150,000 31/12/2018 194.65p GBP291,975
------------------- --------- ------- --------- ---------- ------- ----------
LTIP Granted in 2018 - Audited
The 2018 LTIP intended grant to Mr Mawe had a face value of 46%
of salary. As outlined in the Chairman's statement, the CFO
declined receiving an LTIP award for the year.
The constituents of the index for the last three cycles are
summarised in the table below:
20161 2017 2018
-------------------------- ---------- ----- ---- ----
Focused iron ore miners Weighting 60% 60% 60%
-------------------------- ---------- ----- ---- ----
Assore -- -- --
-------------------------- ---------- ----- ---- ----
Atlas Iron2 -- --
-------------------------- ---------- ----- ---- ----
Cliffs -- -- --
-------------------------- ---------- ----- ---- ----
Fortescue Metals -- -- --
-------------------------- ---------- ----- ---- ----
Kumba Iron Ore -- -- --
-------------------------- ---------- ----- ---- ----
Mount Gibson -- -- --
-------------------------- ---------- ----- ---- ----
Global diversified miners Weighting 40% 40% 40%
-------------------------- ---------- ----- ---- ----
Anglo American3 -- --
-------------------------------------- ----- ---- ----
BHP Billiton -- -- --
-------------------------------------- ----- ---- ----
Rio Tinto -- -- --
-------------------------------------- ----- ---- ----
Vale -- -- --
-------------------------------------- ----- ---- ----
Glencore -- -- --
-------------------------------------- ----- ---- ----
1. The Committee reviewed the constituents of the comparator
index and their weightings prior to the grant of 2015 LTIP awards
and decided to increase the weighting on the focused iron ore
miners from 50% to 60% by dropping the single commodity/emerging
market miners component from the comparator group, increasing the
weighting on our closest comparators to improve the relevance of
the benchmark and aid simplicity.
2. Removed from the peer group for 2018 due to acquisition by Hancock Prospecting in 2018.
3. Removed from the peer group for 2018 because the company is
the majority shareholder of Kumba Iron Ore (already in the peer
group) which the Committee regarded as the more relevant of the two
comparators.
TSR is calculated on a common currency basis to ensure that
comparisons with international comparators listed overseas are
fair, with a TSR share price averaging period of six months to help
improve the comparison of the management long-term incentive in
relation to potential short-term movements in Ferrexpo's share
price or the share price of comparator companies.
No performance shares vest if Ferrexpo's TSR underperforms the
comparator index. 20% vest if Ferrexpo's TSR is equal to index TSR;
full vesting occurs only if Ferrexpo's TSR exceeds the index by at
least 8% p.a.; there is straight-line pro rata vesting in between
these points. In addition, for any shares to vest, the Committee
must be satisfied that the recorded TSR is a fair reflection of
Ferrexpo's underlying business performance.
Dividends accrue on performance shares over the vesting period
and are paid on shares that vest. Dividends that ensue post vesting
are paid to participants in shares.
LTIP Framework for 2018
This Directors' Remuneration Report is published prior to the
grant date of awards under the LTIP, which are normally made in
April. In advance of grant, the Committee will review the efficacy
of the LTIP to ensure that it remains relevant. Details of awards
made in 2019 will be set out in next year's Annual Report on
Remuneration. The awards will be subject to recovery provisions and
a two-year holding period following the three-year performance
period.
Non-executive Directors (Including the Chairman)
The Non-executive Directors' fees are reviewed each year in
light of the time commitment and level of involvement that
Non-executive Directors are required to devote to the activities of
the Board and its Committees, market practice, and surveys by
Mercer | Kepler. Fees payable were reviewed and reduced in 2016 and
2017. For 2019, fees for incoming NEDs will be reduced to align
with market benchmarks. The fee rates applicable for existing NEDs
and new appointments from 2019 is disclosed below:
From 1 January From 1 January
2019 2019 From 1 September
Annual fee for Annual fee for 2017
Role incoming NEDs existing NEDs Annual fee
------------------------------- --------------- --------------- ----------------
Existing fees:
------------------------------- --------------- --------------- ----------------
Chairman fee US$440,000 US$440,000 US$440,000
------------------------------- --------------- --------------- ----------------
Non-executive Director base fee US$100,000 US$135,000 US$135,000
------------------------------- --------------- --------------- ----------------
Committee Chairman fee US$20,000 US$35,000 US$35,000
------------------------------- --------------- --------------- ----------------
Senior Independent Director fee US$35,0001 US$55,0002 US$55,000
------------------------------- --------------- --------------- ----------------
1. Fee includes US$20,000 for chairmanship of the Committee
Independent Directors ("CID") and US$15,000 for acting as the
Senior Independent Director ("SID").
2. The additional fee for the SID includes US$35,000 for
chairmanship of the CID and a fee of US$20,000 for acting as the
SID.
Directors' Shareholdings - Audited
Total interests of the Directors in office (and connected
persons) as at 31 December 2018:
At 31 December At 31 December
2018 2017
------------ -------------- --------------
K Zhevago1 296,077,944 296,077,944
------------ -------------- --------------
C Mawe 254,309 115,437
------------ -------------- --------------
S Lucas 0 0
------------ -------------- --------------
V Lisovenko 0 0
------------ -------------- --------------
S Lockett 50,000 0
------------ -------------- --------------
B Nacken 20,000 20,000
------------ -------------- --------------
M Reilly 0 0
------------ -------------- --------------
1 Mr Zhevago is interested in these shares as a beneficiary of
The Minco Trust, which is the ultimate shareholder of Fevamotinico
S.a.r.l., which owns 296,077,944 shares in the Company.
Executive Directors and members of the Executive Committee are
encouraged to build up a holding of shares of equivalent value to a
year's salary (in the case of Executive Directors) or six months'
salary (for other members of the Executive Committee). Executives
will be encouraged to retain their vested LTIP shares on an
after-tax basis until the applicable guideline level is achieved.
As at 22 April 2019, being a date not more than one month prior to
the date of notice of AGM, the Executive Directors' shareholdings
are as follows:
Shareholding
requirement Owned Subject to Current shareholding2 Guideline
(% salary) outright performance1 (% salary) met?
---------- ------------ ----------- -------------- --------------------- ---------
K Zhevago 100% 296,077,944 - - Yes
---------- ------------ ----------- -------------- --------------------- ---------
C Mawe 100% 254,309 300,000 99.2% No
---------- ------------ ----------- -------------- --------------------- ---------
1 Performance awards are nil-cost options. Further details of
shares subject to performance are provided below.
2 Based only on shares owned outright at 31 December 2018 and a share price of 194.65 pence.
Details of LTIP awards held by Mr Mawe (which are subject to
performance) are provided below.
Price on
Total at date of Date
At 1 January Granted 31 December award from which Expiry
2018 (2018 award) Exercised Lapsed 2018 (pence) exercisable date
------- ------------ ------------- --------- ------ ------------ -------- ------------ --------
C Mawe 135,0001 135,000 0 0 67 01.01.18 21.04.25
------- ------------ ------------- --------- ------ ------------ -------- ------------ --------
150,0002 150,000 37 01.01.19 25.04.26
------- ------------ ------------- --------- ------ ------------ -------- ------------ --------
150,000 150,000 148.6 01.01.20 04.05.27
------- ------------ ------------- --------- ------ ------------ -------- ------------ --------
Total 300,000
------- ------------ ------------- --------- ------ ------------ -------- ------------ --------
1 This award has vested 100% under the TSR performance condition
described above. At the date of vesting (31 December 2017) the
market price of a share was 293.10 pence.
2 This award has vested 100% under the TSR performance condition
described above. At the date of vesting (31 December 2018) the
market price of a share was 194.65 pence.
With the exception of the reinvestment of the January 2019
special dividend to purchase 3,117 shares for Mr Mawe, there have
been no changes in the interests of the Directors from the end of
the period under review to 22 April 2019. Total outstanding (i.e.
awarded but not yet vested) awards granted under the LTIP as at the
end of 2018 are equivalent to 0.05% of issued share capital.
Exit Payments Made in Year - Audited
No payments for loss of office were paid to or receivable by any
Director or former Director in the financial year.
Payments to Past Directors - Audited
Lucio Genovese retired from the Board on 1 August 2014 and has
subsequently been reappointed on 12 February 2019. In 2018, for his
role as a Non-executive Director of Ferrexpo AG he received a fee
of US$40,000 p.a. Wolfram Kuoni retired from the Board on 28
November 2016 and, in 2018, for his role as the Chairman of
Ferrexpo AG, he received a fee of US$100,000 p.a. No other payments
were made to past Directors in the year.
Percentage Change in CEO Remuneration Compared to Other
Employees
The table below sets out the percentage increase in salary,
taxable benefits and annual bonus for the CEO between 2017 and 2018
compared to that for other employees.
Other
CEO employees1
----------------- --- -----------
Salary 0% 1.9%
----------------- --- -----------
Taxable benefits 0% 0%
----------------- --- -----------
Annual bonus n/a 33.7%
----------------- --- -----------
1 Refers to senior executives.
Relative Importance of Spending on Pay
The table below shows Ferrexpo's dividend and total employee pay
expenditure (this includes pension and variable pay, including STIP
and fair value of LTIP, but not social security) for the financial
years ended 31 December 2017 and 31 December 2018, and the
percentage change.
Year-on-year
US$ million 2018 2017 change
------------------------------- ---- ---- ------------
All-employee remuneration 73 55 32.8%
------------------------------- ---- ---- ------------
Distributions to shareholders1 97 58 65.6%
------------------------------- ---- ---- ------------
1 Includes dividends and share buybacks.
Comparison of Company Performance and Executive Director Pay
The graph below shows the value, at 31 December 2018, of GBP100
invested in Ferrexpo's shares on 31 December 2008 compared with the
current value of the same amount invested in the FTSE 250 and
All-Share indices or in the shares of the LTIP comparator group.
The FTSE 250 and All-Share indices are chosen because Ferrexpo was
a constituent member of the FTSE 250 for most of the period.
HISTORICAL TSR PERFORMANCE
Growth in the value of a hypothetical GBP100 holding over the
ten years to 31 December 2018.
Chief Executive Officer's Pay
US$000 2009 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 2015 2016 2017 2018
-------------------- ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- ------ ------ ------ ------ -----
K Zhevago
-------------------- ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- ------ ------ ------ ------ -----
Single figure total
remuneration 322 341 348 291 243 243 243 243 255 251
-------------------- ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- ------ ------ ------ ------ -----
STIP vesting (% K Zhevago did not participate
max) in the STIP
-------------------- ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- -------------------------------------
LTIP vesting (% K Zhevago did not participate
max) in the LTIP
-------------------- ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- -------------------------------------
Statement of Shareholder Voting
The following table shows the results of the binding vote on the
remuneration policy at the 2017 AGM and the advisory vote on the
2017 Annual Report at the 2018 AGM.
For Against Withheld
----------- --------- --------
No. % No. % No.
--------------------------------------- ---- ----- --- ---- --------
Remuneration policy (at 2017 AGM) 434m 97.4% 12m 2.6% 1.4m
--------------------------------------- ---- ----- --- ---- --------
2017 Annual Report on Remuneration (at
2018 AGM) 483m 98.0% 10m 2.0% 0m
--------------------------------------- ---- ----- --- ---- --------
Other transactions involving Directors are set out in Note 33
(related parties) to the financial statements. This report was
approved by the Board on 22 April 2019.
Signed on behalf of the Board
BERT NACKEN
Chairman of the Remuneration Committee
DIRECTORS' REPORT
Introduction
The Company was incorporated under the name Ferrexpo plc as a
public company limited by shares on 22 April 2005. Ferrexpo plc
listed on the London Stock Exchange in June 2007 and is a member of
the FTSE All-Share Index.
The Directors present their Annual Report on the affairs of the
Group, together with the financial statements and auditors' report,
for the year ended 31 December 2018. There have been no significant
events since the balance sheet date, other than the proposed
dividend disclosed in Note 12 to the financial statements.
Information about the Group's strategy, business model and likely
future developments is included in the Strategic Report on pages 5
to 38.
Information about the use of financial instruments by the Group
is given in Note 26 to the financial statements.
Additional disclosures which are incorporated by reference into
this Directors' Report, including any information required in
accordance with Listing Rule 9.8.4R of the FCA's Listing Rules or
the Act, can be located as set out in the following table:
Page
------------------------------------------ ----------------------------------------------- -----
Capitalised interest and tax relief
(LR 9.8.4 R(1)) See financial statements Note 13 116
------------------------------------------ ----------------------------------------------- -----
Details of long-term incentive
schemes (LR 9.8.4R (4)) Remuneration Report 56-72
------------------------------------------ ----------------------------------------------- -----
See financial statements Note 33. Transactions
with FC Vorskla are considered to be
Contracts of significance (LR contracts of significance under the
9.8.4R (10)) Listing Rules 153
------------------------------------------ ----------------------------------------------- -----
Details of waivers of dividends The employee benefit trust contains -
by shareholders 2.3 million Ferrexpo Ordinary Shares
(LR 9.8.4R (12) and (13)) for satisfying existing and future awards
under management incentive schemes.
A dividend waiver is in place in respect
of these shares
------------------------------------------ ----------------------------------------------- -----
Relationship Agreement with controlling
shareholder
(LR 9.8.4R (14)). Also see Note
33: Related party disclosures Corporate Governance Report 43
------------------------------------------ ----------------------------------------------- -----
Disclosures concerning greenhouse
gas emissions Strategic Report 35
------------------------------------------ ----------------------------------------------- -----
The Group does not hold any derivative
financial instruments. Group policy
on financial instruments is set out
Financial instruments in Note 26 to the financial statements 137
------------------------------------------ ----------------------------------------------- -----
Events since the balance sheet
date See financial statements Note 34 156
------------------------------------------ ----------------------------------------------- -----
Statement of Directors' responsibilities
in respect of the Annual Report
and Accounts Corporate Governance Report 78
------------------------------------------ ----------------------------------------------- -----
Information that fulfils the requirements
of DTR 7.2
(other than DTR 7.2.6) Corporate Governance Report 39
------------------------------------------ ----------------------------------------------- -----
Dividends
Results for the year are set out in the consolidated income
statement on page 93.
The Directors recommend a final dividend of 6.6 US cents per
Ordinary Share. Subject to shareholders approving this
recommendation at the Annual General Meeting ("AGM"), the dividend
will be paid in UK Pounds Sterling on 1 July 2019 to shareholders
on the register at the close of business on 14 June 2019.
Shareholders may receive UK Pounds Sterling dividends by direct
bank transfer, provided that they have notified the Company's
registrars in advance. Shareholders may also elect to receive
dividends in US Dollars (the procedure for this is set out in the
Notice of the AGM).
In recognition of the progress made by the business in 2018, the
Directors have also announced a special dividend of 6.6 US cents
per share for payment on 14 May 2019 to shareholders on the
register at the close of business on 3 May 2019. The dividend will
similarly be paid in UK Pounds Sterling with an election to receive
US Dollars.
Directors
The Directors of the Company who served during the year and up
to the date of signing were:
-- Vitalii Lisovenko
-- Simon Lockett (retired 28 January 2019)
-- Steve Lucas
-- Chris Mawe
-- Bert Nacken
-- Mary Reilly
-- Kostyantin Zhevago
-- Lucio Genovese (appointed 12 February 2019)
All of the Directors will retire at the forthcoming AGM and,
being eligible, will offer themselves for re-election.
Details of the remuneration of the Directors, their interests in
shares of the Company and their service contracts are contained in
the Remuneration Report on pages 56 to 72.
Appointment and Replacement of Directors
Directors may be elected by the shareholders (by ordinary
resolution) or appointed by the Board. A Director appointed by the
Board holds office only until the next AGM and is then eligible for
election by the shareholders.
Powers of the Directors
Subject to the Articles, the Act and any directions given by
special resolution, the business of the Company will be managed by
the Board who may exercise all the powers of the Company.
Directors' and Officers' Insurance
The Company maintains Directors' and Officers' Liability
Insurance in respect of legal action that may be brought against
its Directors and Officers.
Directors' Indemnity Provision
During the period under review, the Group had in force a
qualifying third-party indemnity provision in favour of each of the
Directors of Ferrexpo plc against liability in respect of
proceedings brought by third parties, subject to the conditions set
out in the Act.
Disclosures Required by Statute
Employees
Information on the Group's employment policies can be found in
the Strategic Report on pages 32-33. Employee numbers are stated in
Note 28 to the financial statements. The Group employs fewer than
250 staff in the United Kingdom and so does not disclose its
policies on employee involvement or employing disabled people.
However, it will give fair consideration to applications for
employment from disabled people.
Political Donations
The Group made no political donations during the year.
Share Capital and Rights Attaching to the Company's Shares
The Company has a single class of Ordinary Shares of 10 pence
each.
Subject to applicable statutes and other shareholders' rights,
shares may be issued with such rights and restrictions as the
Company may by ordinary resolution decide, or (if there is no such
resolution or so far as it does not make specific provision) as the
Board may decide. At each AGM, the Board proposes to put in place
annual shareholder authority for the Company's Directors to allot
new shares in accordance with relevant institutional investor
guidelines.
Details of the issued share capital of the Company are shown in
Note 30 to the financial statements.
Variation of Rights
Subject to the provisions of the Act, the rights attached to a
class of shares may be varied or abrogated either with the consent
in writing of the holders of at least three-quarters of the nominal
amount of the issued shares of that class (excluding any shares of
that class held as treasury shares) or with the sanction of a
special resolution passed at a separate meeting of the holders of
the issued shares of that class validly held in accordance with the
Articles.
Transfer of Shares
Any share in the Company may be held in uncertificated form and,
subject to the Articles, title to uncertificated shares may be
transferred by means of a relevant system. Registration of a
transfer of an uncertificated share may be refused in the
circumstances set out in the Uncertificated Securities Regulations
2001 and where, in the case of a transfer to joint holders, the
number of joint holders to whom the uncertificated share is to be
transferred exceeds four.
Subject to the Articles, any member may transfer all or any of
his certificated shares by an instrument of transfer in any usual
form or in any other form which the Board may approve. The Board
may decline to register a transfer of a certificated share if it is
not in the approved form. The Board may also decline to register
any transfer of any share which is not a fully paid share. The
Board may decline to register a transfer of any of the Company's
certificated shares by a person with a 0.25% or greater interest if
such a person has been served with a notice and has failed within
14 days to provide the Company with information concerning
interests in those shares required to be provided under the Act,
unless the transfer is shown to the Board to be pursuant to an
arm's length sale.
The Company is not aware of any agreements between holders of
securities that may result in restrictions on the transfer of
securities or that may result in restrictions on voting rights.
Repurchase of Shares
Subject to authorisation by shareholder resolution, the Company
may purchase its own shares in accordance with the Act. Any shares
which have been bought back may be held as treasury shares or
cancelled immediately upon completion of the purchase.
The Company was given authority to make market purchases of up
to approximately 10% of its existing Ordinary Share capital by a
resolution passed on 25 May 2018. This authority will expire at the
conclusion of the Company's 2019 AGM. A special resolution to renew
the authority will be proposed at the forthcoming AGM. Details of
the resolution renewing the authority to purchase Ordinary Shares
are set out in the Notice of AGM enclosed with this report.
The Company did not make use of the authority mentioned above
during 2018.
Dividends and Distributions
Subject to the provisions of the Act, the shareholders may by
ordinary resolution, from time to time, declare dividends not
exceeding the amount recommended by the Board. The Board may pay
interim dividends and also any fixed rate dividends whenever the
financial position of the Group, in the opinion of the Board,
justifies their payment.
Under the Company's Articles, the Board may withhold payment of
all or any part of any dividends or other monies payable in respect
of the Company's shares from a person with a 0.25% or greater
interest (as defined in the Articles) if such person has been
served with a notice under section 793 of the Companies Act 2006
and has failed within 14 days to provide the Company with
information concerning interests in those shares required to be
provided under the Act.
Voting
At a general meeting of the Company, every member has one vote
on a show of hands and, on a poll, one vote for each share held.
Under the Act, members are entitled to appoint a proxy or proxies
to exercise all or any of their rights to attend, speak and vote at
a general meeting. A member that is a corporation may appoint one
or more individuals to act on its behalf at a general meeting as a
corporate representative.
Restrictions on Voting
No member is entitled to vote at any general meeting in respect
of any shares held by him if any call or other sum outstanding in
respect of that share remains unpaid. Currently, all issued shares
are fully paid. In addition, subject to the Articles, no member
shall be entitled to vote if he has failed to provide the Company
with information concerning interests in those shares required to
be provided under the Act.
Shares Held in the Employee Benefit Trust ("EBT")
The trustees of the Company's EBT may vote or abstain from
voting on shares held in the EBT as they think fit and in doing so
may take into account both financial and non-financial interests of
the beneficiaries of the EBT or their dependants.
Deadline for Voting Rights
The Articles provide a deadline for submission of proxy forms of
not less than 48 hours before the meeting. The Directors will also
specify in the notice of any general meeting a time, being not more
than 48 hours before the meeting, by which a person must be entered
in the register of members in order to have the right to attend and
vote at the meeting The Directors may decide, at their discretion,
that no account should be taken of any day that is not a working
day when calculating the 48-hour period.
Substantial Shareholdings
As at 31 December 2018, the Company had been advised, in
accordance with the Disclosure and Transparency Rules, of the
following notifiable interests in its voting rights.
% of the
Company's
Number total voting
Ordinary of voting rights at
Name of shareholder Shares rights date of notification
----------------------- ----------- ----------- ---------------------
Fevamotinico S.a.r.l.1 296,077,944 296,077,944 50.30%
----------------------- ----------- ----------- ---------------------
1 Fevamotinico S.a.r.l. is a wholly owned subsidiary of The
Minco Trust of which Kostyantin Zhevago is a beneficiary.
As at 31 March 2019, the latest practicable date prior to
publication of the Annual Report, no changes in these interests in
voting rights had been notified to the Company.
Significant Agreements - Change of Control
The Company does not have any agreements with Directors or
employees that would provide for compensation for loss of office or
employment resulting from a takeover.
There are no circumstances connected with any other significant
agreements to which the Company is a party that would take effect,
alter or terminate upon a change of control following a takeover
bid, except those referred to below:
LTIP
The rules of the Company's LTIP set out the consequences of a
change of control of the Company on employee rights under the plan.
Generally, such rights will vest on a change of control to the
extent that the performance conditions have been satisfied and on a
time pro-rated basis, subject to the discretion of the Remuneration
Committee. Participants will become entitled to acquire shares in
the Company, or in some cases, to the payment of a cash sum of
equivalent basis.
Bank Loan Facilities
The Group has a facility agreement relating to a Dollar
revolving pre-export finance ("PXF") facility up to US$500 million
(US$400 million of commitments) with BNP Paribas, Deutsche Bank and
other banks entered into in November 2017 and amended and restated
in November 2018, if Kostyantin Zhevago ceases to own directly or
indirectly at least 30% of the issued and allotted share capital of
the Company, or any person (other than Kostyantin Zhevago) becomes
the beneficial owner of shares in the Company carrying more than
50% of the voting rights normally exercisable at a general meeting,
then the lenders are not obliged to fund a drawdown and a lender
may upon notice cancel its commitment and declare the amount owing
to it immediately due and payable. As at 31 December 2018, US$195
million of the facility were drawn.
As of 31 December 2018, total committed PXF facilities available
were US$400 million, of which US$195 million had been drawn under
the 2017 facility.
Corporate Bonds Due 2018 and 2019
Under the conditions of the Notes issued in February and July
2015, if Kostyantin Zhevago or certain related persons ceases to
own directly or indirectly at least 30% of the issued and allotted
share capital of the Company; if any person (other than Kostyantin
Zhevago or certain related persons) becomes the beneficial owner of
shares in the Company carrying more than 50% of the voting rights
normally exercisable at a general meeting; or if the allotted share
capital of the Company ceases to be listed on certain approved
markets, then any Noteholder will have the right to require the
repurchase of its Notes at a purchase price in cash equal to 101%
of the principal amount plus accrued and unpaid interest.
Relationship Agreement
Details of the Relationship Agreement entered into between
Fevamotinico S.a.r.l., Kostyantin Zhevago, The Minco Trust and the
Company can be found in the Corporate Governance Report (page 43).
The Relationship Agreement ceases to apply if Ferrexpo's shares
cease to be listed and traded on the London Stock Exchange, or if
the holding of Fevamotinico S.a.r.l., The Minco Trust or Mr Zhevago
individually or collectively falls below 24.9% of the issued share
capital of the Company and they are no longer a controlling
shareholder for the purposes of the UK Listing Rules.
Going Concern
The Group's business activities, together with the risk factors
likely to affect its future development, performance and position,
are set out on pages 16 to 27. The Viability Statement is set out
in the Strategic Report on page 28. The financial position of the
Group, its cash flows, liquidity position and borrowing facilities
are described in the Performance Review on pages 7 to 12. In
addition, Note 26 of the notes to the consolidated financial
statements on pages 137 to 145 sets out the Group's objectives,
policies and processes for managing its capital; its financial risk
management objectives and details of its financial instruments; its
exposure to credit risk, liquidity risk, as well as currency risk
and interest rate risk.
The Group has assessed that, taking into account: i) its
available cash and cash equivalents available at the date of
authorisation of the consolidated financial statements; ii) its
cash flow projections for the period of management's going concern
assessment; and iii) events and conditions beyond the period of
management's going concern assessment, it has sufficient liquidity
to meet its present obligations and cover working capital needs for
the aforementioned period and will remain in compliance with its
financial covenants throughout this period. Therefore, the Group
continues to adopt the going concern basis of accounting for the
preparation of this set of financial statements.
Statement on Disclosure of Information to Auditors
The Directors who held office at the date of approval of this
Directors' Report confirm that, so far as they are each aware,
there is no relevant audit information (as defined in the Act) of
which the Group's auditors are unaware, and that each Director has
taken all steps that he/she ought to have taken as a Director in
order to make himself/herself aware of any relevant audit
information (as defined) and to establish that the Group's auditors
are aware of that information.
Amendments to Articles of Association
The Articles may be amended by special resolution in accordance
with the Act.
AGM
The AGM of the Company will be held at 11.00am on 7 June 2019 at
The Great Hall, J.P. Morgan, 60 Victoria Embankment, London EC4Y
0JP. A separate letter from the Chairman summarising the business
of the meeting and the Notice convening the AGM will be sent to
shareholders with this Annual Report.
The Strategic Report on pages 4 to 38 and this Directors' Report
have been drawn up and presented in accordance with, and in
reliance upon, applicable English company law, and any liability of
the Directors in connection with these reports shall be subject to
the limitations and restrictions provided by such law.
The Directors' Report was approved by the Board on 22 April
2019.
For and on behalf of the Board
Steve Lucas
Chairman
STATEMENT OF DIRECTORS' RESPONSIBILITIES
Statement by the Directors under the UK Corporate Governance
Code
The Directors are responsible for preparing the Annual Report
and the financial statements in accordance with applicable law and
regulations.
Company law requires the Directors to prepare such financial
statements for each financial year. Under that law the Directors
are required to prepare the Group financial statements in
accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards
("IFRS") as adopted by the European Union and Article 4 of the IAS
Regulation, and have also chosen to prepare the Parent Company
financial statements in accordance with Financial Reporting
Standard 101 (Reduced Disclosure Framework). Under company law the
Directors must not approve the financial statements unless they are
satisfied that they give a true and fair view of the state of
affairs of the Group and the Parent Company and of their profit or
loss for that period.
In preparing the Parent Company financial statements, the
Directors are required to:
-- select suitable accounting policies and then apply them consistently;
-- make judgements and estimates that are reasonable and prudent;
-- state whether Financial Reporting Standard 101 (Reduced
Disclosure Framework) has been followed, subject to any material
departures disclosed and explained in the financial statements;
and
-- prepare the financial statements on the going concern basis
unless it is inappropriate to presume that the Company will
continue in business.
In preparing the Group financial statements, International
Accounting Standard 1 requires that the Directors:
-- properly select and apply accounting policies;
-- present information, including accounting policies, in a
manner that provides relevant, reliable, comparable and
understandable information;
-- provide additional disclosures when compliance with the
specific requirements in IFRSs is insufficient to enable users to
understand the impact of particular transactions, other events and
conditions on the entity's financial position and financial
performance; and
-- make an assessment of the Group's ability to continue as a going concern.
The Directors are responsible for keeping adequate accounting
records that are sufficient to show and explain the Parent
Company's transactions and disclose with reasonable accuracy at any
time the financial position of the Parent Company and enable them
to ensure that its financial statements comply with the Companies
Act 2006. They are also responsible for safeguarding the assets of
the Group and hence for taking reasonable steps for the prevention
and detection of fraud and other irregularities.
The Directors are responsible for the maintenance and integrity
of the corporate and financial information included on the
Company's website. Legislation in the United Kingdom governing the
preparation and dissemination of financial statements may differ
from legislation in other jurisdictions.
Responsibility Statement of the Directors in Respect of the
Annual Report and Accounts
We confirm that to the best of our knowledge:
(a) the financial statements, prepared in accordance with
applicable accounting standards, give a true and fair view of the
assets, liabilities, financial position and profit or loss of the
Company and the undertakings included in the consolidation taken as
a whole; and
(b) the Strategic Report includes a fair review of the
development and performance of the business and the position of the
Company and the undertakings included in the consolidation taken as
a whole, together with a description of the principal risks and
uncertainties that they face; and
(c) the Annual Report and financial statements, taken as a
whole, are fair, balanced and understandable and provide the
information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group's
position and performance, business model and strategy.
The Directors' Report (including Corporate Governance Report)
comprises the information on pages 38 - 77.
This responsibility statement was approved by the Board of
Directors on 22 April 2019 and is signed on its behalf by:
Steve Lucas
Chairman
Chris Mawe
Chief Financial Officer
22 April 2019
INDEPENT AUDITOR'S REPORT
TO THE MEMBERS OF FERREXPO PLC
Report on the audit of the financial statements
Qualified opinion
In our opinion, except for the possible effects of the matters
described in the basis for qualified opinion section of our
report:
-- the financial statements give a true and fair view of the
state of Ferrexpo plc (the 'Parent Company') and its subsidiaries
(together the 'Group') affairs as at 31 December 2018 and of the
Group's profit for the year then ended;
-- the Group financial statements have been properly prepared in
accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRSs)
as adopted by the European Union;
-- the Parent Company financial statements have been properly
prepared in accordance with United Kingdom Generally Accepted
Accounting Practice including Financial Reporting Standard 101
"Reduced Disclosure Framework"; and
-- the financial statements have been prepared in accordance
with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006 and, as regards the
Group financial statements, Article 4 of the IAS Regulation.
We have audited the financial statements which comprise:
-- the consolidated income statement;
-- the consolidated statement of comprehensive income;
-- the consolidated and Parent Company statements of financial position;
-- the consolidated and Parent Company statement of cash flows;
-- the consolidated and Parent Company statement of changes in equity;
-- the related consolidated notes 1 to 34; and
-- the related Parent Company notes 1 to 8.
The financial reporting framework that has been applied in the
preparation of the Group financial statements is applicable law and
IFRSs as adopted by the European Union. The financial reporting
framework that has been applied in the preparation of the Parent
Company financial statements is applicable law and United Kingdom
Accounting Standards, including FRS 101 "Reduced Disclosure
Framework" (United Kingdom Generally Accepted Accounting
Practice).
Basis for qualified opinion
We have been unable to obtain satisfactory audit evidence or
explanations in respect of the following matters:
1. Corporate Social Responsibility ('CSR') donations advanced to
Blooming Land Charitable Foundation ("Blooming Land")
We have been unable to obtain satisfactory audit evidence or
explanations to conclude whether the USD 9.5 million of CSR
donations advanced to Blooming Land in the year ended 31 December
2018, and USD 24.0 million in the year ended 31 December 2017, was
expended by Blooming Land on legitimate business payments for
charitable purposes. The directors suspended payments to Blooming
Land in May 2018. The cumulative CSR payments made to Blooming Land
by the Group since 2013 total approximately $110 million. Depending
on the nature of any misappropriation or misapplication that might
or might not emerge and is concluded on, the risk is that the
Group's financial statements i) might not fairly present the nature
of the expenditures made; ii) might omit liabilities for any
related breaches of laws and regulations involving the Group;
and/or iii) might omit related party or other disclosures that
ought to have been made.
In August 2018, Deloitte received from Blooming Land additional
copy bank statements and inconsistencies were identified between
those and copy bank statements received previously in July 2018,
which raised concerns as to the credibility and reliability of all
other information and documentation previously provided by Blooming
Land. To date, Blooming Land has not provided the original or
certified copy bank statements to Ferrexpo, citing confidentiality
constraints. Blooming Land has provided explanations for these
inconsistencies, including the cyber-attacks against Ukrainian
financial institutions in June 2017 which they stated caused these
irregularities in the copy bank statement data. Our knowledge of
the effects of the cyber-attack on other companies and the systems
by which bank statements are generated raised concerns whether
these explanations are credible.
In relation to the direct donations of materials reported by
Blooming Land as having been made to institutions in Ukraine, we
received cost breakdowns and source documents supporting the stated
expenditure for a sample selected by us but Blooming Land has not
provided the requested details of the recipient parties or any
supporting documents evidencing receipt by them.
In the final quarter of 2018, we identified from public records
in Ukraine that certain criminal legal proceedings have been
launched in Ukraine under which Blooming Land has been directed by
the relevant court to provide documents.
We reported all of these concerns to the board of directors and
our recommendation that an independent forensic investigation be
launched. In February 2019, the Group established an Independent
Review Committee (IRC) with the mandate set out on page 46, which
includes reviewing the discrepancies in the copy bank statements;
gaining assurance over the ultimate use of funds donated to
Blooming Land; reviewing the relationship between Blooming Land and
Khimreaktiv (an entity controlled by the Group's CEO); whether
significant influence or control over Blooming Land exists; and the
extent of any potential legal or regulatory exposures. The IRC
commissioned an independent forensic investigation (referred to as
an Independent Review by the Company) led by legal counsel in the
UK and Ukraine and independent forensic accountants.
The forensic investigation is ongoing, such that the
inconsistencies in the copy bank statements provided by Blooming
Land are not yet resolved. Further, the independent forensic
accountant has identified discrepancies with regard to the
application of funds by the Blooming Land and there are indications
from their work to date that some element of the funds could have
been misappropriated. As noted on page 47, the IRC has noted that
they cannot conclude as to the ultimate use of all of the funds and
that there are indications that some could have been
misappropriated and accordingly we are also unable to conclude as
to the ultimate use of all the funds by Blooming Land and whether
the Group's payments to Blooming Land are appropriately presented
and disclosed.
2. Whether Blooming Land is a related party of the Group
The directors have reached an interim conclusion that neither
the Group, nor its CEO and majority shareholder, have significant
influence or control over Blooming Land. In reaching this
conclusion the directors have considered the relationship of the
CEO with Blooming Land, including the CEO's business network, and
have placed reliance on the CEO's representation, as set out on
page 47 that he believes that he does not. Were this to be
otherwise, Blooming Land would be a related party of the Group.
The investigation into Blooming Land has identified a
significant number of potential associations and linkages adjacent
to the CEO. Whilst not individually definitive, when taken together
with other factors, including the multiple capacities in which the
Group's CEO could interact with Blooming Land (including as CEO of
Ferrexpo, but also as a principal for Khimreaktiv and the
controlling shareholder in Ferrexpo), we did not consider that we
had obtained sufficient appropriate audit evidence to conclude
whether the Group CEO did not hold significant influence, held
significant influence or exercised control. Accordingly we are
unable to conclude whether the associated related party transaction
disclosures are complete and accurate for the current and prior
periods.
Had we been able to obtain sufficient appropriate evidence in
respect of the above matters, adjustments might have been necessary
to the financial information and disclosures for the years ended 31
December 2018 and 31 December 2017.
We conducted our audit in accordance with International
Standards on Auditing (UK) (ISAs (UK)) and applicable law. Our
responsibilities under those standards are further described in the
auditor's responsibilities for the audit of the financial
statements section of our report.
We are independent of the Group and the Parent Company in
accordance with the ethical requirements that are relevant to our
audit of the financial statements in the UK, including the FRC's
Ethical Standard as applied to listed public interest entities, and
we have fulfilled our other ethical responsibilities in accordance
with these requirements. We confirm that the non-audit services
prohibited by the FRC's Ethical Standard were not provided to the
Group or the Parent Company.
We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is
sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for our qualified
opinion.
Summary of our audit approach
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Key audit matters The key audit matters that we identified in the current
year were:
* CSR payments and whether Blooming Land is a related
party of the Group (see basis for qualified opinion
section above)
* Related party disclosure (other than in relation to
Blooming Land)
* Management override of controls
* Taxation - transfer pricing
Our assessment of the Group's key audit matters is consistent
with 2017, except for;
i) the inclusion of management override of controls
due to the matters and uncertainties noted in the basis
for qualified opinion above; and
ii) the taxation key audit matter now only relates to
transfer pricing due to a further reduction in the probability
of a previously unrecognised deferred tax asset being
recorded.
----------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------
Materiality The materiality that we used for the Group financial
statements was USD 18.1 million which was determined
as 5% of the three-year average of profit before tax
and special items.
Performance materiality was set at 50% of materiality.
----------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------
Scoping We utilised Deloitte global member firms ("Component
Auditors") to report on the operations of the assessed
components, comprising the three mining and processing
entities in Ukraine and the Swiss and Middle East marketing
companies.
Our audit scope results in all major operations of the
Group being subject to audit work, covering in excess
of 99% of the Group's revenue, 94% of the Group's profit
before tax and 94% of the net assets.
----------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------
Revisions to As a result of the matters and uncertainties noted in
our planned the basis for qualified opinion, as required by International
audit approach Standards on Auditing (UK), we performed a reassessment
of our audit risks and approach, including fraud risks.
Following which:
i) we involved Deloitte forensic specialists in our
audit to review the scope and independence of the Independent
Review, and to assist in our analysis of its findings
and conclusions. These specialists also supported us
in performing due diligence procedures over certain
counterparties identified during the audit;
ii) additional specific procedures were performed, in
particular in relation to the risk areas of related
parties and management override as outlined in the relevant
Key Audit Matters section of this report;
iii) the extent of existing procedures were increased
through reducing performance materiality of the group
and components;
iv) the group scoping was revised with previously out
of scope entities being subject to additional specified
procedures in relation to their external revenue balance;
v) we performed a reassessment over our work on controls
with particular emphasis on management review controls
over significant account balances;
vi) we changed our overall audit approach such that
we no longer place any reliance on controls and adopted
a fully substantive audit; and
vii) we performed increased procedures on capitalisation
of expenditure and certain expenses accounts including
evaluating the business need and pricing for the services
obtained and obtained audit evidence for the receipt
of the underlying goods or service.
Conclusions relating to going concern, principal risks and viability
statement
-------------------------------------------------------------------- ------------------
Going concern We confirm that
We have reviewed the directors' statement in note 2 we have nothing
to the financial statements about whether they considered material to
it appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of accounting report, add
in preparing them and their identification of any material or draw attention
uncertainties to the Group's and company's ability to to in respect
continue to do so over a period of at least twelve months of these matters.
from the date of approval of the financial statements.
We considered as part of our risk assessment the nature
of the group, its business model and related risks including
where relevant the impact of Brexit, the requirements
of the applicable financial reporting framework and
the system of internal control. We evaluated the directors'
assessment of the group's ability to continue as a going
concern, including challenging the underlying data and
key assumptions used to make the assessment, the directors'
assessment of forecast covenant compliance and evaluated
the directors' plans for future actions in relation
to their going concern assessment.
We are required to state whether we have anything material
to add or draw attention to in relation to that statement
required by Listing Rule 9.8.6R(3) and report if the
statement is materially inconsistent with our knowledge
obtained in the audit.
-------------------------------------------------------------------- ------------------
Principal risks and viability statement We confirm that
Based solely on reading the directors' statements and we have nothing
considering whether they were consistent with the knowledge material to
we obtained in the course of the audit, including the report, add
knowledge obtained in the evaluation of the directors' or draw attention
assessment of the Group's and the company's ability to in respect
to continue as a going concern, we are required to state of these matters.
whether we have anything material to add or draw attention
to in relation to:
* the disclosures on pages 19-27 that describe the
principal risks and explain how they are being
managed or mitigated;
* the directors' confirmation on page 28 that they have
carried out a robust assessment of the principal
risks facing the Group, including those that would
threaten its business model, future performance,
solvency or liquidity; or
* the directors' explanation on page 28 as to how they
have assessed the prospects of the Group, over what
period they have done so and why they consider that
period to be appropriate, and their statement as to
whether they have a reasonable expectation that the
Group will be able to continue in operation and meet
its liabilities as they fall due over the period of
their assessment, including any related disclosures
drawing attention to any necessary qualifications or
assumptions.
We are also required to report whether the directors'
statement relating to the prospects of the Group required
by Listing Rule 9.8.6R(3) is materially inconsistent
with our knowledge obtained in the audit.
-------------------------------------------------------------------- ------------------
Key audit matters
Key audit matters are those matters that, in our professional
judgement, were of most significance in our audit of the financial
statements of the current period and include the most significant
assessed risks of material misstatement (whether or not due to
fraud) that we identified. These matters included those which had
the greatest effect on: the overall audit strategy, the allocation
of resources in the audit; and directing the efforts of the
engagement team.
These matters were addressed in the context of our audit of the
financial statements as a whole, and in forming our opinion
thereon, and we do not provide a separate opinion on these
matters.
In addition to the matters described in the basis for qualified
opinion section, we have determined the matters described below to
be the key audit matters to be communicated in our report.
Related party disclosure (other than in relation to Blooming Land)
------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Key audit matter The Group enters into a substantial number of related party
description transactions and has reported an expense of USD 48.1 million
and other income of USD 1.0 million, of which USD 27.7
million and USD 0.9 million respectively relates to transactions
with counterparties that are controlled by the Group's
majority shareholder and CEO.
Our risk assessment and audit approach reflected the matters
and uncertainties set out in the basis for qualified opinion,
including the limitation of scope in relation to whether
the Group's CEO and majority shareholder has significant
influence or control over Blooming Land, and the previously
unreported related party transaction in the year ended
31 December 2017 which was identified and disclosed during
the Interim review for the six months ended 30 June 2018
as set out in note 33.
There was therefore considered to be a key audit matter
due to the heightened risk of undisclosed related party
transactions and transactions entered into that are not
transacted on an arm's length basis and not disclosed as
such. This risk was considered greatest in the Ukrainian
operations because of the developing regulatory environment.
Refer to Key Estimates and Critical Judgements section
in the Report of the Audit Committee on page 50. The related
party disclosures are set out in note 33 to the Financial
Statements and the Company's controls and processes are
described in the Report of the Audit Committee on page
51.
---------------- ------------------------------------------------------------------
How the scope We reviewed and evaluated management's process for identifying
of our audit and recording related party transactions and reviewed the
responded to design and implementation of management's controls around
the key audit the approval of related party transactions both at the
matter level of the Group and the individual entities.
We challenged the adequacy of the Company's processes and
controls in this area and its response to the previously
unreported related party transaction.
We reviewed the minutes of meetings of the Board of Directors
and relevant sub-committees to assess whether there are
any new related party transactions entered into in 2018
that are significant or outside the normal course of business.
We used forensic tools to profile the counterparties for
all transactions entered into by Ferrexpo in Ukraine during
2018 in order to identify those of greatest audit interest.
For these 128 and the 6 new counterparties in the year
we performed detailed background checks using forensic
experts in the UK and Ukraine to assist in the design and
execution of our audit procedures.
We performed independent searches of the CEO and majority
shareholder's other business interests to test the completeness
of the related party list.
We obtained the list of related parties confirmed by the
Board of Directors and did not identify any counterparties
on the list which were not included in the related party
disclosures.
We reviewed an increased sample of underlying contracts
to understand the nature and commerciality of any new or
significant related party transactions and assessed whether
they are executed on arm's length basis.
In relation to the $10.7 million paid for the sponsorship
of FC Vorskla, which is wholly owned by the Group's CEO
and majority shareholder, we have benchmarked the amounts
paid versus the commercial income of other football clubs
in Ukraine. In relation to the $9 million of this amount,
which is paid to FC Vorskla Cyprus, an entity owned by
a trust in turn controlled by the Group's CEO, we saw a
confirmation from a representative of the football club
confirming the use of funds.
We reviewed disclosure of related party balances and transactions
to determine whether they were in compliance with IAS 24.
---------------- ------------------------------------------------------------------
Key observations With the exception of the matters discussed in the basis
for qualified opinion section above, the results of
our testing were satisfactory and we concur that the
related party transactions and balances are appropriately
disclosed in the financial statements.
---------------- ------------------------------------------------------------------
Management override of controls
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Key audit matter In accordance with ISA 240 (UK) management override is
description presumed to be a significant risk. The ability to override
controls puts management in a unique position to perpetrate
or conceal the effects of fraud. This may take a number
of forms such as falsifying accounting entries in order
to conceal misappropriation of assets or other manipulation
of accounting entries intended to result in the production
of financial statements which give a misleading view of
the entity's financial position or performance.
We assessed an increased potential management override
risk, as a result of the matters and uncertainties noted
in the basis for qualified opinion, in relation to the
purchase to pay controls, which we considered to be the
most pervasive risk area for misappropriation of assets
and undisclosed or non-commercial related party transactions,
and overstatement of reported profit by manipulation of
key estimates or journal entries. Related party disclosure
was also assessed as a separate key audit matter.
---------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------
How the scope As a result of the increased potential management override
of our audit risk, we have performed the following procedures (in addition
responded to to other specific procedures performed which are outlined
the key audit in the other Key Audit Matters and basis of qualified opinion
matter section of this report):
* We performed an account balance by account balance
review for all operating and capital payments, to
determine balances where substantive analytical
procedures are no longer appropriate and supplemented
those procedures with tests of detail. We also
deliberately increased unpredictability in our audit
procedures. We increased our testing over the nature
of legal, consultancy and agency spend given the
higher fraud risk that exists for these balances. We
increased our reliance on directly obtained third
party evidence, such as direct revenue and debt
confirmation and reduced our reliance on management
representations.
* We increased unpredictability in our audit procedures
surrounding the testing of journal entries by
reassessing the selection criteria we applied in our
data analytics tools as a result of our revised risk
assessment. This included additional risk
characteristics reflecting the CSR payments such as
the updated related party list and searching for
additional keywords of interest resulting in
additional samples being substantively tested.
* We held additional discussions with a broader range
of senior management, being the Chief Operating
Officer and Chief Marketing officer, Group legal
counsel and with lower level operational management
throughout the organisation and at different levels
and in different functions, including the chief
geologist, mine planner, head of production, chief
surveyor and accounts payable clerks to identify if
they are aware of any instances of override of
controls.
* We evaluated the design and implementation of key
controls including, in particular high level
management review controls and controls over purchase
to pay procurement processes, as part of our risk
assessment.
* We reviewed internal audit reports to help identify
significant control deficiencies and the whistle
blower reports for any actual or suspected
non-compliance with controls.
* We changed our overall audit approach such that we no
longer place any reliance on the operating
effectiveness of controls and adopted a fully
substantive audit with no control reliance approach.
In line with the initial audit plan, prior to the reassessment
of audit approach, we also performed the following in order
to address the risk of management override:
* We tested the appropriateness of journal entries and
other adjustments recorded in the general ledger and
other adjustments in the preparation of the financial
statements;
* We evaluated whether the judgments and decisions made
in determining the accounting estimates included in
the financial statements, even if they are
individually reasonable, indicate a possible bias on
the part of the entity's management that may
represent a risk of material misstatement due to
fraud; and
* We evaluated the business rationale for significant
transactions that are outside the normal course of
the business for the entity.
* We held discussions with the Audit Committee, senior
management and internal audit regarding the risk of
fraud, effectiveness of key oversight controls and
any fraud or suspected fraud identified during the
year.
---------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------
Key observations We did not identify any instances of management override
of controls.
---------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------
Taxation - transfer pricing
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Key audit matter The Group prices its sales between its subsidiaries using
description international benchmark prices for comparable products
covering product quality and applicable freight. The Group
judge these to be on terms which comply with applicable
legislation. In August 2017, the State Fiscal Service of
Ukraine ("SFS") commenced a tax audit at the Group's major
subsidiary in Ukraine with a focus on cross-border transactions
in terms of its pellet sales to another subsidiary of the
Group for the years 2013-2015.
The SFS issued its official tax audit report to the Group
on 27 December 2018 with a claim representing a total exposure
of $16.2 million.
The Group submitted its objection to the SFS findings on
25 January 2019. The SFS rejected management's responses
on 11 March 2019 and management intend to initiate legal
proceedings.
Ferrexpo assessed the risk of loss in relation to the claim
as possible and has accordingly disclosed, rather than
provided for, the $16.2 million. The Group evaluated the
risk of further claims being received in respect of other
entities or additional years, concluding that such exposure
was remote.
Significant judgement is required in applying the transfer
pricing rules and in determining the probability of any
loss in connection with the Ukrainian tax audit and therefore
this has been identified as a key audit matter.
This matter is described in note 11 to the Financial Statements.
The taxation disclosure including accounting policies and
description of key sources of estimation uncertainty are
set in Note 11 and considered by the Audit Committee on
page 50 of the annual report.
---------------- -----------------------------------------------------------------
How the scope We involved tax specialists in Ukraine to assess appropriateness
of our audit of the transfer pricing policies and documentation in
responded to place prepared by management.
the key audit
matter On a sample basis, we verified the calculation of prices
for transactions that occurred in 2018 to be in line
with the transfer pricing policy.
We reviewed the arguments set out in the statement of
claim and underlying calculations, other correspondence
with the SFS and the calculations of the assessed risk
with assistance from UK tax and transfer pricing specialists.
In addition, we have reviewed recent similar cases in
Ukraine and the results of court proceedings.
We reviewed the disclosure of these taxation balances
to determine whether they were in compliance with IAS
12.
---------------- -----------------------------------------------------------------
Key observations The results of our testing were satisfactory and we
concur that the tax provisions and disclosures are appropriate.
---------------- -----------------------------------------------------------------
Our application of materiality
We define materiality as the magnitude of misstatement in the
financial statements that makes it probable that the economic
decisions of a reasonably knowledgeable person would be changed or
influenced. We use materiality both in planning the scope of our
audit work and in evaluating the results of our work.
Based on our professional judgement, we determined materiality
for the financial statements as a whole as follows:
Group financial statements Parent Company
financial statements
--------------------- ---------------------------------------------------- ---------------------
Materiality USD 18.1 million (2017: USD 16.5 million) USD 15.8 million
(2017: USD 14.4
million)
--------------------- ---------------------------------------------------- ---------------------
Basis for determining We have determined materiality by using 1.5% of Parent
materiality 5% of a three-year average (2016 - 2018) Company's net
of profit before tax and special items. assets (2017:
There were no special items in 2018 or 2017. 1.5%)
In the 2016 they comprised USD 2.5 million
of inventory, property, plant and equipment,
receivables and prepayments and other write
offs and USD 8.5 million of allowance for
the Bank Finance & Credit restricted cash
balance.
In 2017 we used 5% of a two-year average
(2016 - 2017) of profit before tax and special
items in determining our materiality.
--------------------- ---------------------------------------------------- ---------------------
Rationale for The profit before tax for the years 2016-2018 We consider
the benchmark has been normalised in determining materiality the chosen benchmark
applied to exclude items which, due to their variable to be appropriate
financial impact and/or expected infrequency due to the nature
of the underlying events, are not considered of company's
indicative of continuing operations of the operations being
Group. These items do not form part of the a holding company
Group's internally or externally monitored of the Group.
primary key performance indicators, and
which if included, would distort materiality
year-on-year.
We consider this approach of using a three-year
average to be more appropriate than an assessment
based on current year results alone given
the nature of the mining industry which
is exposed to cyclical commodity price fluctuations
and to therefore provide a more stable base
reflective of the scale of the Group's size
and operations. We extended to a three-year
average in 2018 following benchmarking to
peer companies.
--------------------- ---------------------------------------------------- ---------------------
We set our 2018 performance materiality of $9m (2017: $11.5m) at
a level lower than materiality to reduce the probability that, in
aggregate, uncorrected and undetected misstatements exceed the
materiality for the financial statements as a whole. In determining
performance materiality, we considered the increased risk arising
from the CSR payments to Blooming Land and the subsequent
investigation. Group performance materiality therefore is set at
50% of group materiality for the 2018 audit (2017: 70%).
We agreed with the Audit Committee that we would report to them
all audit differences in excess of USD 900,000 (2017: USD 825,000)
for the Group as well as differences below that threshold that, in
our view, warranted reporting on qualitative grounds. We also
report to the Audit Committee on disclosure matters that we
identified when assessing the overall presentation of the financial
statements.
An overview of the scope of our audit
Our Group audit was scoped by obtaining an understanding of the
Group and the Parent Company and their environments, including
internal control, and assessing the risks of material misstatement.
The Group's parent entity and finance company are UK based, while
the head office and marketing companies are based in Switzerland
and the primary mining operations are located in Ukraine.
As a result of the matters and uncertainties noted in the basis
for qualified opinion, we performed an extensive reassessment of
our audit and fraud risks following which:
i) we involved Deloitte forensic specialists in our audit to
review the scope and independence of the Independent Review, and to
perform analysis of its findings and conclusions. These specialists
also supported us in performing due diligence procedures over
certain counterparties identified during the audit;
ii) additional specific procedures were performed, in particular
in relation to the risk areas of related parties and management
override as outlined in the relevant Key Audit Matters section of
this report;
iii) the extent of existing procedures were increased through
reducing performance materiality of the group and components;
iv) the group scoping was revised with previously out of scope
entities such as the bunkering and logistics operations being
subject to additional specified procedures in relation to their
external revenue balance;
v) we performed a reassessment over controls with particular
emphasis on management review controls over significant account
balances.
vi) we changed our overall audit approach such that we no longer
place any reliance on controls and adopted a fully substantive
audit;
vii) we performed increased procedures on capitalisation and
certain expenses accounts including evaluating the business need
and pricing for the services obtained and obtained audit evidence
for the receipt of the underlying goods or service.
Considering operational and financial performance and risk
factors, we focussed our assessment on the significant components
and performed full scope audits of the Ukrainian FPM and FYM
components and Ferrexpo plc entity along with specified group level
audit procedures on the material external balances at the Swiss
marketing entities FAG and FME (being revenue and receivables), the
non-operating Ukrainian FBM component, Ferrexpo Finance plc and for
the first time the Bunkering and Logistics businesses. Our full
scope and specified audit procedures cover revenue (in excess of
99% of Group total), profit before tax (94% of Group total) and net
assets (94% of Group total).
The remaining 21 components represent a 9% reduction of the
Group's profit before tax and individually do not represent more
than a 3% reduction of the Group's profit before tax.
The work performed by the component audit teams is guided by the
Group audit team and is executed at levels of materiality
applicable to each individual entity which were lower than Group
materiality and ranged from USD 9.1 million to USD 14.5 million
(2017: USD 6.6 million to USD 10.7 million).
The Group audit team was involved in the audit work performed by
the component auditors in Ukraine and Switzerland through a
combination of our global planning conference call meetings, a
visit to the Ukrainian team and operations, provision of referral
instructions (including detailed supplemented procedures following
the revised risk assessment), review and challenge of related
component inter-office reporting and of findings from their work
(which included the audit procedures performed to respond to risks
of material misstatement), attendance at component audit closing
conference calls and weekly interaction on audit and accounting
matters which arose.
Ferrexpo plc company only and Ferrexpo Finance plc are
registered in the United Kingdom hence the audit and specified
procedures were carried out by the Group audit team.
At the parent entity level we also tested the consolidation
process and carried out analytical procedures to confirm our
conclusion that there were no significant risks of material
misstatement of the aggregated financial information of the
remaining components not subject to audit or audit of specified
account balances.
Other information
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------
The directors are responsible for the other information. We have nothing
The other information comprises the information included to report in
in the annual report, other than the financial statements respect of these
and our auditor's report thereon. matters.
Our opinion on the financial statements does not cover
the other information and, except to the extent otherwise
explicitly stated in our report, we do not express any
form of assurance conclusion thereon.
In connection with our audit of the financial statements,
our responsibility is to read the other information and,
in doing so, consider whether the other information is
materially inconsistent with the financial statements or
our knowledge obtained in the audit or otherwise appears
to be materially misstated.
If we identify such material inconsistencies or apparent
material misstatements, we are required to determine whether
there is a material misstatement in the financial statements
or a material misstatement of the other information. If,
based on the work we have performed, we conclude that there
is a material misstatement of this other information, we
are required to report that fact.
In this context, matters that we are specifically required
to report to you as uncorrected material misstatements
of the other information include where we conclude that:
* Fair, balanced and understandable - the statement
given by the directors that they consider the annual
report and financial statements taken as a whole is
fair, balanced and understandable and provides the
information necessary for shareholders to assess the
Group's position and performance, business model and
strategy, is materially inconsistent with our
knowledge obtained in the audit; or
* Audit committee reporting - the section describing
the work of the audit committee does not
appropriately address matters communicated by us to
the audit committee; or
* Directors' statement of compliance with the UK
Corporate Governance Code - the parts of the
directors' statement required under the Listing Rules
relating to the company's compliance with the UK
Corporate Governance Code containing provisions
specified for review by the auditor in accordance
with Listing Rule 9.8.10R (2) do not properly
disclose a departure from a relevant provision of the
UK Corporate Governance Code.
------------------------------------------------------------- -----------------
Responsibilities of directors
As explained more fully in the directors' responsibilities
statement, the directors are responsible for the preparation of the
financial statements and for being satisfied that they give a true
and fair view, and for such internal control as the directors
determine is necessary to enable the preparation of financial
statements that are free from material misstatement, whether due to
fraud or error.
In preparing the financial statements, the directors are
responsible for assessing the Group's and the Parent Company's
ability to continue as a going concern, disclosing as applicable,
matters related to going concern and using the going concern basis
of accounting unless the directors either intend to liquidate the
Group or the Parent Company or to cease operations, or have no
realistic alternative but to do so.
Auditor's responsibilities for the audit of the financial
statements
Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance about whether
the financial statements as a whole are free from material
misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and to issue an
auditor's report that includes our opinion. Reasonable assurance is
a high level of assurance, but is not a guarantee that an audit
conducted in accordance with ISAs (UK) will always detect a
material misstatement when it exists. Misstatements can arise from
fraud or error and are considered material if, individually or in
the aggregate, they could reasonably be expected to influence the
economic decisions of users taken on the basis of these financial
statements.
Details of the extent to which the audit was considered capable
of detecting irregularities, including fraud are set out below.
A further description of our responsibilities for the audit of
the financial statements is located on the Financial Reporting
Council's website at: www.frc.org.uk/auditorsresponsibilities .
This description forms part of our auditor's report.
Extent to which the audit was considered capable of detecting
irregularities, including fraud
We identify and assess the risks of material misstatement of the
financial statements, whether due to fraud or error, and then
design and perform audit procedures responsive to those risks,
including obtaining audit evidence that is sufficient and
appropriate to provide a basis for our opinion.
Identifying and assessing potential risks related to
irregularities
In identifying and assessing risks of material misstatement in
respect of irregularities, including fraud and non-compliance with
laws and regulations, our procedures included the following:
-- enquiring of group and local management, internal audit, the
Group's internal and external legal counsel and the Audit
Committee, including obtaining and reviewing supporting
documentation, concerning the group's policies and procedures
relating to:
-- identifying, evaluating and complying with laws and
regulations and whether they were aware of any instances of
non-compliance;
-- detecting and responding to the risks of fraud and whether
they have knowledge of any actual, suspected or alleged fraud;
-- the internal controls established to mitigate risks related
to fraud or non-compliance with laws and regulations;
-- discussing among the engagement team including significant
component audit teams and involving relevant internal specialists,
including tax, valuations, pensions, IT, forensic and industry
specialists regarding how and where fraud might occur in the
financial statements and any potential indicators of fraud. As part
of this discussion, we identified potential for fraud in the
following areas: CSR payments, related party disclosure,
taxation-transfer pricing, revenue recognition, valuation of lean
ore inventories, cost capitalisation and management override of
controls; and
-- obtaining an understanding of the legal and regulatory
frameworks that the group operates in, focusing on those laws and
regulations that had a direct effect on the financial statements.
The key laws and regulations we considered in this context included
UK Companies Act, Listing Rules, and tax legislation. In addition,
we considered compliance with the UK Bribery Act, employee
legislation, terms of the group's mining licences and environmental
regulations as fundamental to the group's operations.
Audit response to risks identified
As a result of performing the above, we identified CSR payments,
taxation - transfer pricing, related party disclosure and
management override of controls as key audit matters. The basis for
qualified opinion and key audit matters sections of our report
explains the matters in more detail.
In addition to the above, our procedures to respond to risks
identified included the following:
-- reviewing the financial statement disclosures and testing to
supporting documentation to assess compliance with relevant laws
and regulations described as having a direct effect discussed
above;
-- enquiring of management, the audit committee and external
legal counsel concerning actual and potential litigation and
claims;
-- performing analytical procedures to identify any unusual or
unexpected relationships that may indicate risks of material
misstatement due to fraud;
-- reading minutes of meetings of those charged with governance,
reviewing internal audit reports and reviewing correspondence with
the Ukrainian State Fiscal Service;
-- with respect to revenue recognition, we obtained direct third
party confirmations of all iron ore sales during the year with
detailed substantive procedures performed for any unreconciled
differences and reviewed customer agreements, including identifying
any pricing outliers;
-- with respect to valuations of lean ore inventories:
-- We audited the significant assumptions within the lean ore
valuation calculations with reference to external third party
support;
-- We assessed the Group's ability to complete key capital
projects, including the processing facility expansion programme
("Section 9"), and the economic feasibility of processing lean ore
versus the opportunity cost of processing higher grade ores;
and
-- In relation to capital projects, the Group audit team visited
the mine in 2018 and observed the progress of key capital projects.
We also enhanced our detailed testing on capitalised expenditure
and prepayments by: increasing the sample size of transactions,
challenging the commercial rationale for the transactions selected,
obtaining documentary support for the delivery of goods or
services, checking that the cash payments were made to the correct
supplier bank accounts and challenging whether the costs incurred
qualified to be capitalized under IAS 16.
We also communicated relevant identified laws and regulations
and potential fraud risks to all engagement team members including
internal specialists and significant component audit teams, and
remained alert to any indications of fraud or non-compliance with
laws and regulations throughout the audit.
Report on other legal and regulatory requirements
Opinions on other matters prescribed by the Companies Act
2006
In our opinion the part of the directors' remuneration report to
be audited has been properly prepared in accordance with the
Companies Act 2006.
In our opinion, based on the work undertaken in the course of
the audit:
-- the information given in the strategic report and the
directors' report for the financial year for which the financial
statements are prepared is consistent with the financial
statements; and
-- the strategic report and the directors' report have been
prepared in accordance with applicable legal requirements.
In the light of the knowledge and understanding of the Group and
the Parent Company and their environment obtained in the course of
the audit, we have not identified any material misstatements in the
strategic report or the directors' report.
Matters on which we are required to report by exception
----------------------------------------------------------------- -----------------
Adequacy of explanations received and accounting records
Arising solely from the limitation on the scope of our work referred to
above:
* we have not obtained all the information and
explanations that we considered necessary for the
purpose of our audit.
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Under the Companies Act 2006 we are required to report We have nothing
to you if, in our opinion: to report in
respect of these
* adequate accounting records have not been kept by the matters.
Parent Company, or returns adequate for our audit
have not been received from branches not visited by
us; or
* the Parent Company financial statements are not in
agreement with the accounting records and returns.
----------------------------------------------------------------- -----------------
Directors' remuneration We have nothing
Under the Companies Act 2006 we are also required to report to report in
if in our opinion certain disclosures of directors' remuneration respect of these
have not been made or the part of the directors' remuneration matters.
report to be audited is not in agreement with the accounting
records and returns.
----------------------------------------------------------------- -----------------
Other matters
Auditor tenure
Following the recommendation of the Audit Committee, we were
appointed by the members at the Annual General Meeting on 27 May
2017 to audit the financial statements for the year ending 31
December 2017 and subsequent financial periods.
The period of total uninterrupted engagement of the firm is 2
years, covering years from our appointment through to the year
ending 31 December 2018.
Consistency of the audit report with the additional report to
the audit committee
Our audit opinion is consistent with the additional report to
the audit committee we are required to provide in accordance with
ISAs (UK).
Statement pursuant to section 837(4) of the Companies Act
2006
Respective responsibilities of directors and the auditor
In addition to their responsibilities described above, the
directors are also responsible for considering whether the company,
subsequent to the balance sheet date, has sufficient distributable
profits to make a distribution at the time the distribution is
made.
Our responsibility is to report whether, in our opinion, the
subject matter of our qualification of our auditor's report on the
Ferrexpo plc financial statements for the year ended 31 December
2018 is material for determining, by reference to those financial
statements, whether the distribution proposed by the company is
permitted under section 830 and section 831 of the Companies Act
2006. We are not required to form an opinion on whether the company
has sufficient distributable reserves to make the distribution
proposed at the time the distribution is made.
Opinion
In our opinion the subject matter of the above qualification is
not material for determining by reference to these financial
statements whether the final dividend for the year ended 31
December 2018 of $116 million proposed by the company is permitted
under section 830 and section 831 of the Companies Act 2006.
Use of our report
This report is made solely to the company's members, as a body,
in accordance with Chapter 3 of Part 16 of the Companies Act 2006.
Our audit work has been undertaken so that we might state to the
company's members those matters we are required to state to them in
an auditor's report and for no other purpose. To the fullest extent
permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to
anyone other than the company and the company's members as a body,
for our audit work, for this report, or for the opinions we have
formed.
Christopher Thomas
(Senior statutory auditor)
For and on behalf of Deloitte LLP
Statutory Auditor
London, United Kingdom
22 April 2019
Consolidated Income Statement
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17
----- --------- ---------
Revenue 6 1,274,030 1,197,494
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Operating expenses 5/7 (844,470) (717,354)
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Other operating income 8 3,314 3,238
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Operating foreign exchange (losses)/gains 9 (5,295) 6,661
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Operating profit 427,579 490,039
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Share of profit from associates 32 5,360 5,527
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Profit before tax and finance 432,939 495,566
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Net finance expense 10 (39,332) (54,766)
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Non-operating foreign exchange (losses)/gains 9 (1,585) 9,033
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Profit before tax 392,022 449,833
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Income tax expense 11 (56,801) (55,361)
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Profit for the year 335,221 394,472
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Profit attributable to:
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Equity shareholders of Ferrexpo plc 333,616 392,929
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Non-controlling interests 1,605 1,543
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Profit for the year 335,221 394,472
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Earnings per share:
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Basic (US cents) 12 56.9 67.1
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Diluted (US cents) 12 56.7 66.9
---------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17
----- --------- ---------
Profit for the year 335,221 394,472
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Items that may subsequently be reclassified to profit
or loss:
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Exchange differences on translating foreign operations 12,178 (41,415)
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Income tax effect 11 (2,007) 4,557
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Net other comprehensive income/(loss) that may be
reclassified to profit or loss in subsequent periods 10,171 (36,858)
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Items that will not be reclassified subsequently
to profit or loss:
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Remeasurement gains/(losses) on defined benefit pension
liability 21 875 (9,172)
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Income tax effect 11 - 1,556
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Net other comprehensive income/(loss) not being reclassified
to profit or loss in subsequent periods 875 (7,616)
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Other comprehensive income/(loss) for the year, net
of tax 11,046 (44,474)
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Total comprehensive income for the year, net of tax 346,267 349,998
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Total comprehensive income attributable to:
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Equity shareholders of Ferrexpo plc 344,587 348,686
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Non-controlling interests 1,680 1,312
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
346,267 349,998
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Consolidated Statement of Financial Position
As at As at
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Assets
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Property, plant and equipment 13 701,376 623,359
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Goodwill and other intangible assets 14 39,609 36,858
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Investments in associates 32 7,037 5,947
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Inventories 16 217,688 175,831
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Other non-current assets 15 32,104 10,501
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Income taxes recoverable and prepaid 11 - 5,454
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Deferred tax assets 11 27,946 40,408
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Total non-current assets 1,025,760 898,358
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Inventories 16 144,919 96,645
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Trade and other receivables 17 85,695 88,327
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Prepayments and other current assets 18 27,344 17,514
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Income taxes recoverable and prepaid 11 61 14
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Other taxes recoverable and prepaid 19 44,837 23,192
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Cash and cash equivalents 24 62,996 97,742
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Total current assets 365,852 323,434
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Total assets 1,391,612 1,221,792
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Equity and liabilities
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Issued capital 30 121,628 121,628
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Share premium 185,112 185,112
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Other reserves 30 (2,010,080) (2,020,864)
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Retained earnings (restated - see Note 12) 2,568,187 2,329,591
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Equity attributable to equity shareholders
of Ferrexpo plc 864,847 615,467
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Non-controlling interests 2,050 370
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Total equity 866,897 615,837
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings 5/25 197,258 186,294
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Defined benefit pension liability 21 21,444 20,514
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Provision for site restoration 22 1,940 2,070
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Deferred tax liabilities 11 352 381
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Total non-current liabilities 220,994 209,259
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings 5/25 204,600 305,412
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Trade and other payables (restated - see Note
12) 20 34,292 32,420
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Accrued liabilities and contract liabilities 23 32,693 27,554
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Income taxes payable 11 20,571 23,715
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Other taxes payable (restated - see Note 12) 19 11,565 7,595
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Total current liabilities 303,721 396,696
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Total liabilities 524,715 605,955
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
Total equity and liabilities 1,391,612 1,221,792
---------------------------------------------- ----- ----------- -----------
The financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors
on 22 April 2019.
Steve Lucas
Chairman
Christopher Mawe
Chief Financial Officer
Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows
Year ended Year ended
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Profit before tax 392,022 449,833
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Adjustments for:
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment
and amortisation of intangible assets 62,094 46,392
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Interest expense 10 37,832 53,044
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Interest income 10 (891) (372)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Losses on disposal of property, plant and equipment 5,701 7,754
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Cash elements included in losses on disposal
of property, plant and equipment (372) (2,953)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Write-offs 7 1,489 407
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Share of profit from associates 32 (5,360) (5,527)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Movement in allowance for doubtful receivables 17 222 576
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Movement in site restoration provision 22 (162) 1,070
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Employee benefits 21 3,642 (1,632)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Share-based payments 27 674 586
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Operating foreign exchange losses/(gains) 9 5,295 (6,661)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Non-operating foreign exchange losses/(gains) 9 1,586 (9,033)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Other adjustments (7,657) (6,458)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Operating cash flow before working capital
changes 496,115 527,026
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Changes in working capital:
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Increase in trade and other receivables (12,785) (3,024)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Increase in inventories (87,999) (78,892)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Increase/(decrease) in trade and other accounts
payable 1,903 (27,317)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Increase in other taxes recoverable and payable
(incl. VAT) 19 (17,530) (511)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Cash generated from operating activities 379,704 417,282
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Interest paid (42,768) (48,576)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Income tax paid 11 (43,509) (13,721)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Post-employment benefits paid (1,702) (1,539)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Net cash flows from operating activities 291,725 353,446
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Cash flows from investing activities
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Purchase of property, plant and equipment and
intangible assets 13/14 (135,113) (102,953)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Proceeds from disposal of property, plant and
equipment and intangible assets 800 138
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Interest received 827 358
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Dividends from associates 4,137 4,982
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Net cash flows used in investing activities (129,349) (97,475)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Cash flows from financing activities
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Proceeds from borrowings and finance 25 214,317 -
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Repayment of borrowings and finance 25 (308,817) (238,670)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Arrangement fees paid (5,817) (4,042)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Dividends paid to equity shareholders of Ferrexpo
plc (96,559) (58,316)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Net cash flows used in financing activities (196,876) (301,028)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents (34,500) (45,057)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning
of the year 97,742 144,751
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Currency translation differences (246) (1,952)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the
year 24 62,996 97,742
---------------------------------------------------- ----- ---------- ----------
Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity
Attributable to equity shareholders
of Ferrexpo plc
-------------------------- -------- ----------------------------------------------- --------------- --------
Issued Share Other Retained Non-controlling
capital premium reserves earnings Total interests
(Note (Note (Note (Note capital (Note Total
US$000 30) 30) 30) 12) and reserves 31) equity
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
At 1 January 2017 121,628 185,112 (1,984,758) 2,002,153 324,135 (847) 323,288
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
Profit for the year - - - 392,929 392,929 1,543 394,472
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
Other comprehensive
loss - - (36,692) (7,550) (44,242) (230) (44,472)
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
Total comprehensive
(loss)/income for
the year - - (36,692) 385,379 348,687 1,313 350,000
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
Effect from increase
of shareholding in
subsidiary - - - 26 26 (96) (70)
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
Share-based payments
(Note 27) - - 586 - 586 - 586
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
Equity dividends to
shareholders of Ferrexpo
plc - - - (57,967) (57,967) - (57,967)
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
At 31 December 2017 121,628 185,112 (2,020,864) 2,329,591 615,467 370 615,837
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
Application of new
IFRSs (Note 3) - - - 989 989 - 989
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
At 1 January 2018
- after application
of new IFRSs 121,628 185,112 (2,020,864) 2,330,580 616,456 370 616,826
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
Profit for the year - - - 333,616 333,616 1,605 335,221
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
Other comprehensive
income - - 10,110 861 10,971 75 11,046
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
Total comprehensive
income for the year - - 10,110 334,477 344,587 1,680 346,267
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
Share-based payments
(Note 27) - - 674 - 674 - 674
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
Equity dividends to
shareholders of Ferrexpo
plc (Note 12) - - - (96,870) (96,870) - (96,870)
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
At 31 December 2018 121,628 185,112 (2,010,080) 2,568,187 864,847 2,050 866,897
-------------------------- -------- -------- ----------- --------- ------------- --------------- --------
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
Note 1: Corporate information
Ferrexpo plc (the "Company") is incorporated and registered in
England, which is considered to be the country of domicile, with
its registered office at 55 St James's Street, London SW1A 1LA, UK.
Ferrexpo plc and its subsidiaries (the "Group") operate two mines
and a processing plant near Kremenchug in Ukraine, have an interest
in a port in Odessa and sales and marketing activities around the
world including offices in Switzerland, Dubai, Japan, China,
Singapore and Ukraine. The Group also owns logistics assets in
Austria which operate a fleet of vessels operating on the Rhine and
Danube waterways and an ocean-going vessel which provides top off
services and operates on international sea routes. The Group's
operations are vertically integrated from iron ore mining through
to iron ore concentrate and pellet production and subsequent
logistics. The Group's mineral properties lie within the Kremenchug
Magnetic Anomaly and are currently being extracted at the
Gorishne-Plavninske-Lavrykivske ("GPL") and Yerystivske
deposits.
The majority shareholder of the Group is Fevamotinico S.a.r.l.
("Fevamotinico"), a company incorporated in Luxembourg and
ultimately owned by The Minco Trust, of which Kostyantin Zhevago,
the Group's Chief Executive Officer, is a beneficiary. At the time
this report was published, Fevamotinico held 50.3% (2017: 50.3%) of
Ferrexpo plc's issued share capital.
Note 2: Basis of preparation
The consolidated financial statements of Ferrexpo plc and its
subsidiaries have been prepared in accordance with International
Financial Reporting Standards ("IFRS") as adopted by the European
Union ("EU").
The consolidated financial statements have been prepared on a
historical cost basis, except for post-employment benefits measured
in accordance with IAS 19 revised Employee benefits. The
consolidated financial statements are presented in thousands of US
Dollars and all values are rounded to the nearest thousand except
where otherwise indicated.
The detailed accounting policies are included in the disclosure
notes to the specific financial statement accounts.
Going concern
The Group has assessed that, taking into account: i) its
available cash and cash equivalents available at the date of
authorisation of the consolidated financial statements; ii) its
cash flow projections for the period of management's going concern
assessment; and iii) events and conditions beyond the period of
management's going concern assessment, it has sufficient liquidity
to meet its present obligations and cover working capital needs for
the aforementioned period and will remain in compliance with its
financial covenants throughout this period. Therefore, the Group
continues to adopt the going concern basis of accounting for the
preparation of this set of financial statements. See also the
Directors' Report on page 76 for further information.
Basis of consolidation
The consolidated financial statements comprise the financial
statements for Ferrexpo plc and its subsidiaries as at 31 December
each year. The financial statements of the subsidiaries are
prepared as at the same reporting date as Ferrexpo plc's, using
consistent accounting policies.
Subsidiaries acquired are fully consolidated from the date the
Group obtains effective control. Similarly, subsidiaries disposed
of are deconsolidated from the date on which the Group ceases to
hold effective control. A change in the ownership interest of a
subsidiary without obtaining or losing control is accounted for as
an equity transaction.
All intercompany balances and transactions, including unrealised
profits arising from intra-group transactions, have been eliminated
in full. Unrealised losses are eliminated unless costs cannot be
recovered.
Business combinations
On the acquisition of a subsidiary, the business combination is
accounted for using the acquisition method. The cost of an
acquisition is measured as the aggregated amount of the
consideration transferred, measured at the date of acquisition. The
consideration paid is allocated to the assets acquired and
liabilities assumed on the basis of fair values at the date of
acquisition. Acquisition costs are expensed when incurred and
included in general and administrative expenses.
Functional and presentational currencies
Based on the economic substance of the underlying business
transactions and circumstances relevant to the parent, the
functional currency of the parent has been determined to be the US
Dollar, with each subsidiary determining its own functional
currency based on its own circumstances. The Group has chosen the
US Dollar as its presentational currency. The functional currency
of Ukrainian subsidiaries, which is where the Group's main
operations are based, is the Ukrainian Hryvnia.
Foreign currency translation
For individual subsidiary company accounts, transactions in
foreign currencies (i.e. other than the functional currency) are
recorded at the rate ruling at the date of the transaction.
Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies
are translated to the functional currency at the rate of exchange
ruling at the reporting date and non-monetary assets and
liabilities at the historic rate. Foreign exchange differences
arising on translation are recognised in the income statement.
For presentation of the Group's consolidated accounts, if the
functional currency of a subsidiary is different to the
presentational currency as at the reporting date, the assets and
liabilities of this entity are translated into the presentational
currency at the rate ruling at the reporting date and the income
statement is translated using the average exchange rate for the
period based on the officially published rates by the National Bank
of Ukraine ("NBU"). The foreign exchange differences arising are
taken directly to a separate component of equity. On disposal of a
foreign entity the deferred cumulative amount of exchange
differences recognised in equity relating to the particular foreign
operation is recognised in the income statement.
Note 3: New accounting policies
New standards and interpretations adopted
The accounting policies and methods of computation adopted in
the preparation of the consolidated financial statements are
consistent with those followed in the preparation of the Group's
annual financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2017
except for the adoption of new amendments and improvements to IFRSs
effective as of 1 January 2018.
New standards and interpretations adopted with an impact on the
Group's consolidated financial statements
IFRS 9 Financial instruments
The Group applied IFRS 9 Financial instruments, as revised in
July 2014, for the first time as of 1 January 2018 and elected to
apply the modified retrospective method in accordance with the
transition provisions set out in the standard. The new standard
became effective as of 1 January 2018 and replaces IAS 39 and
includes a new expected credit loss impairment model, changes to
the classification and measurement requirements of financial assets
and financial liabilities as well as to hedge accounting.
Additionally, the Group adopted as of 1 January 2018 the
consequential amendments to IFRS 7 Financial instruments:
Disclosures.
The impact from the application of IFRS 9 on the Group's
consolidated financial statements is predominantly related to the
expected credit loss impairment model as the new standard
established a new approach for the assessment of loans and
receivable balances, including trade receivables, with a focus on
the risk of default in the future rather than based on incurred
losses in the past. Classification and measurement of financial
instruments is unchanged on application of the new standard and the
Group does not intend to apply hedge accounting under IFRS 9.
IFRS 15 Revenue from contracts with customers
The Group applied IFRS 15 Revenue from contracts with customers,
as amended in April 2016, for the first time as of 1 January 2018.
The Group, in accordance with the transition provisions set out in
IFRS 15, elected to apply the modified retrospective method, under
which comparative financial information is not restated. The new
standard establishes the principles for the disclosure of useful
information in the financial statements about the nature, amount,
timing and uncertainties of revenue and cash flows arising from
contracts with customers. Under IFRS 15 the revenue recognition
model changed from one based on the transfer of risk and reward of
ownership to the transfer of control of ownership. The Group's
revenue is predominantly derived from sales of iron pellets, where
the point of recognition is dependent on the contractual sales
terms based on the International Commercial terms ("Incoterms"). As
the time of the transfer of risks and rewards coincides with the
transfer of control, the timing and the amount of revenue
recognised is not affected for the majority of the Group's sales.
For the Incoterms Cost, Insurance and Freight ("CIF"), and Cost and
Freight ("CFR"), the Group must contract for and pay the freight
necessary to bring the goods to the named port of destination.
Consequently, the freight service on sales contracts with CIF and
CFR Incoterms meet the criteria of a separate performance
obligation and a portion of the revenue earned under these
contracts, representing the obligation to perform freight service,
is deferred and recognised over time as this obligation is
fulfilled, along with the associated costs.
The tables below and on the following page provide the details
of the cumulative effects from the application of the new standards
on the consolidated statement of financial position as of 1 January
2018 and the consolidated statement of financial position and the
consolidated income statement as at 31 December 2018.
Effect Effect
Balance from application from application
as at of IFRS of IFRS Year ended
US$000 01.01.18 15 9 31.12.17
--------------------------------------------- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- -----------
Consolidated statement of financial position
--------------------------------------------- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- -----------
Assets
--------------------------------------------- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- -----------
Trade and other receivables 88,109 - (218) 88,327
--------------------------------------------- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- -----------
Prepayments and other current assets 24,727 7,213 - 17,514
--------------------------------------------- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- -----------
Liabilities
--------------------------------------------- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- -----------
Accrued liabilities and contract liabilities (33,560) (6,006) - (27,554)
--------------------------------------------- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- -----------
Equity
--------------------------------------------- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- -----------
Retained earnings (2,330,580) (1,207) 218 (2,329,591)
--------------------------------------------- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- -----------
As disclosed above, the portion of revenue earned under sales
contracts with CIF and CFR Incoterms, representing the obligation
to perform freight services, is deferred and recognised over time
as this obligation is fulfilled, along with the associated costs.
The effect from the expected credit loss impairment model to be
applied under the new standard is primarily calculated based on
publicly available ratings default risks of the Group's customers
with outstanding receivable balances as at the end of a reporting
period. There are no non-current receivable balances to be
considered in the computation of the Group's expected credit loss
as all of the Group's receivable balances are classified as current
based on the agreed terms and conditions.
Balance
Effect Effect without
As reported from application from application effect
as at of IFRS of IFRS from new
Notes 31.12.18 15 9 IFRSs
------------------------------------- ----- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- ---------
Consolidated income statement
------------------------------------- ----- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- ---------
Freight revenue related to sales
of iron ore pellets and concentrate 6 74,929 1,369 - 73,560
------------------------------------- ----- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- ---------
Operating expenses 7 (844,470) (3,207) (35) (841,228)
------------------------------------- ----- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- ---------
Consolidated statement of financial
position
------------------------------------- ----- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- ---------
Assets
------------------------------------- ----- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- ---------
Trade and other receivables 85,695 - (253) 85,948
------------------------------------- ----- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- ---------
Prepayments and other current assets 27,344 (3,207) - 30,551
------------------------------------- ----- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- ---------
Liabilities
------------------------------------- ----- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- ---------
Accrued liabilities and contract
liabilities (32,693) 1,369 - (34,062)
------------------------------------- ----- ----------- ----------------- ----------------- ---------
The table above shows the impact on the operating result from
the application of the new accounting standards only. The impact
from the separate presentation of the total freight revenue related
to the sales of iron pellets and concentrate is shown in Note 6
Revenue. The adoption of the new accounting standards has not had
any material impact on basic and diluted earnings per share.
New standards and interpretations adopted without an impact on
the Group's consolidated financial statements
-- IFRIC 22 Foreign currency transactions and advance
considerations clarifies the accounting for transactions that
include the receipt or payment of advance consideration in a
foreign currency.
-- Amendment to IFRS 2 Share-based payments: Classification and
measurement of share-based payments clarifies the classification of
share-based payment transactions with net settlement features, the
measurement of cash-settled share-based payment transactions that
include a performance condition and of modifications of share-based
payment transactions from cash-settled to equity-settled.
-- Annual improvements to IFRS standards 2014-2016 cycle
contains amendments to IFRS 1 First-time Adoption of IFRS and IAS
28 Investments in associates and joint ventures.
New standards and interpretations not yet adopted
The Group has elected not to adopt early any revised and amended
standards or interpretations that are not yet mandatory in the
EU.
The standards and interpretations below could have an impact on
the consolidated financial statements of the Group.
IFRS 16 Leases
The new standard was issued in January 2016, replacing the
previous leases standard, IAS 17 Leases, and related
interpretations. IFRS 16 establishes the principles for the
recognition, measurement, presentation and disclosure of leases for
the customer ("lessee") and the supplier ("lessor"). IFRS 16
eliminates the classification of leases as either operating or
finance as is required by IAS 17. Instead, it introduces a single
lessee accounting model requiring a lessee to recognise assets and
liabilities for all leases unless the underlying asset has a low
value or the lease term is 12 months or less. Currently, the Group
leases land and buildings under operating leases. The vast majority
of these operating leases are for land used for the extraction of
ore and are not within the scope of IFRS 16 and will be accounted
for under IFRS 6 Exploration for and evaluation of mineral
resources. The Group expects that the new standard will primarily
result in the recognition of right-of-use assets and liabilities in
respect of long-term rental contracts for several of its office
premises, land not used for the direct extraction of ore as well as
for lease equipment. This new standard applies to annual reporting
periods beginning on or after 1 January 2019 and the Group does not
intend to early adopt this standard. If the new standard were
applied as of 31 December 2018, right-of-use assets and
corresponding lease liabilities of US$7,645 thousand would have
been recognised without an effect on the operating result at this
point of time. Depreciation of right-of-use assets and resulting
finance expense under the new standard are not expected to be
materially different to the operating lease expense recognised in
the past.
IFRIC 23 Uncertainty over income tax treatments
The interpretation was issued in June 2017 and clarifies the
accounting treatment for uncertainties in income taxes. The new
interpretation is to be applied to the determination of taxable
results, tax bases, unused tax losses, unused tax credits and tax
rates, when there is uncertainty over income tax treatments under
IAS 12, and becomes effective for financial years beginning on or
after 1 January 2019 subject to EU endorsement. The Group does not
expect a material impact on its consolidated financial statements
from this new interpretation.
Annual Improvements to IFRS Standards 2015-2017 Cycle
The improvements are effective for the financial year beginning
on 1 January 2020 and contain amendments to IAS 12 Income taxes and
IAS 23 Borrowing costs. The Group does not expect a material impact
on its consolidated financial statements from these annual
improvements.
Amendments to IFRS 9 Financial instruments: Prepayment features
with negative compensation
The amendments are effective for the financial year beginning on
1 January 2019 and clarify the classification of particular
pre-payable financial assets and the accounting for financial
liabilities following a modification. The Group does not expect a
material impact on its consolidated financial statements from these
amendments.
Amendments to IAS 19 Employee benefits: Plan amendment,
curtailment or settlement
The amendments are effective for the financial year beginning on
1 January 2020 and provide guidance, in the case of plan amendment,
curtailment or settlement, on the measurement of the current
service cost and the net interest for the period after the
remeasurement. Furthermore, they clarify the effect of a plan
amendment, curtailment or settlement on the requirements regarding
the asset ceiling. The Group does not expect a material impact on
its consolidated financial statements from these amendments.
Amendments to References to the Conceptual Framework in IFRS
standards
The revised Conceptual Framework was issued in March 2018 and is
effective for the financial year beginning on 1 January 2020
subject to EU endorsement. The amendments introduce a new chapter
on measurement, guidance on reporting financial performance,
improved definitions of an asset and a liability and clarifications
in areas such as the roles of stewardship, prudence and measurement
uncertainty in financial reporting. The Group is in the process of
performing the impact assessment.
The Group does not expect an impact on its consolidated
financial statements from all other standards, interpretations and
amendments issued at the reporting date, but not yet to be adopted
for these financial statements.
Note 4: Use of critical estimates and judgements
The preparation of consolidated financial statements in
conformity with IFRS requires management to make estimates and
judgements that affect the amounts reported in the consolidated
financial statements and accompanying notes. These estimates and
judgements are based on information available as at the date of
authorising the consolidated financial statements for issue. Actual
results could therefore differ from those estimates and judgements.
The Group identified a number of areas involving the use of
critical estimates and judgements made by management in preparing
the consolidated financial statements and supporting information is
embedded within the following disclosure notes:
Critical estimates
-- Note 16 Inventories - lean and weathered ore
Critical judgements
-- Note 7 Operating expenses - nature of the Group's community support donations
-- Note 11 Taxation - tax legislation in Ukraine
-- Note 33 Related party disclosures - completeness
Note 5: Segment information
The Group is managed as a single segment, which produces,
develops and markets its principal product, iron ore pellets, for
sale to the metallurgical industry. While the revenue generated by
the Group is monitored at a more detailed level, there are no
separate measures of profit reported to the Group's Chief Operating
Decision Maker ("CODM"). In accordance with IFRS 8 Operating
segments, the Group presents its results in a single segment, which
are disclosed in the income statement for the Group.
Management monitors the operating result of the Group based on a
number of measures, including underlying EBITDA, gross profit and
net debt.
Underlying EBITDA and gross profit
The Group presents the underlying EBITDA as it is a useful
measure for evaluating its ability to generate cash and its
operating performance. The Group's full definition of underlying
EBITDA is disclosed in the Glossary on page 172.
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Profit before tax and finance 432,939 495,566
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Losses on disposal of property, plant and equipment 5,701 7,754
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Share-based payments 27 674 586
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Write-offs 7 1,489 407
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Depreciation and amortisation 62,094 46,392
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Underlying EBITDA 502,897 550,705
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17
-------------- ----- --------- ---------
Revenue 6 1,274,030 1,197,494
-------------- ----- --------- ---------
Cost of sales 7 (507,939) (411,490)
-------------- ----- --------- ---------
Gross profit 766,091 786,004
-------------- ------- -------
Net debt
Net debt as defined by the Group comprises cash and cash
equivalents less interest-bearing loans and borrowings.
As at As at
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Cash and cash equivalents 24 62,996 97,742
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings - current 25 (204,600) (305,412)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings - non-current 25 (197,258) (186,294)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Net debt (338,862) (393,964)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
The Group made debt repayments of US$308,817 thousand during the
year ended 31 December 2018 (2017: US$238,602 thousand). Net debt
is an Alternative Performance Measure ("APM"). Further information
on the APMs used by the Group, including the definitions, is
provided on pages 165 to 167.
In the current period, management has reviewed the presentation
of the accrued interest and has reclassified it from
interest-bearing loans and borrowings to accrued liabilities in
order to better reflect the nature of this balance in the
presentation. US$9,358 thousand have been re-presented for the
comparative year ended 31 December 2017 to be on a consistent basis
and reducing the net debt by these amounts.
Disclosure of revenue and non-current assets
The Group does not generate significant revenues from external
customers attributable to the UK, the Company's country of
domicile. The information on the revenues from external customers
attributed to the individual foreign countries is given in Note 6
Revenue. The Group does not have any significant non-current assets
that are located in the country of domicile of the Company. The
vast majority of the non-current assets are located in Ukraine.
Note 6: Revenue
Accounting policy
Revenue recognition
Revenue is recognised to the extent that it is probable that
economic benefits will flow to the Group and the revenue can be
reliably measured. The following specific recognition criteria are
to be met before revenue is recognised:
Sale of goods including sales of pellets and fuel from bunker
business
Revenue is recognised when the control of the goods has passed
to the buyer and can be reliably measured.
Revenue is measured at the fair value of the consideration
received or receivable and represents amounts receivable for goods
provided in the normal course of business, net of discounts,
customs duties and sales taxes. Revenues related to provisionally
priced sales are initially recognised at the estimated fair value
of the consideration receivable based on the forward price at each
reporting date for the relevant period outlined in the different
contracts.
The control of goods passes when title for the goods passes to
the customer as determined by the terms of the sales agreement. The
sales are typically made under the following terms:
-- CIF ("Cost Insurance and Freight");
-- CFR ("Cost and Freight");
-- DAP ("Delivery At Place"); or
-- FOB ("Free on Board").
Under DAP Incoterms, revenue is recognised when goods arrive at
the agreed destination or at the border crossing, whereas under the
other above-mentioned terms the title passes on the date of the
bill of lading. If the sales agreement allows for adjustment of the
sales prices based on survey of the goods by the customer (e.g. ore
content) the revenue is recognised based on the most recent
determined product specification.
The freight services under CIF and CFR Incoterms meet the
criteria of a separate performance obligation and a portion of the
revenue earned under these contracts, representing the obligation
to perform freight service, is deferred and recognised over time as
this obligation is fulfilled, along with the associated costs. The
freight revenue related to the sales of iron ore pellets made under
CIF and CFR Incoterms is shown separate from the revenue from sales
of iron ore pellets and concentrate.
The Group has no unsatisfied or partially unsatisfied
performance obligations relating to contracts with customers with
original expected duration of more than one year. The Group has
therefore taken advantage of the practical expedient provided in
IFRS 15 in respect of the transaction price allocated to the
remaining performance obligations.
Logistic services
Revenue from logistic services rendered is recognised over time
as services are completed. Where services are invoiced in advance
of discharge, amounts attributable to the time between the end of
the reporting period and the discharge date are deferred as
contract liabilities.
Other sales
Other sales and services provided include predominantly the
revenue generated from the sale of other materials and repair and
maintenance works provided to third parties. The revenues are
recognised when the title passes for material sold or services
provided are completed.
The details on the first-time adoption of IFRS 15 Revenue from
contracts with customers are provided in Note 3 New accounting
policies.
Revenue for the year ended 31 December 2018 consisted of the
following:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Revenue from sales of iron ore pellets and concentrate 1,146,734 1,062,871
------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Freight revenue related to sales of iron ore pellets and
concentrate 74,929 63,447
------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total revenue from sales of iron ore pellets and concentrate 1,221,663 1,126,318
------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Revenue from logistics and bunker business 48,778 68,449
------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Revenue from other sales and services provided 3,589 2,727
------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total revenue 1,274,030 1,197,494
------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
The information of the comparative year in respect of the
separate presentation of the freight revenue related to sales of
iron ore pellets and concentrate have been re-presented to be on a
consistent basis with the current period. There has been no
restatement of the underlying financial information.
Revenue in the amount of US$6,006 thousand were included in the
contract liability balance at the beginning of the period and
recognised in the consolidated income statement during the year
ended 31 December 2018.
Export sales of iron ore pellets and concentrate by geographical
destination showing separately countries that individually
represented more than 10% of export sales in either the current or
prior year were as follows:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
---------------------------- --------- ---------
Central Europe 565,820 536,836
---------------------------- --------- ---------
Austria 290,825 328,377
---------------------------- --------- ---------
Others 274,995 208,459
---------------------------- --------- ---------
Western Europe 193,540 170,295
---------------------------- --------- ---------
Germany 172,108 155,508
---------------------------- --------- ---------
Others 21,432 14,787
---------------------------- --------- ---------
North East Asia 221,985 198,165
---------------------------- --------- ---------
Japan 127,336 120,053
---------------------------- --------- ---------
Others 94,649 78,112
---------------------------- --------- ---------
China & South East Asia 176,135 142,812
---------------------------- --------- ---------
China 125,315 123,531
---------------------------- --------- ---------
Others 50,820 19,281
---------------------------- --------- ---------
Turkey, Middle East & India 64,183 78,210
---------------------------- --------- ---------
Turkey 64,183 78,210
---------------------------- --------- ---------
Total exports 1,221,663 1,126,318
---------------------------- --------- ---------
The Group markets its products across various regions. The
disclosure of the segmentation reflects how the Group makes its
business decisions and monitors its sales. Information about the
composition of the regions is provided in the Glossary on pages 168
to 172.
During the year ended 31 December 2018 sales made to three
customers accounted for 40% of the revenues from export sales of
ore pellets and concentrate (2017: 45%).
Sales to one customer that individually represented more than
10% of total sales in either the current or prior year amounted to
US$290,825 thousand (2017: US$328,377 thousand).
Note 7: Operating expenses
Accounting policy
Operating expenses arise in the course of the ordinary
activities of the Group and are recognised in the income statement
when a decrease in future economic benefits related to a decrease
in an asset or an increase of a liability has arisen that can be
measured reliably.
Expenses are recognised in the income statement on the basis of
a direct association between costs incurred and specific items of
income. When economic benefits are expected to arise over several
accounting periods and the association with income can only be
broadly or indirectly determined, expenses are systematically
allocated to the accounting period in which the economic benefits
are expected to arise.
Critical judgements
Nature of the Group's community support donations
The preparation of the consolidated financial statements for the
year ended 31 December 2018 required management to determine the
nature of the Group's community support donations. In light of the
ongoing Independent Review, it is currently considered that some of
the funds donated to Blooming Land (the "Charity") could have been
misappropriated. For further information see Independent Review
Committee Report ("IRC") on page 46.
In the absence of conclusive evidence that funds have not been
used as intended, the Group has judged that it remains appropriate
for it to present its community support donations to the Charity as
such in the consolidated financial statements within operating
expenses on the assumption that all material donations made by the
Group have been applied as previously reported by the Charity to
the Group.
If the IRC based on new facts reaches a different view to the
above critical judgement this may require additional or alternative
disclosures and, under certain circumstances, this may expose the
Group to regulatory and other actions resulting in potential legal
claims or penalties, fines or other liabilities. For further
information see Note 29 Commitments, contingencies and legal
disputes on page 149.
Operating expenses for the year ended 31 December 2018 consisted
of the following:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------------------------ --------- ---------
Cost of sales 507,939 411,490
------------------------------------ --------- ---------
Selling and distribution expenses 260,422 219,703
------------------------------------ --------- ---------
General and administrative expenses 45,246 41,954
------------------------------------ --------- ---------
Other operating expenses 30,863 44,207
------------------------------------ --------- ---------
Total operating expenses 844,470 717,354
------------------------------------ --------- ---------
Operating expenses include:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17
----------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Inventories recognised as an expense upon sale of
goods 481,366 367,161
----------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Employee costs (excl. logistics and bunker business) 79,471 53,293
----------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Inventory movements (34,801) (1,846)
----------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment 61,377 45,920
----------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Amortisation of intangible assets 718 472
----------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Royalties and levies 29,742 19,610
----------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Costs of logistics and bunker business 50,270 63,127
----------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Audit and non-audit services 3,166 1,342
----------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Community support donations 33 15,130 28,384
----------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Write-offs 1,489 407
----------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Losses on disposal of property, plant and equipment 5,701 7,754
----------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Further information in respect of the Group's community support
donations is provided in the Chairman's Statement (page 6),
Principal Risks (page 25), Responsible Business (page 29),
Corporate Governance Report (page 39), Independent Review Committee
Report (page 46), Audit Committee Report (page 50) and Note 29
Commitments, contingencies and legal disputes, Note 33 Related
party disclosures and Note 34 Events after the reporting period to
the consolidated financial statements.
Write-offs for the year ended 31 December 2018 primarily
consisted of obsolete inventories and property, plant and equipment
as outlined below:
As at As at
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Write-off of inventories 1,072 368
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Write-off of property, plant and equipment 395 39
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Write-off of receivables and prepayments 22 -
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total write-offs 1,489 407
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Auditor remuneration
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Audit services
------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Ferrexpo plc Annual Report 2,827 1,008
------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Subsidiary entities 182 191
------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total audit services 3,009 1,199
------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Audit-related assurance services 150 140
------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total audit and audit-related assurance services 3,159 1,339
------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Non-audit services
------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Other services 7 3
------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total non-audit services 7 3
------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total auditor remuneration 3,166 1,342
------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Auditor remuneration paid is in respect of the audit of the
financial statements of the Group and its subsidiary companies and
for the provision of other services not in connection with the
audit. Recognised in the 2018 audit services figure is US$192
thousand subsequently agreed in relation to 2017.
Note 8: Other income
Accounting policy
Other income mainly includes lease income generated from rail
cars, mining equipment and premises, and the proceeds from the sale
of spare parts, scrap metal and fuel and compensations received
from insurance companies. Lease income is recognised based on the
underlying contractual basis over the term of the lease. Other
income from the sale of consumable materials is recognised as
revenue when the title passes.
Other income for the year ended 31 December 2018 consisted of
the following:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------- --------- ---------
Lease income 397 386
------------------- --------- ---------
Other income 2,917 2,852
------------------- --------- ---------
Total other income 3,314 3,238
------------------- --------- ---------
Note 9: Foreign exchange gains and losses
Accounting policy
Foreign exchange gains and losses are reported on a net basis.
Operating foreign exchange gains and losses are those resulting
directly from the Group's operating activities. Non-operating gains
and losses are predominantly those associated with the Group's
financing and treasury activities, including the translation of
interest-bearing loans and borrowings denominated in currencies
different from the respective functional currencies and
transactional gains and losses from the conversion of cash balances
in currencies different from the local functional currencies at
exchange rates different from those at the initial recognition
date.
Foreign exchange gains and losses for the year ended 31 December
2018 consisted of the following:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
---------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Operating foreign exchange (losses)/gains
---------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Revaluation of trade receivables (4,922) 7,113
---------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Revaluation of trade payables (358) (394)
---------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Other (15) (58)
---------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total operating foreign exchange (losses)/gains (5,295) 6,661
---------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Non-operating foreign exchange (losses)/gains
---------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Revaluation of interest-bearing loans 95 10,136
---------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Conversion of cash and cash equivalents (801) (1,497)
---------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Other (879) 394
---------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total non-operating foreign exchange (losses)/gains (1,585) 9,033
---------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total foreign exchange (losses)/gains (6,880) 15,694
---------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
The translation differences and foreign exchange gains and
losses are predominantly dependent on the fluctuation of the
exchange rate of the Ukrainian Hryvnia against the US Dollar. The
table below shows the closing and average rate of the most relevant
currencies of the Group compared to the US Dollar.
Average exchange Closing exchange
rate rate
----- -------------------- --------------------
Year Year
As at As at ended ended
US$ 31.12.18 31.12.17 31.12.18 31.12.17
----- --------- --------- --------- ---------
UAH 27.200 26.597 27.688 28.067
------ --------- --------- --------- ---------
EUR 0.847 0.887 0.874 0.838
------ --------- --------- --------- ---------
Exchange differences arising on translation of non-US Dollar
functional currency operations (mainly in Ukrainian Hryvnia) are
included in the translation reserve. See Note 30 Share capital and
reserves for further details.
Note 10: Net finance expense
Accounting policy
Finance expense
Finance expense is expensed as incurred and includes the
interest on loans and borrowings measured at amortised cost and
interest on defined benefit plans.
Borrowing costs incurred in respect of the financing of
construction or production of a qualifying asset are capitalised up
to the date when the asset is ready for its intended use. See also
Note 13 Property, plant and equipment for further details.
Finance income
Finance income comprises interest income on funds invested and
the effect of unwinding discounts recorded in previous periods.
Interest income is recognised as it accrues using the effective
interest method.
Finance expense and income for the year ended 31 December 2018
consisted of the following:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
----------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Finance expense
----------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Interest expense on loans and borrowings (43,468) (53,560)
----------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Less capitalised borrowing costs 8,125 3,637
----------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Interest on defined benefit plans (2,390) (2,094)
----------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Bank charges (778) (2,537)
----------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Other finance costs (1,713) (584)
----------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total finance expense (40,224) (55,138)
----------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Finance income
----------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Interest income 843 364
----------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Other finance income 49 8
----------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total finance income 892 372
----------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Net finance expense (39,332) (54,766)
----------------------------------------- --------- ---------
The presentation of the interest expense on loans and borrowings
has been changed in the current period to reflect an interest
expense measured at amortised cost using the effective interest
rate method by presenting the effect from the amortisation of
prepaid arrangement fees in interest expense on loans and
borrowings and not in bank charges as done in the previous periods.
In order to be consistent with the presentation in the current
period, the amount of US$7,013 thousand has been reclassified from
bank charges to interest expense on loans and borrowings for the
comparative year ended 31 December 2017. The total finance expense
remained unchanged.
Note 11: Taxation
Accounting policy
Current income tax
Current income taxes are computed based on enacted or
substantively enacted local tax rates and laws at the reporting
date and the expected taxable incomes of the subsidiaries for the
respective period.
Current income taxes are recognised as an expense or income in
the consolidated income statement unless related to items
recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income or
directly in equity or if related to the initial accounting for a
business combination.
Deferred income tax
Deferred income tax is provided using the liability method on
temporary differences at the reporting date between the tax bases
of assets and liabilities and their carrying amounts for financial
reporting purposes.
Deferred tax liabilities are generally recognised for taxable
temporary differences if it is probable that they will become
taxable. Deferred income tax assets are generally recognised for
deductible temporary differences, carry forward of unused tax
credits and unused tax losses, to the extent that it is probable
that taxable profit will be available against which the deductible
temporary differences and the carry forward of unused tax credits
and unused tax losses can be utilised.
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured at the tax
rates that are expected to apply in the period when the asset is
realised or the liability is settled, based on tax rates (and tax
laws) that have been enacted or substantively enacted at the
reporting date.
No deferred assets or liabilities are recognised if the
temporary differences arise from the initial recognition of assets
and liabilities in a transaction, other than in a business
combination, which affects neither the accounting profit nor
taxable profit or loss.
Deferred tax liabilities are recognised in respect of taxable
temporary differences associated with investments in subsidiaries,
associates and interests in joint ventures, except where the Group
is able to control the reversal of the temporary differences and it
is probable that the temporary difference will not reverse in the
foreseeable future. Deferred tax assets in relation to temporary
differences on such investments and interests are recognised to the
extent that it is probable that there are sufficient taxable
profits available against which the benefits of the temporary
differences can be utilised and that they are expected to reverse
in the foreseeable future.
Deferred tax assets are recognised on temporary differences and
available tax loss carry forwards when it is more likely than not
that they will be recovered in a future period.
The carrying amount of deferred income tax assets is reviewed at
each reporting date and reduced to the extent that it is no longer
probable that sufficient taxable profit will be available to allow
all or part of the deferred income tax assets to be utilised.
Additionally, unrecognised deferred income tax assets are
reassessed at each reporting date and are recognised to the extent
that it has become probable that future taxable profit will allow
the deferred tax assets to be recovered.
Income tax effects on items directly recognised in other
comprehensive income or equity are also recognised in other
comprehensive income or equity.
Deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities are offset if a
legally enforceable right exists to set off current tax assets
against current tax liabilities and the deferred taxes relate to
the same taxable entity and the same taxation authority.
Critical judgements
Tax legislation in Ukraine
The Group prices its sales between its subsidiaries using
international benchmark prices for comparable products covering
product quality and applicable freight costs. The Group judges
these to be on terms which comply with applicable legislation. In
August 2017, the State Fiscal Service of Ukraine ("SFS") commenced
a tax audit for the period from 1 September 2013 to 31 December
2015 at the Group's major subsidiary in Ukraine with a focus on
cross-border transactions in terms of its pellet sales to another
subsidiary of the Group. In accordance with the current
legislation, the SFS has completed this audit within 18 months from
commencement and issued its official tax audit report on 27
December 2018, claiming a tax adjustment totalling UAH448 million
(US$16,180 thousand). The Group's major subsidiary in Ukraine
submitted its objections to the findings of the SFS on 25 January
2019 and following further discussions between the parties during
February 2019, the SFS issued the formal claim on 12 March 2019
according to its earlier tax audit report. The Group's Ukrainian
subsidiary is going to initiate legal proceedings and to file a
claim to the first court instance in Poltava on 22 March 2019. As
the Group considers that it has complied with applicable
legislation for all cross-border transactions and periods, the
Group expects to successfully defend its methodology applied to
determine the prices between its subsidiaries. Consequently, no
provision has been recorded as at 31 December 2018. The SFS may
commence new audits on other cross-border transactions within the
Group or on other periods and the Group also expects to
successfully defend its pricing methodology against any further
claims should they arise.
The income tax expense for the year ended 31 December 2018
consisted of the following:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
-------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Current income tax
-------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Current income tax charge 44,086 45,423
-------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Amounts related to previous years (569) (4,154)
-------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total current income tax 43,517 41,269
-------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Deferred income tax
-------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Origination and reversal of temporary differences 13,284 14,092
-------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total deferred income tax 13,284 14,092
-------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total income tax expense 56,801 55,361
-------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
The amounts relating to the prior year shown in the table above
for the comparative year ended 31 December 2017 are predominantly
related to effects from final tax assessments received in
Switzerland during the year ended 31 December 2017. As a result of
the final tax assessments received, a recorded tax accrual in
Switzerland could be released in financial year 2017.
Tax effects on items charged to the statement of other
comprehensive income consisted of the following for the year ended
31 December 2018:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Tax effect of exchange differences arising on translating
foreign operations 30 (2,007) 4,557
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Tax effect of remeasurement gains on defined benefit
pension liability - 1,556
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Total income taxes (credited)/charged to other comprehensive
income (2,007) 6,113
------------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
The weighted average statutory corporate income tax rate is
calculated as the average of the statutory tax rates applicable in
the countries in which the Group operates, weighted by the profits
and losses before tax of the subsidiaries in the respective
countries, as included in the consolidated financial information.
The weighted average statutory corporate income tax rate was 15.5%
for the financial year 2018 (2017: 13.5%). A reconciliation between
the income tax charged in the accompanying financial information
and income before taxes multiplied by the weighted average
statutory tax rate for the year ended 31 December 2018 is as
follows:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
--------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Profit before tax 392,022 449,833
--------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Notional tax charge computed at the weighted average statutory
tax rate of 15.5% (2017: 13.5%) 60,629 60,819
--------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
(Recognition)/derecognition of deferred tax assets1 (8,576) 25,396
--------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Credit for Ukrainian fuel excise tax against income tax2 (7,408) -
--------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Expenses not deductible for local tax purposes3 3,795 7,295
--------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Income exempted for local tax purposes (56) (2,385)
--------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Reassessment of prior year temporary differences4 7,719 -
--------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Recognition of losses and temporary differences previously
not recognised5 - (29,945)
--------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Effect from change in permanent differences - (1,957)
--------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Effect of different tax rates on local profit streams6 1,157 1,039
--------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Prior year adjustments to current tax7 (569) (4,154)
--------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Effect from share of profit from associates8 (974) (995)
--------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Other (including translation differences) 1,084 248
--------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total income tax expense 56,801 55,361
--------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
1 Recognition of US$8,576 thousand in 2018 relates to temporary
differences arising from inflationary adjustments made in the past
to the tax basis of property, plant and equipment for two Ukrainian
subsidiaries. Derecognition in 2017 of US$25,396 thousand in
respect of temporary differences on restricted cash and deposits
balances being of a non-recurring nature. Note 29 Commitments,
contingencies and legal disputes provides further information
2 Effective 1 January 2018, a temporary provision in the
Ukrainian tax code allows a reduction in income tax payable for the
amount of excise tax included in prices of fuel used for mining
equipment. This provision still applies for 2019
3 Effect in 2018 predominantly related to expenses not
deductible in Ukraine whereas the effect in 2017 related to Ukraine
and Switzerland. The effect in Ukraine is expected to be recurring
to a certain extent as a portion of operating expenses is
historically not deductible for tax purposes according to the
enacted local tax legislation whereas the one in Switzerland is
expected to be non-recurring
4 Effective 1 January 2019, the relevant accounting framework
for tax purposes changed from local GAAP to IFRS resulting in a
reduction of temporary differences as of 31 December 2018 being of
a non-recurring nature
5 Effect in 2017 related to previously unrecognised losses and
temporary differences for a Ukrainian subsidiary that became
profitable during 2017. As the entire balance of temporary
differences and available losses from previous periods was
recognised as deferred tax assets, the effect is expected to be of
a non-recurring nature
6 Effect in 2018 and 2017 related to different tax rates
applying to different income streams in Swiss subsidiaries as a
result of their specific tax status. The effect is of a recurring
nature
7 Effect in 2017 related to final tax assessments received in
Switzerland being of a non-recurring nature
8 Share of profit from associates is recognised net of taxes of
the associates. This effect is of a recurring nature
The net balance of income tax receivable/(payable) changed as
follows during the financial year 2018:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------------------------------ --------- ---------
Opening balance (18,247) 4,607
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Income statement charge (43,517) (41,269)
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Booked through other comprehensive income (2,007) 4,557
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Tax paid 43,509 13,721
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Translation differences (248) 138
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Closing balance (20,510) (18,247)
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
The net income tax payable as at 31 December 2018 consisted of
the following:
As at As at
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
-------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Income tax receivable balance - current 61 14
-------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Income tax receivable balance - non-current - 5,454
-------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Income tax payable balance (20,571) (23,715)
-------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Net income tax (payable)/receivable (20,510) (18,247)
-------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
The non-current income tax receivable balance of US$5,454
thousand as at the end of the comparative period ended 31 December
2017 relates predominantly to prepayments made by a Ukrainian
subsidiary and was classified as non-current due to the uncertainty
in respect of the timing of the recovery. The prepaid balance was
fully offset against income tax payable during the financial year
2018.
Temporary differences at the reporting date between the tax
bases of assets and liabilities and their carrying amounts for
financial reporting purposes and the recognition of available tax
loss carry forwards results in the following deferred income tax
assets and liabilities at 31 December 2018:
Consolidated
statement of Consolidated
financial position income statement
------------------------------------------------ ----- --------------------- --------------------
Year Year
As at As at ended ended
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Allowance for restricted cash and deposits 29 3,771 3,720 - (21,836)
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Property, plant and equipment 23,486 18,032 5,095 6,213
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Inventory 373 1,409 (1,051) 252
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Tax losses recognised 3,213 14,210 (11,505) 13,134
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Accrued expenses - - - (10,654)
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Defined benefit pension liability 666 3,316 (2,681) 1,070
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Other 649 690 (32) 83
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Total deferred tax assets/change 32,158 41,377 (10,174) (11,738)
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Thereof netted against deferred tax liabilities (4,212) (969)
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Total deferred tax assets as per the
statement of financial position 27,946 40,408
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Property, plant and equipment (3,690) (600) (3,326) (62)
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Trade and other receivables (329) (379) 50 (187)
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Other (545) (371) 166 (2,105)
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Total deferred tax liabilities/change (4,564) (1,350) (3,110) (2,354)
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Thereof netted against deferred tax assets 4,212 969
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Total deferred tax liabilities as per
the statement of financial position (352) (381)
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
Net deferred tax assets/net change 27,594 40,027 (13,284) (14,092)
------------------------------------------------ ----- ---------- --------- --------- ---------
The movement in the deferred income tax balance is as
follows:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------------------------------ --------- ---------
Opening balance 40,027 52,232
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Income statement charge (13,284) (14,092)
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Booked through other comprehensive income - 1,556
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Translation differences 851 331
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Closing balance 27,594 40,027
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
As at 31 December 2018, the Group had available tax loss carry
forwards in the amount of US$92,654 thousand (2017: US$97,873
thousand) for which no deferred tax assets were recognised.
US$59,883 thousand (2017: US$70,198 thousand) are related to losses
incurred in Ukraine and Austria and those losses do not expire. The
remaining balance totalling US$32,771 thousand (2017: US$27,675
thousand) relates to losses incurred in Hungary, of which US$22,923
thousand (2017: US$22,957 thousand) expire after more than eight
years.
Temporary differences associated with investments in
subsidiaries for which deferred tax liabilities have not been
recognised amount to US$440,328 thousand (2017: US$453,097
thousand). Other temporary differences of US$19,963 thousand have
not been recognised as of 31 December 2018 (2017: US$26,627
thousand), of which the vast majority relates to temporary
differences on property, plant and equipment in Ukraine.
Note 12: Earnings per share and dividends paid and proposed
Accounting policy
Basic number of Ordinary Shares outstanding
The basic number of Ordinary Shares is calculated by reducing
the total number of Ordinary Shares in issue by the weighted
average of shares held in treasury and employee benefit trust
reserve. The basic earnings per share ("EPS") are calculated by
dividing the net profit for the year attributable to ordinary
equity shareholders of Ferrexpo plc by the weighted average number
of Ordinary Shares.
Dilutive potential Ordinary Shares
The dilutive potential Ordinary Shares outstanding are
calculated by adjusting the weighted average number of Ordinary
Shares in issue on the assumption of conversion of all potentially
dilutive Ordinary Shares. All share awards that are potentially
dilutive are considered in the calculation of diluted earnings per
share.
Distributable reserves
Ferrexpo plc (the "Company") is the Group's holding company,
with no direct operating business, so its ability to make
distributions to its shareholders is dependent on its ability to
access profits held in the subsidiaries. The Group's consolidated
retained earnings shown in the consolidated statement of changes in
equity do not reflect the profits available for distribution in the
Group as of 31 December 2018.
Year Year
ended ended
31.12.18 31.12.17
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Earnings for the year attributable to equity shareholders
per share
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Basic (US cents) 56.9 67.1
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Diluted (US cents) 56.7 66.9
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
The calculation of the basic and diluted earnings per share is
based on the following data:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
-------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders
-------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Basic and diluted earnings 333,616 392,929
-------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Year Year
ended ended
Thousand 31.12.18 31.12.17
---------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Weighted average number of shares
---------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Basic number of Ordinary Shares outstanding 586,117 585,674
---------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Effect of dilutive potential Ordinary Shares 1,948 2,074
---------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Diluted number of Ordinary Shares outstanding 588,065 587,748
---------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Dividends proposed and paid
Taking into account relevant thin capitalisation rules and
dividend-related covenants for the Group's major bank debt
facilities, the total available distributable reserves of Ferrexpo
plc is US$167,611 thousand as of 31 December 2018 (2017: US$197,236
thousand).
Year
ended
US$000 31.12.18
----------------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Dividends proposed
----------------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Final ordinary dividend for 2018: 6.6 US cents per Ordinary
Share 38,695
----------------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Final special dividend for 2018: 6.6 US cents per Ordinary Share 38,695
----------------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Interim special dividend for 2018: 6.6 US cents per Ordinary
Share 38,695
----------------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Total dividends proposed 116,085
----------------------------------------------------------------- ---------
On 6 December 2018, the Group announced that the Directors had
proposed to pay an interim special dividend of 6.6 US cents per
Ordinary Share totalling US$38,695 thousand. This dividend was paid
on 14 January 2019 and, in accordance with UK law, the liability
recognised only on payment of the dividend in the financial
statements for the year ending 31 December 2019.
As of 31 December 2017, a dividend payable was recognised in
respect of an interim special dividend proposed by the Directors on
7 December 2017 and payable on 15 January 2018. The presentation of
the comparatives as of 31 December 2017 has been restated to be
consistent with the current year presentation by derecognising the
interim special dividend of US$19,365 thousand (comprising of
US$16,008 thousand dividend payable and US$3,357 thousand
withholding tax) and recognising a corresponding credit to retained
earnings.
The balances impacted by this restatement are outlined
below:
Year ended
Year ended 31.12.17
(after
US$000 31.12.17 restatement)
------------------------------------------------------ ---------- --------------
Trade and other payables 48,428 32,420
------------------------------------------------------ ---------- --------------
Other taxes 10,952 7,595
------------------------------------------------------ ---------- --------------
Total current liabilities 416,061 396,696
------------------------------------------------------ ---------- --------------
Retained earnings 2,310,226 2,329,591
------------------------------------------------------ ---------- --------------
Total equity attributable to shareholders of Ferrexpo
plc 596,472 615,467
------------------------------------------------------ ---------- --------------
Year
ended
US$000 31.12.18
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Dividends paid during the year
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Interim dividend for 2018: 3.3 US cents per Ordinary Share 19,376
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Final dividend for 2017: 3.3 US cents per Ordinary Share 18,929
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Special dividend for 2017: 6.6 US cents per Ordinary Share 38,615
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Special dividend for 2017: 3.3 US cents per Ordinary Share 19,639
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Total dividends paid during the year 96,559
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Although accounts are published in US Dollars and dividends are
declared in US Dollars, the shares are denominated in UK Pounds
sterling and dividends are therefore paid in UK Pounds
Sterling.
Year
ended
US$000 31.12.17
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Dividends proposed
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Final dividend for 2017: 3.3 US cents per Ordinary Share 19,328
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Special dividend for 2017: 6.6 US cents per Ordinary Share 38,656
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Special dividend for 2017: 3.3 US cents per Ordinary Share 19,328
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Total dividends proposed 77,312
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Year
ended
US$000 31.12.17
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Dividends paid during the year
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Interim dividend for 2017: 3.3 US cents per Ordinary Share 19,266
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Final dividend for 2016: 3.3 US cents per Ordinary Share 19,679
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Special dividend for 2016: 3.3 US cents per Ordinary Share 19,371
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Total dividends paid during the year 58,316
----------------------------------------------------------- ---------
Note 13: Property, plant and equipment
Accounting policy
Property, plant and equipment
Property, plant and equipment is stated at cost, net of
accumulated depreciation and/or accumulated impairment losses. Such
cost includes the cost of replacing part of the property, plant and
equipment and borrowing costs for qualifying assets (see below) if
the recognition criteria are met. The cost of self-constructed
assets includes the cost of materials, direct labour and an
appropriate proportion of production overheads.
Major spare parts and servicing equipment qualify as property,
plant and equipment when they are expected to be used during more
than one period. Expenditure incurred after the assets have been
put into operation, such as repairs and maintenance and overhaul
costs, are charged to the income statement in the period the costs
are incurred unless it can be demonstrated that the expenditure
results in future economic benefits, when the expenditure is
capitalised as an additional cost.
Upon recognition, items of property, plant and equipment are
divided into components, which represent items with a significant
value that have different useful lives. Assets included in
property, plant and equipment are depreciated over their estimated
useful life taking into account their own physical life limitations
and the present assessment of economically recoverable reserves of
the mine property at which the assets are located. The remaining
useful lives for major assets are reassessed on a regular basis.
Changes in estimates, which affect the unit of production
calculations, are accounted for prospectively.
Except for mining assets, which are depreciated using the unit
of production method, depreciation is calculated on a straight-line
basis over the estimated useful life of the asset, as follows:
-- Buildings: 20-50 years
-- Vessels: 30-40 years
-- Plant and equipment: 3-15 years
-- Vehicles: 7-15 years
-- Fixtures and fittings: 2.5-10 years
An item of property, plant and equipment is derecognised upon
disposal or when no future economic benefits are expected to arise
from the continued use of the asset. Any gain or loss arising on
derecognition of the asset (calculated as the difference between
the net disposal proceeds and the carrying amount of the item) is
included in the income statement in the period the item is
derecognised.
Assets in the course of construction are initially recognised in
assets under construction. Assets under construction are not
depreciated. On completion of the asset and when available for use,
the cost of construction is transferred to the appropriate asset
category in property, plant and equipment and depreciation
commences.
Freehold land is not depreciated.
Deferred stripping costs
Rock, soil and other waste materials are typically to be removed
to access an ore body, which is known as stripping activity.
Stripping work comprises overburden removal at pre-production, mine
extension and production stages.
Pre-production stripping costs incurred in the development of a
component of a mine before commercial production commences are
capitalised as part of assets under construction. After the
commencement of commercial production, the respective capitalised
pre--production stripping costs are transferred to mining assets
and depreciated over the life of the respective component of the
ore body on a unit of production ("UOP") basis.
Production stripping costs are generally charged to the income
statement as variable production costs unless these costs are
related to gaining improved access to an identified component of
the ore body to be mined in future periods. Such production
stripping costs are capitalised within mining assets provided all
the following conditions are met:
-- it is probable that the future economic benefit associated
with the stripping activity will be realised;
-- the component of the ore body for which access has been improved can be identified; and
-- the costs relating to the stripping activity associated with
the improved access can be reliably measured.
Once the commercial production of the specific component of the
ore body commences, the capitalised production stripping costs are
depreciated on a UOP basis over the life of the respective
identified component. No production stripping costs were
capitalised as at 31 December 2018 (2017: nil).
Mining assets
Any capitalised stripping activities, either of a pre-production
or production nature, are reclassified to mining assets at the
point of time when the extraction of the ore body of the specific
component starts. Mining assets are depreciated using the UOP
method based on the estimated economically recoverable reserves to
which they relate.
Exploration and evaluation assets
Costs incurred in relation to the exploration and evaluation of
potential iron ore deposits are capitalised and classified as
tangible or intangible assets depending on the nature of the
expenditures. Costs associated with exploratory drilling,
researching and analysing of exploration data and costs of
pre-feasibility studies are included in tangible assets whereas
those associated with the acquisition of licences are included in
intangible assets.
Capitalised exploration and evaluation expenditures are carried
forward as an asset as long as these costs are expected to be
recouped in full through successful development and exploration in
a future period.
Exploration and evaluation assets are measured at cost and are
neither amortised nor depreciated, but monitored for indications of
impairment. To the extent that the capitalised expenditures are not
expected to be recouped, the excess is fully provided for in the
financial year in which this is determined.
Upon reaching the development stage, exploration and evaluation
assets are either transferred to assets under construction or other
intangible assets, if those costs were associated with the
acquisition of licences.
Borrowing costs
Borrowing costs directly attributable to the acquisition,
construction or production of an asset that necessarily takes a
substantial period of time to get ready for its intended use or
sale (qualifying asset) are capitalised as part of the cost of the
respective asset. All other borrowing costs are expensed in the
period they occur. Borrowing costs consist of interest and other
costs incurred in connection with the borrowing of the funds. In
the case of general borrowings used to fund the acquisition or
construction of a qualifying asset, the borrowing costs to be
capitalised are calculated based on a weighted average interest
rate applicable to the relevant general borrowings of the Group
during a specific period.
Impairment testing
Property, plant and equipment is considered to be part of a
single cash-generating unit ("CGU"). The recoverable amount of the
CGU is determined to be the fair value less cost of disposal. The
Group assesses at each reporting date whether there are indications
that assets may be impaired or previously recognised impairment
losses may no longer exist or may have decreased. If such
indication exists, or when annual impairment testing for an asset,
such as goodwill, is required, the Group estimates the assets'
recoverable amounts. If the carrying amount of an asset exceeds its
recoverable amount, the asset is considered to be impaired and is
written down to its recoverable amount. Impairment losses are
recognised in the income statement.
The Group assesses at each reporting date whether a financial
asset or group of financial assets is impaired. Individual balances
of receivables and prepayments are assessed at each reporting date
and written off when management deems that there is no possibility
of recovery. Further information on the result of the annual
impairment testing of goodwill is provided in Note 14 Goodwill and
other intangible assets.
A previously recognised impairment loss is reversed only if
there has been a change in the estimates used to determine the
asset's recoverable amount since the last impairment loss was
recognised. In this case, the carrying amount of the asset is
increased to its recoverable amount, but not exceeding the carrying
amount that would have been determined, net of depreciation, had no
impairment loss been recognised for the asset in prior years. Such
reversal is recognised in the income statement and the basis for
future depreciation is adjusted accordingly. Impairment losses in
respect of goodwill are not reversed.
Capitalised stripping costs
Stripping costs are deferred and capitalised if related to
gaining improved access to an identified component of an ore body
to be mined in future periods. The capitalised amount is determined
based on the volume of waste extracted, compared with expected ore
volume in the identified component of the ore body. As at 31
December 2018, deferred pre-production stripping costs totalling
US$101,305 thousand relate to components in operation and are
included in mining assets (2017: US$110,124 thousand). Deferred
pre-production stripping costs in relation to components expected
to be put into operation in a future period totalled US$34,498
thousand and are included in assets under construction (2017:
US$22,734 thousand). No production stripping costs are capitalised
as of this point of time.
As at 31 December 2018, property, plant and equipment
comprised:
Exploration Plant Fixtures Assets
and Mining and and under
US$000 evaluation Land assets Buildings Vessels equipment Vehicles fittings construction Total
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Cost:
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
At 1 January
2017 1,519 2,838 108,230 142,883 103,383 184,221 131,471 5,453 160,001 839,999
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Additions 157 769 489 175 1,355 (192) (354) 237 121,007 123,643
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Transfers - 19 92,058 13,281 3,747 25,863 11,125 780 (146,873) -
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Disposals - - - (936) (257) (9,096) (2,529) (175) (479) (13,472)
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Translation
differences (58) (123) (9,811) (5,088) 9,916 (6,437) (4,579) (97) (2,174) (18,451)
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
At 31 December
2017 1,618 3,503 190,966 150,315 118,144 194,359 135,134 6,198 131,482 931,719
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Additions - 1,235 (49) 628 61 615 (697) 27 145,641 147,461
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Transfers - - 52 23,598 3,363 35,025 20,370 885 (83,293) -
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Disposals - - - (2,565) (109) (7,498) (4,721) (136) (1,205) (16,234)
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Translation
differences 22 24 2,612 1,816 (3,441) 2,307 1,412 53 (302) 4,503
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
At 31 December
2018 1,640 4,762 193,581 173,792 118,018 224,808 151,498 7,027 192,323 1,067,449
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Depreciation:
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
At 1 January
2017 - 2 44,811 37,263 33,985 81,625 61,116 3,772 2,586 265,160
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Depreciation
charge - 3 8,433 7,747 9,093 17,388 12,228 628 - 55,520
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Disposals - - - (633) - (4,595) (1,637) (160) - (7,025)
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Impairment - - - 44 - 1 2 - (8) 39
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Translation
differences - - (1,842) (1,467) 3,627 (3,133) (2,451) (41) (27) (5,334)
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
At 31 December
2017 - 5 51,402 42,954 46,705 91,286 69,258 4,199 2,551 308,360
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Depreciation
charge - 3 6,907 9,220 9,710 23,945 15,891 702 - 66,378
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Disposals - - - (811) 11 (5,716) (3,628) (124) - (10,268)
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Impairment - - - (79) - 255 18 - 168 362
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Translation
differences - - 546 427 (1,466) 970 743 9 12 1,241
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
At 31 December
2018 - 8 58,855 51,711 54,960 110,740 82,282 4,786 2,731 366,073
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Net book value
at:
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
31 December
2017 1,618 3,498 139,564 107,361 71,439 103,073 65,876 1,999 128,931 623,359
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
31 December
2018 1,640 4,754 134,726 122,081 63,058 114,068 69,216 2,241 189,592 701,376
-------------- ----------- ------ -------- --------- ------- --------- -------- -------- ------------ ---------
Assets under construction consist of ongoing capital projects
amounting to US$155,092 thousand (2017: US$106,197 thousand) and
capitalised pre-production stripping costs of US$34,498 thousand
(2017: US$22,734 thousand). Once production commences, stripping
costs are transferred to mining assets.
Property, plant and equipment includes capitalised borrowing
costs on qualifying assets of US$25,499 thousand (2017: US$17,810
thousand). The capitalised borrowing costs on general borrowings
were determined based on the capitalisation rate of 9.65% (2017:
9.0%), which is the average effective interest rate on general
borrowings during the period. The Group has no specific borrowings
in relation to qualifying assets during either reporting
period.
The carrying value of equipment held under finance leases and
hire purchase contracts at 31 December 2018 was US$1,881 thousand
(2017: US$2,214 thousand). Leased assets and assets under hire
purchase contracts are pledged as security for the related finance
leases and hire purchase liabilities. US$42,340 thousand of
property, plant and equipment have been pledged as security for
liabilities (2017: US$47,921 thousand).
The gross value of fully depreciated property, plant and
equipment that is still in use is US$40,041 thousand (2017:
US$24,728 thousand).
Note 14: Goodwill and other intangible assets
Accounting policy
Goodwill
If the cost of acquisition in a business combination exceeds the
identifiable net assets attributable to the Group, the difference
is considered as purchased goodwill, which is not amortised. After
initial recognition, goodwill is measured at cost less any
accumulated impairment losses.
Goodwill is reviewed for indication of impairment annually and,
in case those are identified, an impairment assessment is
conducted. An impairment loss recognised for goodwill is never
reversed in a subsequent period. In the case that the identifiable
net assets attributable to the Group exceed the cost of
acquisition, the difference is recognised in profit and loss as a
gain on bargain purchase. For each business combination, the Group
measures the non-controlling interest in the acquiree either at
fair value or at the proportionate share of the acquiree's
identifiable net assets. If the initial accounting for a business
combination cannot be completed by the end of the reporting period
in which the combination occurs, only provisional amounts are
reported, which can be adjusted during the measurement period of 12
months after acquisition date.
Exploration and evaluation assets
See the policy disclosed in Note 13 Property, plant and
equipment.
Other intangible assets
Other intangible assets acquired separately are measured on
initial recognition at cost and the useful lives are assessed as
either finite or indefinite. Following the initial recognition, the
intangible assets are carried at cost less accumulated amortisation
and accumulated impairment losses. If amortised, the intangible
assets are amortised on a straight-line basis over the estimated
useful life of the asset, ranging between one and three years.
Capitalised mineral licences are amortised on a unit of production
basis.
The cost of other intangible assets acquired in a business
combination is its fair value as at the date of acquisition.
As at 31 December 2018, goodwill and other intangible assets
comprised:
Other
Exploration Patents Computer intangible
US$000 Goodwill and evaluation and licences software assets Total
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Cost:
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
At 1 January 2017 29,033 2,705 1,881 4,333 101 38,053
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Additions - - - 138 3,270 3,408
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Disposals - - - (28) - (28)
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Transfers - - 2,882 382 (3,264) -
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Translation differences (933) (84) (217) 80 30 (1,124)
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
At 31 December 2017 28,100 2,621 4,546 4,905 137 40,309
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Additions - - 1,053 75 1,930 3,058
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Disposals - - (73) (17) (4) (94)
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Transfers - - 68 342 (410) -
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Translation differences 396 37 (13) (15) (55) 350
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
At 31 December 2018 28,496 2,658 5,581 5,290 1,598 43,623
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Accumulated amortisation and impairment:
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
At 1 January 2017 - - 769 2,064 - 2,833
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Amortisation charge - - 172 300 - 472
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Disposals - - - (28) - (28)
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Translation differences - - 22 152 - 174
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
At 31 December 2017 - - 963 2,488 - 3,451
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Amortisation charge - - 290 428 - 718
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Disposals - - (73) (14) - (87)
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Translation differences - - (12) (56) - (68)
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
At 31 December 2018 - - 1,168 2,846 - 4,014
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
Net book value at:
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
31 December 2017 28,100 2,621 3,583 2,417 137 36,858
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
31 December 2018 28,496 2,658 4,413 2,444 1,598 39,609
----------------------------------------- -------- --------------- ------------- --------- ----------- -------
The goodwill acquired through business combinations in previous
periods has been allocated for impairment purposes to a single
cash- generating unit, as the Group only has one operating segment,
being the production and sale of iron ore products. This represents
the lowest level within the Group at which goodwill is monitored
for internal management purposes.
The major component of other intangible assets comprises mining
licences and purchased software.
Impairment testing
Impairment testing was performed at 31 December 2018 based on a
fair value less cost of disposal calculation using cash flow
projections over the remaining estimated lives of the GPL and the
Yerystivske deposits, which are expected to expire in 2038 and
2048, respectively, according to the current approved mine plans.
The estimated production volumes are based on these mine plans and
do not take into account the effects of expected future mine life
extension programmes. The cash flow projection is based on a
financial long-term model approved by the senior management
covering the expected life of the mines. The production capacity
remains at a fixed level once full capacity is reached and
therefore no perpetual growth rate is applied for the cash flow
projections beyond this point of time.
The key assumptions used for the impairment testing are:
Estimates/assumptions Basis
------------------------------- --------------------------------------
Future production Proved and probable reserves
------------------------------- --------------------------------------
Contract prices and longer-term price
Commodity prices estimates
------------------------------- --------------------------------------
Capital expenditures Future sustaining capital expenditures
------------------------------- --------------------------------------
Cost of raw materials and other
production/distribution costs Expected future costs
------------------------------- --------------------------------------
Exchange rates Current market exchange rates
------------------------------- --------------------------------------
Cost of capital risk adjusted for
Discount rates the resource concerned
------------------------------- --------------------------------------
Cash flows are projected based on management's expectations
regarding the development of the iron ore and steel market and the
cost of producing and distributing the pellets. The Group takes
into account two key assumptions: selling price and total
production costs considering relevant macro and local factors.
In determining the future long-term selling price, the Group
takes into account external and internal analysis of the
longer-term and shorter-term supply and demand dynamics in the
local region and throughout the world along with costs of
production of competitors and the marginal cost of incremental
production in a particular market. The Group considers local supply
and demand balances affecting its major customers and the effects
this could have on the longer-term price. The assumptions for iron
ore prices ranged from US$62 per tonne to US$69 per tonne of 62% Fe
fines CFR North China (2017: US$60 per tonne to US$63 per
tonne).
Cost of production and shipping is considered taking into
account local inflationary pressures, major exchange rate
developments between local currency and the US Dollar, the
longer-term and shorter-term trends in energy supply and demand and
the effect on costs along with the expected movements in
steel-related commodity prices, which affect the cost of certain
production inputs.
For the purpose of the goodwill impairment test, the future cash
flows were discounted using a pre-tax real discount rate of 12.7%
(2017: 14.0%) per annum. These rates reflect the time value of
money and risk associated with the asset, and are in line with the
rates used by competitors with a similar background.
Sensitivity to changes in assumptions
Management believes that due to the available headroom resulting
from the Group's impairment testing of its operating assets, no
reasonable change in the above key assumptions would cause the
carrying value of these operating assets to materially exceed its
recoverable amount.
Note 15: Other non-current assets
As at 31 December 2018, other non-current assets comprised:
As at As at
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
---------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Prepayments for property, plant and equipment 24,993 10,283
----------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Prepaid bank arrangement fees 6,552 -
----------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Other non-current assets 559 218
----------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total other non-current assets 32,104 10,501
----------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Note 16: Inventories
Accounting policy
Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realisable
value.
Costs incurred in bringing each product to its present location
and condition are accounted for as follows:
-- Raw materials - at cost on a first-in, first-out basis.
-- Finished goods and work in progress - at cost of direct
materials and labour and a proportion of manufacturing overheads
based on normal operating capacity, but excluding borrowing
costs.
-- Lean and weathered ore - at cost, if lower than net realisable value.
The net realisable value is the estimated selling price in the
ordinary course of business, less estimated costs of completion
(conversion into pellets or concentrate) and the estimated costs
necessary to sell the product or goods.
Major spare parts and servicing equipment that meet the
definition of property, plant and equipment are, in accordance with
IAS 16, included in property, plant and equipment and not in
inventory.
Critical estimates
Lean and weathered ore
Iron ore of various grades is being extracted at the Group's two
operating mines GPL and Yerystivske. In order to maximise the
operational efficiency and output of the processing facility at
FPM, management determines the optimal mix and grade of ore to be
delivered to the processing facility from each mine. During the
last financial years, including the financial year 2018, ore of a
lower iron content was stockpiled due to limited processing
capacities.
It is the Group's intention to process the stockpiled ore once
additional processing capacities are available. This additional
capacity is currently being constructed and expected to be
completed in the first half of the financial year 2020 and as a
consequence the entire balance is classified as non-current.
As at 31 December 2018, the stockpiled ore valued at cost
totalled US$217,688 thousand (2017: US$175,831 thousand). Critical
estimates in determining the net realisable value of lean and
weathered ore includes i) utilisation of the ore over the period
from 2020 to 2034, representing an average of 10 % of total
available processing capacity, and using an asset specific WACC
based pre-tax discount rate of 19.0%; and ii) forecast long-term
iron ore prices of US$77 per tonne.
The net realisable value of lean and weathered ore is most
sensitive to delays in the commencement of utilising the ore in the
production process, which depends on the completion of the capacity
upgrade programme at FPM. Two separate stress tests assuming a one
year delay and a US$5 per tonne lower forecast long-term iron ore
price would result in a reduction in the net realisable value of
US$46,700 thousand and US$25,500 thousand, respectively.
At 31 December 2018, inventories comprised:
As at As at
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
-------------------------------- --------- ---------
Raw materials and consumables 39,083 34,295
-------------------------------- --------- ---------
Spare parts 56,873 42,053
-------------------------------- --------- ---------
Finished ore pellets 43,097 15,482
-------------------------------- --------- ---------
Work in progress 3,153 2,475
-------------------------------- --------- ---------
Other 2,713 2,340
-------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total inventories - current 144,919 96,645
-------------------------------- --------- ---------
Lean and weathered ore 217,688 175,831
-------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total inventories - non-current 217,688 175,831
-------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total inventories 362,607 272,476
-------------------------------- --------- ---------
Inventories classified as non-current mainly comprise lean and
weathered ore that are, based on the Group's current processing
plans, not planned to be processed within the next year. It is the
Group's intention to process this ore at a later point of time and
it is expected that it will take more than one year to process this
stockpile, depending on the Group's future mining activities,
processing capabilities and anticipated market conditions.
Note 17: Trade and other receivables
Accounting policy
Trade receivables are stated at original invoice amount less an
allowance for expected credit losses. The Group measures the loss
allowance at an amount equal to the 12-month expected credit losses
of its customers based on publicly available default risk ratings
adjusted for current observable circumstances, forecast information
and past history of credit losses. All of the Group's receivable
balances are classified as current based on the agreed terms and
conditions and the Group has no history of credit losses.
Individual balances are written off when management deems that
there is no possibility of recovery.
Trade receivables include provisionally priced sales, which are
open at the end of the reporting period. Certain contracts have
embedded provisional pricing mechanisms, which have the character
of commodity derivatives that are carried at fair value through
profit and loss. Revenues on these contracts are initially
recognised at the estimated fair value of consideration receivable,
based on the contractual price, and adjusted at the end of each
subsequent reporting period on the basis of changes in iron ore
prices and the specific underlying contract terms. Final prices
based on the relevant index are normally known within 60 days after
the reporting period. Further information on the fair value of the
embedded provisional pricing mechanism at 31 December 2018 is
disclosed in Note 26 Financial instruments.
At 31 December 2018, trade and other receivables comprised:
As at As at
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
----------------------------------- --------- ---------
Trade receivables 83,945 85,645
----------------------------------- --------- ---------
Other receivables 2,840 3,364
----------------------------------- --------- ---------
Allowance for doubtful receivables (1,090) (682)
----------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total trade and other receivables 85,695 88,327
----------------------------------- --------- ---------
As trade receivables are non-interest bearing and final invoices
are generally settled within 90 days after delivery, contracts with
customers are not deemed to contain a significant financing
component.
Trade receivables at 31 December 2018 includes US$1,517 thousand
(2017: US$1,237 thousand) owed by related parties. The detailed
related party disclosures are made in Note 33 Related party
disclosures.
The cumulative effects from the application of the new standard
IFRS 9 Financial instruments on the consolidated statement of
financial position as of 1 January 2018 and as at 31 December 2018
is disclosed in Note 3 New accounting policies.
The movement in the allowance for doubtful debts during the
period under review was:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Opening balance 682 926
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Impact of first-time application of IFRS 9 218 -
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Increase 452 177
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Release (230) (445)
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Translation differences (32) 24
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Closing balance 1,090 682
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
During the financial year 2018 there was no movement in the
allowance for doubtful debts relating to lifetime expected credit
losses and credit impaired assets.
The following table shows the Group's receivables at the
reporting date that are subject to credit risk and the ageing and
impairment profile thereon:
Receivables past
due but not impaired
------------------ ------- ----------- ----------- -------------------------
Receivables
neither
past Less 45 to Over
As at 31.12.18 Gross Receivables due nor than 90 90
US$000 amount impaired impaired 45 days days days
------------------ ------- ----------- ----------- ---------- ------ -----
Trade receivables 83,945 732 81,052 1,400 375 386
------------------ ------- ----------- ----------- ---------- ------ -----
Other receivables 2,840 358 2,274 23 27 158
------------------ ------- ----------- ----------- ---------- ------ -----
Receivables past
due but not impaired
------------------ ------- ----------- ----------- -------------------------
Receivables
neither
past Less 45 to Over
As at 31.12.17 Gross Receivables due nor than 90 90
US$000 amount impaired impaired 45 days days days
------------------ ------- ----------- ----------- ---------- ------ -----
Trade receivables 85,645 431 84,154 282 154 624
------------------ ------- ----------- ----------- ---------- ------ -----
Other receivables 3,364 251 2,923 101 5 84
------------------ ------- ----------- ----------- ---------- ------ -----
Of the total balance of receivables impaired as of 31 December
2018 US$712 thousand (2017: US$682 thousand) was past due.
The table above includes the impact from the application of the
new expected credit loss impairment model under IFRS 9 Financial
instruments. The change of the balance of impairment losses on
trade receivables recognised in the consolidated income statement
as of 31 December 2018 is not material and therefore not disclosed
separately in the consolidated income statement. For further
information see the table above and Note 3 New accounting
policies.
The Group's exposures to credit, currency and commodity risks
are disclosed in Note 26 Financial instruments.
Note 18: Prepayments and other current assets
As at 31 December 2018, prepayments and other current assets
comprised:
As at As at
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Prepayments to suppliers:
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Electricity and gas 7,458 2,729
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Materials and spare parts 5,191 3,068
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Services 3,552 2,650
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Other prepayments 602 615
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Prepaid bank arrangement fees 2,293 4,384
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Prepaid expenses 8,171 4,069
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Other 77 -
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total prepayments and other current assets 27,344 17,514
------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Prepayments at 31 December 2018 include US$1,181 thousand (2017:
US$1,259 thousand) made to related parties. The detailed related
party disclosures are made in Note 33 Related party
disclosures.
The cumulative effects from the application of the new standard
IFRS 15 Revenue from contracts with customers on the consolidated
statement of financial position as at 1 January 2018 and as at 31
December 2018 are disclosed in Note 3 New accounting policies.
Note 19: Other taxes recoverable and payable
Accounting policy
Value added tax
Revenues, expenses and assets are recognised net of the amount
of value added tax ("VAT"), except:
-- where VAT incurred on a purchase of assets or services is not
recoverable from the taxation authority, in which case VAT is
recognised as part of the cost of acquisition of the asset or as
part of the expense item as applicable; and
-- receivables and payables are stated with the amount of VAT included.
VAT receivable balances are not discounted unless the overdue
balances are expected to be received after more than 12 months
following the period end.
As at 31 December 2018, other taxes recoverable comprised:
As at As at
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------------------------------ --------- ---------
VAT receivable 44,730 23,081
------------------------------------------ --------- ---------
Other taxes prepaid 107 111
------------------------------------------ --------- ---------
Total other taxes recoverable and prepaid 44,837 23,192
------------------------------------------ --------- ---------
The table below provides a reconciliation of the VAT receivable
balance in Ukraine:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17
----------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Opening balance, gross 22,444 20,565
----------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Net VAT incurred 127,363 99,536
----------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
VAT refunds received in cash (106,341) (96,824)
----------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Translation differences 2 292 (833)
----------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Closing balance, gross 43,758 22,444
----------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Allowance (1,020) (1,190)
----------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Closing balance, net 42,738 21,254
----------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
US$13,328 thousand of the total VAT receivable balance in
Ukraine was overdue as at 31 December 2018 (2017: US$678 thousand).
US$12,641 thousand of the aforementioned overdue balance was
refunded by the end of January 2019.The allowance of US$1,020
thousand (2017: US$1,190 thousand) is related to uncertainties in
terms of the recovery of VAT receivable balances of one of the
Ukrainian subsidiaries with its mine still being developed.
As at 31 December 2018, other taxes payable comprised:
As at As at
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
-------------------------- --------- ---------
Environmental tax 1,449 1,010
-------------------------- --------- ---------
Royalties 6,669 3,494
-------------------------- --------- ---------
VAT payable 235 159
-------------------------- --------- ---------
Other taxes 3,212 2,932
-------------------------- --------- ---------
Total other taxes payable 11,565 7,595
-------------------------- --------- ---------
See Note 11 Taxation for information in respect of a withholding
tax claim in Ukraine.
Note 20: Trade and other payables
Accounting policy
Trade and other payables are not interest-bearing, being
generally short-term, and are stated at their original invoice
amount.
As at 31 December 2018, trade and other payables comprised:
As at As at
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
--------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Materials and services 30,446 30,040
--------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Payables for equipment 3,755 2,084
--------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Other 91 296
--------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total current trade and other payables 34,292 32,420
--------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Trade and other payables at 31 December 2018 includes US$1,428
thousand (2017: US$1,770 thousand) due to related parties (see Note
33 Related party disclosures).
The Group's exposure to currency and liquidity risk related to
trade and other payables is disclosed in Note 26 Financial
instruments.
Note 21: Pension and post-employment obligations
Accounting policy
The defined benefit costs relating to the plans operated by the
Group in the different countries are determined and accrued in the
consolidated financial statements using the projected unit credit
method for those employees entitled to such payments. The
underlying assumptions are defined by management and the defined
benefit pension liability is calculated by independent actuaries at
the end of each annual reporting period.
Remeasurements, comprising actuarial gains and losses, are
immediately reflected in the statement of financial position. The
corresponding charge or credit is recognised in the other
comprehensive income of the period in which it occurred and
immediately reflected in retained earnings as not reclassified to
the income statement in subsequent periods.
The costs of managing plan assets are deducted from the return
on plan assets reflected in other comprehensive income. All other
scheme administration costs are charged to the income statement.
The net interest is calculated by applying the discount rate to the
net defined benefit pension liability or plan assets. Any past
service costs are recognised in the income statement at the earlier
of when the plan amendment occurs or when related restructuring
costs are recognised.
The service costs (including current and past) are included in
cost of sales, selling and distribution expenses and general and
administrative expenses in the consolidated income statement
whereas the net finance expenses are included in finance expenses.
The effects from remeasurements are recognised in other
comprehensive income.
The defined benefit pension liability is the aggregate of the
defined benefit obligation less plan assets of funded schemes. The
Group operates funded and unfunded schemes.
The Group's expenses in relation to defined contribution plans
are charged directly to the income statement.
The Group mainly operates defined benefit plans for qualifying
employees of its subsidiaries in Ukraine and Switzerland. All local
defined benefit pension liabilities are calculated by independent
actuaries applying accepted actuarial techniques. In addition to
the aforementioned schemes, the Group operates a defined benefit
scheme in Austria and contribution plans for qualifying employees
in the UK and in Singapore.
Details of the major defined benefit schemes in Ukraine and
Switzerland are provided below:
Ukraine
The Group's subsidiaries in Ukraine make defined contributions
to the Ukrainian State Pension scheme at statutory rates based on
the gross salary payments made to the employees. PJSC Ferrexpo
Poltava Mining ("FPM") and LLC Ferrexpo Yeristovo Mining ("FYM")
also have a legal obligation to compensate the Ukrainian State
Pension Fund for additional pensions paid to certain categories of
its current and former employees. All pension schemes in Ukraine
are unfunded.
There was no change in the Ukrainian pension legislation during
the financial year 2018 whereas in the comparative year the
Ukrainian pension legislation was changed in October 2017 by
adjusting the average state salary for the years 2014 to 2018,
stepwise increasing insurance length of services and decreasing the
coefficient for one year of service. Following the change to the
pension legislation, the pensions for the current pensioners have
been recalculated and have resulted in a past service cost gain of
US$4,038 thousand as of 31 December 2017 for both Ukrainian
schemes.
As of 1 December of the comparative year 2017, FPM's collective
agreement was changed in order to remove FPM's obligation of
additional payments to its employees reaching retirement age in
order to improve their welfare. This change affected 6,992
employees and resulted in a curtailment gain of US$655 thousand. No
changes in FPM's collective agreement were made during the
financial year 2018.
At 31 December 2018, the pension schemes in Ukraine covered
4,377 current employees (2017: 4,302 people) following the
above-mentioned change of the collective agreement for FPM. There
are 900 former employees currently in receipt of pensions (2017:
956 people).
Switzerland
The employees of the Group's Swiss operation are covered under a
collective pension plan (multi-employer plan), which is governed in
accordance with the requirements of Swiss law. The funding, of
which two-thirds is contributed by the employer and one-third by
the employees, is based on the regulations of the pension scheme
and Swiss law. The pension scheme in Switzerland is funded and the
assets of the pension scheme are held separately from those of the
Group and are invested with an insurance company. The accumulated
capital of the employees is subject to interests determined by the
local legislation and defined in the regulations of the pension
scheme.
On retirement, employees are entitled to receive either a lump
sum or an annual proportion of their accumulated capital as a
pension underpinned by certain guarantees. The Group, and in
certain cases the employees, make contributions to the pension
scheme as a percentage of the insured salaries and depending on the
age of the employees.
At 31 December 2018, the Swiss pension scheme covered 21 people
(2017: 20 people).
The principal assumptions used in determining the defined
benefit obligation are shown below:
Year ended
31.12.18 Year ended 31.12.17
--------------------------------- ------------------ ---------------------
Ukrainian Swiss Ukrainian Swiss
schemes scheme schemes scheme
--------------------------------- --------- ------- ----------- --------
Discount rate 14.00% 0.95% 13.00% 0.80%
--------------------------------- --------- ------- ----------- --------
Retail price inflation 6.38% 1.00% 7.44% 1.00%
--------------------------------- --------- ------- ----------- --------
Expected future salary increase 7.85% 1.25% 9.22% 1.25%
--------------------------------- --------- ------- ----------- --------
Expected future benefit increase 6.38% 0.00% 8.48% 0.00%
--------------------------------- --------- ------- ----------- --------
Female life expectancy (years) 81.7 89.5 81.5 89.4
--------------------------------- --------- ------- ----------- --------
Male life expectancy (years) 77.4 87.5 77.2 87.4
--------------------------------- --------- ------- ----------- --------
As at As at
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
----------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Present value of funded defined benefit obligation 6,920 5,094
----------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Fair value of plan assets (4,483) (3,183)
----------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Funded status 2,437 1,911
----------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Present value of unfunded defined benefit obligation 19,001 18,603
----------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Defined benefit pension liability 21,438 20,514
----------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof for Ukrainian schemes 18,913 18,504
----------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof for Swiss scheme 2,437 1,911
----------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof for schemes in other jurisdictions 88 99
----------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Amounts recognised in the income statement or other
comprehensive income are as follows:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Defined benefit cost/(gains) charged in the income statement:
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Current service cost 1,234 943
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Past service cost - (4,038)
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Curtailment gains - (655)
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Interest cost on defined benefit obligation 2,416 2,116
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Interest income on plan assets (31) (20)
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Administration cost 23 22
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total defined benefit cost/(gains) charged in the income
statement 3,642 (1,632)
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Remeasurement cost/(gains) in other comprehensive income:
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Remeasurement from demographic assumptions 229 (799)
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Remeasurement from financial assumptions (5,035) 7,682
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Experience adjustment 3,895 2,468
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Return on plan assets 36 (179)
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total remeasurement cost/(gains) in other comprehensive
income (875) 9,172
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total defined benefit cost 2,767 7,540
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof for Ukrainian schemes 1,893 7,232
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof for Swiss scheme 878 301
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof for schemes in other jurisdictions (4) 7
-------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
The effect from remeasurement of financial assumptions relates
to an increase of the discount rate for the Ukrainian schemes as of
31 December 2018 compared to a decrease as of the end of the
comparative year ended 31 December 2017. The effect from the
experience adjustments relates to higher than assumed salary
increases in Ukraine during the financial years 2017 and 2018.
Changes in the present value of the defined benefit obligation
are as follows:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Opening defined benefit obligation 23,697 18,324
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Current service cost 1,234 943
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Interest cost on defined benefit obligation 2,416 2,116
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Remeasurement losses/(gains) (947) 9,352
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Translation differences 221 (480)
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Contributions paid by employer (1,700) (1,539)
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Contributions paid by employees 119 112
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Benefits paid and net transfers through pension assets 881 (424)
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Curtailment gains - (669)
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Plan amendments - (4,038)
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Closing defined benefit obligation 25,921 23,697
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof for Ukrainian schemes 18,913 18,504
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof for Swiss scheme 6,920 5,094
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof for schemes in other jurisdictions 88 99
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof for active employees 16,824 14,256
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof for vested terminations 4,865 4,414
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof for pensioners 4,232 5,027
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
The durations of the defined benefit obligation for the
different schemes as at 31 December 2018 are 9.1 years (Ukraine)
and 20.4 years (Switzerland).
Contributions to the defined benefit plans, including benefits
paid by employer and employee contributions, are expected to be
US$1,566 thousand for the schemes in Ukraine and US$703 thousand in
Switzerland in the next financial year.
The expenses in relation to the defined contribution plan in the
UK and Singapore totalled US$60 thousand (2017: US$50
thousand).
Changes in the fair values of the plan assets are as
follows:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Opening fair value of plan assets 3,183 2,835
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Interest income 31 20
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Contributions paid by employer 344 354
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Contributions paid by employees 119 112
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Benefits paid and net transfers through pension assets 881 (424)
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Return on plan assets (36) 179
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Administration cost (23) (21)
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Translation differences (16) 128
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Closing fair value of plan assets 4,483 3,183
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof for Swiss scheme 4,483 3,183
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
The asset allocation of the plan assets of the Swiss scheme is
as follows:
As at As at As at As at
%/US$000 31.12.18 31.12.18 31.12.17 31.12.17
---------------------------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
Scheme assets at fair value
---------------------------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
Equities 29.4 1,318 26.6 847
---------------------------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
Bonds 32.7 1,466 35.6 1,133
---------------------------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
Properties 12.7 569 10.5 334
---------------------------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
Other 25.2 1,130 27.3 869
---------------------------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
Fair value of scheme assets 100.0 4,483 100.0 3,183
---------------------------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
The pension assets are included in a multi-employer plan and no
information in respect of the split of the investments into quoted
and non-quoted assets is available. Taking into account the
requirements of Swiss law, it is assumed that equities and bonds
reflect investments into quoted assets whereas a portion of the
other assets in the portfolio could be investments into non-quoted
assets.
Changes to interest rates and future salary increases in Ukraine
are considered to be the main pension-related risks for the Group,
as such changes are likely to affect the balance of the Group's
defined benefit obligation. The percentage used to calculate the
sensitivities was set under consideration of the volatility for
these assumptions for the Ukrainian schemes and has also been
applied for the Group's less material schemes in other
jurisdictions.
Following new rules in Ukrainian pension legislation, the
pension indexation is defined by the future salary increases and
the local inflation rate. As a result of this change, no
sensitivity for the indexation of pension is calculated anymore for
the Ukrainian schemes, but the sensitivity for local inflation is
used instead.
Changes to the significant assumptions would have the following
effects on the defined benefit obligation in the different
jurisdictions:
Year ended 31.12.18
---------------------------- ----------------------------------------------------------------------
Ukrainian Swiss Other Ukrainian Swiss Other
US$000 schemes scheme jurisdictions schemes scheme jurisdictions
---------------------------- --------- ------- -------------- --------- ------- --------------
Increase by Decrease by
---------------------------- ---------------------------------- ----------------------------------
1.0% 1.0% 1.0% 1.0% 1.0% 1.0%
or or or or or or
Change 1 year 1 year 1 year 1 year 1 year 1 year
---------------------------- --------- ------- -------------- --------- ------- --------------
Discount rate (%) (1,603) (1,136) (8) 1,774 1,574 9
---------------------------- --------- ------- -------------- --------- ------- --------------
Future salary increases (%) 1,044 152 8 (946) (135) (8)
---------------------------- --------- ------- -------------- --------- ------- --------------
Local inflation (%) 501 6 n/a (496) (6) n/a
---------------------------- --------- ------- -------------- --------- ------- --------------
Indexation of pension (%) n/a 775 n/a n/a n/a n/a
---------------------------- --------- ------- -------------- --------- ------- --------------
Life expectancy (years) 287 156 n/a (336) (157) n/a
---------------------------- --------- ------- -------------- --------- ------- --------------
Year ended 31.12.17
---------------------------- ----------------------------------------------------------------------
Ukrainian Swiss Other Ukrainian Swiss Other
US$000 schemes scheme jurisdictions schemes scheme jurisdictions
---------------------------- --------- ------- -------------- --------- ------- --------------
Increase by Decrease by
---------------------------- ---------------------------------- ----------------------------------
1.0% 1.0% 1.0% 1.0% 1.0% 1.0%
or or or or or or
Change 1 year 1 year 1 year 1 year 1 year 1 year
---------------------------- --------- ------- -------------- --------- ------- --------------
Discount rate (%) (1,587) (868) (9) 1,845 1,221 10
---------------------------- --------- ------- -------------- --------- ------- --------------
Future salary increases (%) 1,324 181 8 (1,178) (162) (9)
---------------------------- --------- ------- -------------- --------- ------- --------------
Local inflation (%) 249 6 n/a (247) (6) n/a
---------------------------- --------- ------- -------------- --------- ------- --------------
Indexation of pension (%) n/a 556 n/a n/a n/a n/a
---------------------------- --------- ------- -------------- --------- ------- --------------
Life expectancy (years) 286 102 n/a (335) (102) n/a
---------------------------- --------- ------- -------------- --------- ------- --------------
For the presentation of the effects of the changes of the
significant assumptions shown in the table above, the present value
of the defined benefit obligation has been calculated based on the
projected unit credit method at the end of the reporting period,
which is the same as the one applied for the calculation of the
defined benefit obligation recognised in the statement of financial
position as at the end of the respective reporting period. The
methods and assumptions used for the sensitivity analysis for the
prior year are unchanged.
Note 22: Provisions
Accounting policy
General
Provisions are recognised when the Group has a present
obligation (legal or constructive) as a result of a past event and
it is probable that an outflow of resources embodying economic
benefits will be required to settle the obligation and a reliable
estimate can be made of the amount of the obligation.
Site restoration
Site restoration provisions are made in respect of the estimated
future costs of closure and restoration and for environmental
rehabilitation costs (determined by an independent expert) in the
accounting period when the related environmental disturbance
occurs. The provision is discounted, if material, and the unwinding
of the discount is included in finance costs. At the time of
establishing the provision, a corresponding asset is capitalised
where it gives rise to a future benefit and depreciated over future
production from the mine to which it relates. The provision is
reviewed on an annual basis for changes in cost estimates, discount
rates or the life of operations.
The provision for site restoration changed as follows during the
financial year 2018:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
---------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Opening balance 2,070 1,071
---------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Unwind of the discount 272 150
---------------------------------------- --------- ---------
(Credit)/charge to the income statement (429) 904
---------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Translation differences 27 (55)
---------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Closing balance 1,940 2,070
---------------------------------------- --------- ---------
The costs of restoration of the different deposits in the
Group's open pit mines are based on amounts determined by an
independent and credited institute taking into account the codes of
practice and laws applicable in Ukraine. The useful lives of the
different pits and mines are determined by the same institute based
on expected annual stripping and production volumes having taken
into account the expected timing and effect of future mine-life
extension programmes. It is expected that the restoration works of
the GPL mine will start after the years 2038, 2041 and 2061 for the
different areas within the mine. The first minor restoration work
of the Yerystivske mine is expected to start after 2032 within the
different dump areas, whereas the removal of equipment and the
flooding of the pit will only begin at the end of the mine's
life.
The provision represents the discounted value of the estimated
costs of decommissioning and restoring the mines at the dates when
the deposits are expected to be depleted in the relevant areas
within the mine. The present value of the provision has been
calculated in Ukrainian Hryvnia using a nominal pre-tax discount
rate of 14% (2017: 13.0%) and the costs are expected to be incurred
once the restoration works begin in the different areas of the
mines.
Uncertainties in estimating the provision include potential
changes in regulatory requirements, decommissioning and reclamation
alternatives and the discount and inflation rates to be used in the
calculations.
Note 23: Accrued liabilities and contract liabilities
As at 31 December 2018, accrued liabilities and contract
liabilities comprised:
As at As at
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
--------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Accrued expenses 6,123 3,721
--------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Accrued interest 6,438 9,358
--------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Accrued employee costs 13,899 12,235
--------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Advances from customers 195 780
--------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Contract liabilities 6,038 1,460
--------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total accrued liabilities and contract liabilities 32,693 27,554
--------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
In the current period, management has reviewed the presentation
of the accrued interest and has reclassified it from
interest-bearing loans and borrowings to accrued liabilities. See
Note 25 Interest-bearing loans and borrowings for further
information.
The cumulative effects from the application of the new standard
IFRS 15 Revenue from contracts with customers on the consolidated
statement of financial position as at 1 January 2018 and as at 31
December 2018 are disclosed in Note 3 New accounting policies.
Note 24: Cash and cash equivalents
Accounting policy
Cash and cash equivalents include cash at bank and on hand and
short-term deposits with original maturity of 90 days or less. Cash
at bank and on hand and short-term deposits are recorded at their
nominal amount as these present an insignificant risk of changes in
value.
As at 31 December 2018, cash and cash equivalents comprised:
As at As at
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
-------------------------------- --------- ---------
Cash at bank and on hand 62,996 97,742
-------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total cash and cash equivalents 62,996 97,742
-------------------------------- --------- ---------
The debt repayments during the financial year ended 31 December
2018 totalled US$308,817 thousand (2017: US$238,602 thousand)
affecting the balance of cash and cash equivalents. Further
information on the Group's gross debt is provided in Note 25
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings.
The balance of cash and cash equivalents held in Ukraine amounts
to US$21,416 thousand as at 31 December 2018 (2017: US$10,281
thousand). The Group's exposure to liquidity, counterparty and
interest rate risk as well as a sensitivity analysis for financial
assets and liabilities are disclosed in Note 26 Financial
instruments.
Note 29 Commitments, contingencies and legal disputes provides
details on the Group's balance of restricted cash and deposits
which has been fully provided for as currently not available to the
Group.
Note 25: Interest-bearing loans and borrowings
Accounting policy
The Group's interest-bearing loans and borrowings are measured
at amortised cost. All loans are in US Dollars. See also Note 26
Financial instruments for more details in respect of the accounting
policies applied. This note provides information about the
contractual terms of the Group's major finance facilities.
As at As at
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Current
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Eurobond issued 172,454 171,202
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Syndicated bank loans - secured - 112,500
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Other bank loans - secured 9,262 16,218
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Other bank loans - unsecured 1,494 1,523
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Obligations under finance leases 29 2,074 3,969
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Trade finance facilities 19,316 -
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Total current interest-bearing loans and borrowings 204,600 305,412
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Non-current
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Eurobond issued - 171,202
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Syndicated bank loans - secured 195,000 -
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Other bank loans - secured - 9,267
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Other bank loans - unsecured 2,258 3,752
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Obligations under finance leases 29 - 2,073
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Total non-current interest-bearing loans and borrowings 197,258 186,294
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Total interest-bearing loans and borrowings 26 401,858 491,706
-------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
In the current period, management has reviewed the presentation
of the accrued interest and has reclassified it from
interest-bearing loans and borrowings to accrued liabilities in
order to better reflect the nature of this balance in the
presentation. US$9,358 thousand have been re-presented for the
comparative year ended 31 December 2017 to be on a consistent
basis. There has been no restatement of the underlying financial
information.
At 31 December 2018, the Group has a syndicated revolving
US$400,000 thousand pre-export finance facility, of which
US$205,000 thousand is available (31 December 2017: US$195,000
thousand) and US$195,000 thousand is drawn by the Group (31
December 2017: nil). The initial facility agreement for a total
amount of US$195,000 thousand was signed on 16 November 2017 and
fully drawn in March 2018. In August 2018, an amendment to the
aforementioned facility agreement was signed, increasing the
facility from US$195,000 thousand to US$400,000 thousand and
extending the tenor by one year. The effective date of the increase
and extension is 6 November 2018. Following a one-year grace
period, the facility will be amortised in 12 quarterly instalments,
with the first instalment due on 6 February 2020 and the final
repayment due on 6 November 2022. The Group has drawn on 4 March
2019 US$185,000 thousand under the afore-mentioned extended
facility.
The aforementioned bank debt facility was guaranteed and secured
as follows:
-- Ferrexpo AG and Ferrexpo Middle East FZE, which are also
joint borrowers, assigned the rights to revenue from certain sales
contracts;
-- PJSC Ferrexpo Poltava Mining assigned all of its rights of
certain export contracts for the sale of pellets to Ferrexpo AG and
Ferrexpo Middle East FZE; and
-- the Group pledged bank accounts of Ferrexpo AG and Ferrexpo
Middle East FZE into which sales proceeds from assigned sales
contracts are exclusively received.
In July 2018, the Group made the final repayment of another
syndicated revolving US$350,000 thousand pre-export finance
facility. As at the end of the comparative year ended 31 December
2017, US$131,250 thousand was available and US$112,500 thousand
drawn by the Group.
In addition to the major bank debt facility mentioned above, the
Group had outstanding unsecured Notes at par value totalling
US$173,181 thousand as at 31 December 2018 (31 December 2017:
US$346,385 thousand). The Notes have a 10.375% interest coupon
payable semi-annually. The Notes with maturity dates on 7 April
2019 and 2018, respectively, were repaid in two equal instalments
of US$173,181 thousand.
As at 31 December 2018, the Group had open trade finance
facilities in the amount of US$19,316 thousand (2017: nil). Trade
finance facilities are secured against receivables related to these
specific trades.
The outstanding unsecured Notes are shown net of associated
arrangement fees while for the revolving syndicated pre-export
finance facility, fees are presented in prepayments and current
assets and other non-current assets based on the maturity of the
underlying facility and are amortised over the term of the
facility.
The table below shows the movements in the interest-bearing
loans and borrowings:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
--------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Opening balance of interest-bearing loans and borrowings 491,706 723,154
--------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Cash movements
--------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Repayments of Eurobond issued (173,181) -
--------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Proceeds from syndicated bank loans - secured 195,000 -
--------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Repayments of syndicated bank loans - secured (112,500) (193,750)
--------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Repayments of other bank loans - secured (17,189) (20,512)
--------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Repayments of other bank loans - unsecured (1,512) (1,534)
--------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Repayments of obligations under finance leases (3,753) (3,690)
--------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Change of trade finance facilities, net 19,288 (19,025)
--------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total cash movements (93,847) (238,511)
--------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Non-cash movements
--------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Amortisation of fees 4,696 7,014
--------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Others (including translation differences) (697) 49
--------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total non-cash movements 3,999 7,063
--------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Closing balance of interest-bearing loans and borrowings 401,858 491,706
--------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Further information on the Group's exposure to interest rate,
foreign currency and liquidity risk is provided in Note 26
Financial instruments.
IFRS 16 Leases applies to annual reporting periods beginning on
or after 1 January 2019. On transition date, lease liabilities of
US$7,645 thousand will be recognised within net debt. For further
information see Note 3 New accounting policies.
Note 26: Financial instruments
Accounting policy
Financial assets and liabilities are recognised when the Group
becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the financial
instrument.
Non-derivative financial instruments
Non-derivative financial instruments comprise investments in
equity and debt securities (e.g. promissory notes), trade and other
receivables, cash and cash equivalents, loans and borrowings and
trade and other payables.
Derivative financial instruments
Except for the provisionally priced receivables disclosed in
Note 17 Trade and other receivables, the Group does not hold any
derivative financial instruments.
Initial measurement
Non-derivative financial instruments
Financial assets and financial liabilities are initially
measured at fair value. Any transaction costs that are directly
attributable to the acquisition or issue of financial assets or
financial liabilities are added or deducted from its fair value
except for financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value
through the income statement. For those financial assets and
financial liabilities, the transaction costs are recognised
immediately in the income statement.
All regular way purchases and sales of financial assets are
recognised on the trade date (i.e. the date that the Group commits
to purchase or sell the asset). Regular way purchases or sales are
those that require delivery of assets within the period generally
established by regulation or convention in the marketplace.
The subsequent measurement is based on the classification of the
financial instruments.
Subsequent measurement
Financial assets
Loans and receivables
Except for the provisionally priced receivables disclosed in
Note 17 Trade and other receivables, loans and receivables are
non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments
that are not quoted in an active market. Such assets are carried at
amortised cost using the effective interest method. Gains and
losses are recognised in the income statement when the loans and
receivables are derecognised or impaired along with the
amortisation process.
Other
Other non-derivative financial assets are measured at amortised
cost using the effective interest method less any impairment
losses.
Financial liabilities
Trade and other payables
Trade and other payables are subsequently measured at amortised
cost using the effective interest method.
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings are subsequently measured
at amortised cost using the effective interest method. Gains and
losses are recognised in the income statement when the liabilities
are derecognised as well as through the amortisation process.
Impairment of financial assets
In addition to the individual assessment at each reporting date
whether a financial asset or group of financial assets is impaired,
the Group also assesses the expected credit losses on financial
assets carried at amortised cost. As all of the Group's loan and
receivable balances are classified as current based on the agreed
terms and conditions, the loss allowance is measured at an amount
equal to the 12-month expected credit losses based on publicly
available credit default ratings adjusted for current observable
circumstances, forecast information and past history of credit
losses. This assessment is performed individually for all financial
assets that are individually significant and collectively for those
that are not individually significant and have similar credit risk
characteristics. The carrying amount of the financial assets is
reduced by an allowance account with the change of the allowance
being recognised in the consolidated income statement.
Individual balances are written off when management deems that
there is no possibility of recovery.
Assets carried at amortised cost
If there is objective evidence that an impairment loss on loans
and receivables carried at amortised cost has been incurred, the
amount of the loss is measured as the difference between the
asset's carrying amount and the present value of estimated future
cash flows (excluding future credit losses that have not been
incurred). The carrying amount of the asset is reduced either
directly or through use of an allowance account. The amount of the
loss is recognised in the income statement.
The Group first assesses whether objective evidence of
impairment exists individually for financial assets that are
individually significant, and individually or collectively for
financial assets that are not individually significant. If it is
determined that no objective evidence of impairment exists for an
individually assessed financial asset, whether significant or not,
the asset is included in a group of financial assets with similar
credit risk characteristics and that group of financial assets is
collectively assessed for impairment.
If, in a subsequent period, the amount of the impairment loss
decreases and it is objectively related to an event occurring after
the impairment was recognised, the previously recognised impairment
loss is to be reversed. Any subsequent reversal of an impairment
loss is recognised in the income statement to the extent that the
carrying value of the asset does not exceed its amortised cost at
the reversal date.
The accounting classification of each category of financial
instruments and their carrying amounts are set out below:
As at 31.12.18
-------------------------------------- ----- ----------------------------------------
Financial
liabilities
measured
Loans at amortised
US$000 Notes and receivables cost Total
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Financial assets
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Cash and cash equivalents 24 62,996 - 62,996
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Trade and other receivables 17 85,695 - 85,695
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Other financial assets 456 - 456
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Total financial assets 149,147 - 149,147
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Financial liabilities
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Trade and other payables 20 - 34,292 34,292
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Accrued liabilities 23 - 26,458 26,458
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings 25 - 401,858 401,858
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Total financial liabilities - 462,608 462,608
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
As at 31.12.17
-------------------------------------- ----- ----------------------------------------
Financial
liabilities
measured
Loans at amortised
US$000 Notes and receivables cost Total
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Financial assets
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Cash and cash equivalents 24 97,742 - 97,742
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Trade and other receivables 17 88,327 - 88,327
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Other financial assets 620 - 620
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Total financial assets 186,689 - 186,689
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Financial liabilities
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Trade and other payables 20 - 32,420 32,420
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Accrued liabilities 23 - 25,314 25,314
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings 25 - 491,706 491,706
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Total financial liabilities - 549,440 549,440
-------------------------------------- ----- ---------------- ------------- -------
Fair values and impairment testing
Financial assets and other financial liabilities
The fair values of cash and cash equivalents, trade and other
receivables and payables are approximately equal to their carrying
amounts due to their short maturity.
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings
The fair values of interest-bearing loans and borrowings are
based on the discounted cash flows using market interest rates
(Level 2) except for the fair value of the Eurobond issued (Level
1), which is based on the market price quotation at the reporting
date. The fair values of interest-bearing loans and borrowings
totalled US$401,089 thousand (2017: US$514,515 thousand).
Fair value measurements recognised in the statement of financial
position
Except for the provisionally priced trade receivables (Level 2)
disclosed in Note 17 Trade and other receivables, the Group does
not have any financial instruments that are measured subsequent to
initial recognition at fair value, grouped into Level 1 to Level 3
based on the degree to which the fair value is observable. There
were no transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 in these periods.
Financial risk management
Overview
The Group has exposure to the following risks from its use of
financial instruments:
-- credit risk;
-- liquidity risk;
-- market risk - including currency and commodity risk.
This Note presents information about the Group's exposure to
each of the above risks, the Group's objectives, policies and
processes for measuring and managing risk, and the Group's
management of capital. Further quantitative disclosures are
included throughout these consolidated financial statements. The
Board has overall responsibility for the establishment and
oversight of the Group's risk
management framework.
The Group's risk management policies are established to identify
and analyse the risks faced by the Group, to set appropriate risk
limits and controls, and to monitor risks and adherence to limits.
Risk management policies and systems are reviewed regularly to
reflect changes in market conditions and the Group's activities.
The Group, through its training and management standards and
procedures, aims to develop a disciplined and constructive control
environment in which all employees understand their roles and
obligations.
The Audit Committee oversees how management monitors compliance
with the Group's risk management policies and procedures and
reviews the adequacy of the risk management framework in relation
to the risks faced by the Group. The Audit Committee is assisted in
its oversight role by Internal Audit. Internal Audit undertakes
both regular and ad hoc reviews of risk management controls and
procedures, the results of which are reported to the Audit
Committee and the CFO.
The Group operates a centralised financial risk management
structure under the management of the Executive Committee,
accountable to the Board. The Executive Committee delegates certain
responsibilities to the CFO. The CFO's responsibilities include
authority for approving all new physical, commercial or financial
transactions that create a financial risk for the Group.
Additionally, the CFO controls the management of treasury risks
within each of the business units in accordance with a
Board-approved treasury policy.
Financial instrument risk exposure and management
Natural hedges that can be identified and their effectiveness
quantified are used in preference to financial risk management
instruments. Derivative transactions may be executed for risk
mitigation purposes only - speculation is not permitted under the
approved treasury policy - and are designed to have the effect of
reducing risk on underlying market or credit exposures. Appropriate
operational controls ensure operational risks are not increased
disproportionately to the reduction in market or credit risk.
The Group has not used any financial risk management instruments
that are derivative in nature, or other hedging instruments, in
this or prior periods.
Credit risk
Trade and other receivables
The Group, through its trading operations, enters into binding
contracts, which contain obligations that create exposure to
credit, counterparty and country risks. It is the primary objective
of the Group to manage such risks to reduce uncertainty of
collection from buyers. A secondary objective is to minimise the
cost of reducing risks within acceptable parameters.
Trade finance is used to balance risk and payment. These risks
include the creditworthiness of the buyer, and the political and
economic stability of the buyer's country. Trade finance generally
refers to the financing of individual transactions or a series of
revolving transactions and is often self-liquidating, whereby the
lending bank stipulates that all sales proceeds to be collected are
applied to settle the loan, with the remainder returned to the
Group. Trade finance transactions are approved by the Group
Treasurer. The primary objective is to ensure that the margins paid
and conditions applicable should be the same as, or better than,
those which other organisations with similar creditworthiness would
achieve, and compared with other financing available to the
Group.
Credit risk is the risk associated with the possibility that a
buyer will default, by failing to make required payments in a
timely manner or to comply with other conditions of an obligation
or agreement. Where appropriate, the Group uses letters of credit
to assist in mitigating
such risks.
Counterparty risk crystallises when a party to an agreement
defaults. Where letters of credit are used to minimise this risk,
the Group uses a confirming bank with a similar or higher credit
rating to mitigate country and/or credit risk of the issuing
bank.
Country risk is the potential volatility of foreign assets,
whether receivables or investments, that is due to political and/or
financial events in a given country.
Group Treasury monitors the concentration of all outstanding
risks associated with any entity or country, and reports to the
Group CFO on a timely basis.
Investment securities
Outside Ukraine the Group limits its cash exposure to credit,
counterparty and country risk by only investing in liquid
securities and with counterparties that are incorporated in an A+
or better "S&P" rated OECD country. A ratings approach is used
to determine maximum exposure to each counterparty. Cash not
required within three months for production, distribution and
capital expenditures is invested with counterparties rated by
S&P or Moody's at a level of long-term BBB "S&P" or
short-term A3 "S&P" or better.
Recognising that the principal activities of the Group are
predominantly in Ukraine, special consideration is given to
Ukrainian transactional banking counterparties where the sector is
small and constrained by the sovereign credit rating. Exceptions
may be made under the following conditions:
-- the counterparty is resident in Ukraine; and
-- the counterparty is included in the top 15 financial
institutions in Ukraine based on the Group's assessment of the
financial institution.
Subsequent to the declaration of insolvency of the Group's
former transactional bank in Ukraine (see Note 29 Commitments,
contingencies and legal disputes), the Group changed its
transactional banking arrangements and is currently working with
four banks in Ukraine, all of them being subsidiaries of Western
banks, and is still exposed to Ukraine country and banking sector
risk in this respect.
Guarantees
The Group's policy is to provide financial guarantees under
limited circumstances only for the benefit of wholly owned or
substantially wholly owned subsidiaries. At 31 December 2018,
Ferrexpo AG, Ferrexpo Finance plc and Ferrexpo Middle East FZE were
jointly and severally liable under a US$400 million revolving
pre-export finance facility, of which US$195,000 thousand was drawn
as of 31 December 2018 (2017: nil) and US$205,000 thousand was
available (2017: US$195,000 thousand).
At 31 December 2018, Ferrexpo plc, Ferrexpo AG and Ferrexpo
Middle East FZE were guarantors to the Eurobond ("Notes") issued by
Ferrexpo Finance plc totalling US$173,181 thousand and fully repaid
on 7 April 2019. Additionally, the Notes benefited from a surety
agreement provided by FPM.
Certain Group companies act as guarantors for several finance
facilities provided to Ukrainian subsidiaries: Ferrexpo AG
amounting to US$15,767 thousand (2017: US$38,902 thousand),
Ferrexpo Middle East FZE amounting to US$6,595 thousand (2017:
US$15,852 thousand) and Ferrexpo plc amounting to US$2,661 thousand
(2017: US$7,984 thousand).
The total remaining contractual maturities of the guarantees
provided under the facilities listed above is US$403,268 thousand
(2017: US$497,800 thousand).
Exposure to credit risk
The carrying amount of financial assets at 31 December 2018 was
US$149,147 thousand (2017: US$186,689 thousand) and represents the
maximum credit exposure. See page 141 for further information.
Of the total maximum exposure to credit risk, US$26,068 thousand
(2017: US$13,170 thousand) related to Ukraine.
The total receivables balance relating to the Group's top three
customers was US$40,670 thousand (2017: US$49,918 thousand), making
up 47.5% of the total amounts receivable (2017: 63.4%). The top
three customers are considered to be crisis-resistant top-class
steel mills and sales are made under long-term contracts.
Impairment profile
The Group's exposure to credit risk relating to trade and other
receivables is disclosed in Note 17 Trade and other
receivables.
Liquidity risk
Liquidity risk is the risk that the Group will not be able to
meet its financial obligations as they fall due. The Group's
approach is to ensure that it will always have sufficient liquidity
to meet its liabilities when due, under both normal and stressed
conditions, without incurring unacceptable losses or risking damage
to the Group's reputation by holding surplus cash or undrawn
committed credit facilities.
The Group prepares detailed rolling cash flow forecasts, which
assist it in monitoring cash flow requirements and optimising its
cash return on investments. Typically the Group intends to ensure
that it has sufficient cash on demand and/or lines of credit to
meet expected operational expenses, including the servicing of
financial obligations. For further information see the Group's
Viability Statement on page 28.
The following are the contractual maturities of financial
liabilities:
As at 31.12.18
----------------------------------- ----------------------------------------------
Less Between Between More
than 1 to 2 to than
US$000 1 year 2 years 5 years 5 years Total
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Interest-bearing
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Fixed rate loans and borrowings 181,182 - - - 181,182
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Floating rate loans and borrowings 24,785 66,534 130,767 - 222,086
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Total interest-bearing 205,967 66,534 130,767 - 403,268
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Non-interest-bearing
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Trade and other payables 34,292 - - - 34,292
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Accrued liabilities 26,458 - - - 26,458
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Future interest payable 23,321 12,380 10,511 - 46,212
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Total non-interest-bearing 84,071 12,380 10,511 - 106,962
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Total financial liabilities 290,038 78,914 141,278 - 510,230
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
The difference of the total of fixed and floating
interest-bearing loans and borrowings compared to the balances
disclosed in Note 25 Interest-bearing loans and borrowings mainly
relates to arrangement fees paid for specific facilities which are
netted for the presentation in the statement of financial
position.
As at 31.12.17
----------------------------------- ----------------------------------------------
Less Between Between More
than 1 to 2 to than
US$000 1 year 2 years 5 years 5 years Total
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Interest-bearing
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Fixed rate loans and borrowings 189,004 181,180 - - 370,184
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Floating rate loans and borrowings 119,847 5,468 2,301 - 127,616
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Total interest-bearing 308,851 186,648 2,301 - 497,800
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Non-interest-bearing
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Trade and other payables 48,428 - - - 48,428
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Accrued liabilities 25,314 - - - 25,314
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Future interest payable 30,251 9,218 70 - 39,539
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Total non-interest-bearing 103,993 9,218 70 - 113,281
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Total financial liabilities 412,844 195,866 2,371 - 611,081
----------------------------------- ------- -------- -------- -------- -------
Currency risk
The Group is exposed to currency risk on financial assets and
financial liabilities resulting from sales, purchases and
borrowings that are denominated in a currency other than the
respective functional currencies of the Group's subsidiaries. The
functional currencies of the Group's subsidiaries are primarily the
Ukrainian Hryvnia, US Dollars, Euro and Swiss Francs. The Group's
functional currency and reporting currency is US Dollar.
The Group's major lines of borrowings and the majority of its
sales are denominated in US Dollars, with costs of local Ukrainian
production mainly in Hryvnia. The value of the Hryvnia is published
by the NBU.
An appreciation of the Ukrainian Hryvnia increases the operating
costs of the production unit in US Dollar terms and the value of
Hryvnia payables recorded in the statement of financial position at
the year end in US Dollars, with the opposite effect in case of a
depreciation of the Ukrainian Hryvnia. As the majority of sales and
receivables are denominated in US Dollars, a change in the local
currency will result in operating exchange difference recorded in
the income statement.
In case of a change of the local currency compared to the US
Dollar, US Dollar-denominated loans held by the Ukrainian
subsidiaries result in non-operating exchange differences to the
extent these are not matched by US Dollar-denominated assets. Fixed
assets are held in local currency amounts and a change in the
functional currencies different to the US Dollar results in a
change of the Group's net assets as recorded in the translation
reserve.
The NBU manages and determines the official exchange rates. An
interbank market for exchange of currencies exists in Ukraine and
is
monitored by the NBU. The Group, through financial institutions,
exchanges currencies at bank offered market rates.
Trade receivables are predominately in US Dollars and are not
hedged. Trade payables denominated in US Dollars are also not
hedged on the market, but are matched against US Dollar currency
receipts. This includes the interest expense, which is principally
payable in US Dollars. Trade receivables and trade payables in
Ukrainian Hryvnia are not hedged as a forward market for the
currency is generally not available.
Other Group monetary assets and liabilities denominated in
foreign currencies are considered immaterial as the exposure to
currency risk mainly relates to corporate costs within Switzerland
and the UK.
The Group's exposure to foreign currency risk was as follows as
of 31 December 2018:
As at As at
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total financial assets 149,147 186,689
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof exposed to Ukrainian Hryvnia - -
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof exposed to US Dollar 6,837 6,906
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof exposed to Euro 49 145
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof exposed to Swiss Franc 674 673
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof exposed to other currencies 1,898 1,446
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total exposures to currencies other than local functional
currencies 9,458 9,170
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total financial liabilities (462,608) (549,440)
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof exposed to Ukrainian Hryvnia - -
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof exposed to US Dollar (12,369) (22,061)
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof exposed to Euro (1,587) (1,731)
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof exposed to Swiss Franc (4,617) (216)
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Thereof exposed to other currencies (1,086) (6,569)
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total exposures to currencies other than local functional
currencies (19,659) (30,577)
---------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
No other subsidiaries of the Group have financial assets and
liabilities denominated in the Ukrainian Hryvnia. The functional
currency of the Ukrainian subsidiaries is the Ukrainian Hryvnia and
the translation of financial assets and financial liabilities does
not therefore pose a foreign currency risk exposure in the
consolidated income statement of the Group as translation
differences are reflected in the translation reserve (see Note 30
Share capital and reserves).
Interest rate risk
The Group predominantly borrows bank funds that are at floating
interest rates and is exposed to interest rate movements. No
interest rate swaps have been entered into in this or prior
periods.
Commodity risk
Revenues related to provisionally priced sales are initially
recognised at the estimated fair value of the consideration
receivable based on the forward price at each reporting date for
the relevant period outlined in the different contracts. As a
consequence, the receivable balance may change in a future period
when final invoices can be issued based on final iron ore prices to
be applied according to the specific underlying contract terms.
There was no provisionally priced iron ore exposure at 31 December
2018 (2017: 176,000 tonnes) which would give rise to a fair value
adjustment relating to the embedded provisional pricing mechanism
as at 31 December 2018 (2017: gain of US$846 thousand). Final iron
ore prices based on the relevant index are normally known within 60
days after the reporting period. There were no provisionally priced
receivable balances as at 31 December 2018. The difference between
the provisionally priced receivable balance recognised as at the
end of the comparative period ended 31 December 2017 and the
receivable balance taking into account the known final prices was
US$863 thousand and would have increased the consolidated result
and the shareholders' equity by this amount.
Where pricing terms deviate from the index-based pricing model,
derivative commodity contracts may be used to swap the pricing
terms to the iron ore index price.
Finished goods are held at cost without revaluation to a spot
price for iron ore pellets at the end of the reporting period, as
long as the recoverable amount exceeds the cost basis.
Sensitivity analysis
A 20% strengthening of the US Dollar against the following
currencies at 31 December would have increased/(decreased) income
statement and equity by the amounts shown below. The percentage
applied to the sensitivity analysis of the Group's foreign currency
exposure is based on the average change of the Ukrainian Hryvnia,
the Group's most relevant foreign currency, compared to the US
Dollar in past years, which might repeat again in the near future.
This percentage was also applied for the Group's less relevant
foreign currencies and does not have a significant effect on the
total effect of this sensitivity analysis. This assumes that all
other variables, in particular interest rates, remain constant.
Year Year
ended ended
31.12.18 31.12.17
Income Income
US$000 statement/equity statement/equity
------------------ ----------------- -----------------
Ukrainian Hryvnia (922) (2,526)
------------------ ----------------- -----------------
Euro (256) (264)
------------------ ----------------- -----------------
Swiss Franc (657) 76
------------------ ----------------- -----------------
Total (1,835) (2,714)
------------------ ----------------- -----------------
A 20% weakening of the US Dollar against the above currencies
would have an equal but opposite effect to the amounts shown above,
on the basis that all the other variables remain constant.
Fair value sensitivity analysis for fixed rate instruments
The Group does not account for any fixed rate financial assets
and liabilities at fair value through profit or loss, and the Group
does not hold any derivatives (e.g. interest rate swaps). Therefore
a change in interest rates at the reporting date would not affect
the income statement.
Cash flow sensitivity for variable rate instruments
An increase of 100 basis points ("bps") in interest rates would
have decreased equity and the consolidated result by the amounts
shown below. The possible change applied to the cash flow
sensitivity represents a plausible scenario taking into account the
movement of variable interest rates in the last year and possible
changes in the near future. This analysis assumes that all other
variables, in particular foreign currency rates, remain
constant.
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------- --------- ---------
Net finance charge 1,591 299
------------------- --------- ---------
A decrease of 100bps would increase equity and profit by
US$1,126 thousand for the year ended 31 December 2018 (2017:
increase of US$1,288 thousand). This is on the basis that all the
other variables remain constant.
Capital management
The Board's policy is to maintain a strong capital base. The
Board of Directors monitors both the demographic spread of
shareholders, as well as the return on capital, which the Group
defines as total shareholders' equity, excluding non-controlling
interests, and the level of dividends to ordinary shareholders.
Please refer to the statement of changes in equity for details of
the capital position of the Group.
A key measure in respect of the Group's capital management is
the level of net debt and the net debt to EBITDA ratio. Both key
figures improved during the financial year 2018 as a result of the
strong financial performance. The net debt has decreased from
US$393,964 thousand at the beginning of the year to US$338,862
thousand as at 31 December 2018.
The capital base of the Group can be adversely affected by falls
in the price of iron ore reducing reported revenues and
profitability. The price that the industry earns for iron ore
products is cyclical in nature and the Board of Directors continues
to review its capital base in line with industry trends. In prior
years the Board approved investments in growth projects as part of
its policy to support a strong capital base. During the financial
years 2015 and 2016, in recognition of the industry trend and to
further support the Group's capital base, the Board slowed down
investments in major growth projects. Under consideration of
increased iron ore prices and more positive industry trends,
investments in major growth projects continued in 2018 and are
expected to be continued in 2019.
The Board seeks to maintain a balance between the higher returns
that might be possible with higher levels of borrowings and
advantages and security afforded by a sound capital position. The
Board continues to support maintaining a sound capital base
balanced against these market constraints.
The Board maintains a dividend policy consistent with the
Group's profile, reflecting the investment activities the Group has
made supporting current and future production growth and the cash
generated by existing operations, while maintaining a prudent level
of dividend cover supported by an appropriate level of
liquidity.
Neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries is subject to
externally imposed capital requirements other than a bank covenant
requirement to maintain consolidated equity of the Group of
US$500,000 thousand including non-controlling interests and
excluding the translation reserve. Compliance is ensured by
balancing dividend payments against the earnings of the Group.
Ferrexpo plc (the "Company") is the Group's holding company,
with no direct operating business, so its ability to make
distributions to its shareholders is dependent on its ability to
access profits held in the subsidiaries. The Group's consolidated
retained earnings shown in the consolidated statement of changes in
equity do not reflect the profits available for distribution in the
Group as of 31 December 2018. See Note 12 Earnings per share and
dividends paid and proposed for further information.
For more information about the Group's interest-bearing loans
and borrowings see Note 25 Interest-bearing loans and
borrowings.
Note 27: Share-based payments
Accounting policy
Equity-settled transactions
The cost of equity-settled transactions with employees is
measured by reference to the fair value of the award at the grant
date using modelling techniques consistent with the mathematics
underlying the Black-Scholes option pricing model extended to allow
for the performance conditions. The fair value is determined by
reference to the quoted closing share price on the grant date. The
cost is recognised as an expense over the vesting period, which
ends on the date on which the relevant employees become fully
entitled to the award. In valuing equity-settled transactions, no
account is taken of any vesting conditions, except for market
conditions, such as the relative Total Shareholder Return
("TSR").
Where the vesting of awards is subject to the satisfaction of
certain market conditions, a vesting charge is recognised
irrespective of whether or not the market condition is satisfied,
provided that all other performance conditions are satisfied. Where
awards terminate before the performance period is complete, any
unamortised expense is recognised immediately.
At each reporting date, the cumulative expense of outstanding
awards is calculated, representing the extent to which the vesting
period has expired and management's best estimate of the
achievement or otherwise of non-market conditions and of the number
of equity instruments that will ultimately vest. The movement in
cumulative expense since the previous reporting date is recognised
in the income statement, with a corresponding entry in employee
benefit trust reserve in equity.
Long-term incentive plan ("LTIP")
The LTIP is a share-based scheme whereby certain senior
management and executives receive rewards based on the relative
TSR. The LTIP is subject to a performance condition based on the
TSR compared to a comparator group, which operate in a similar
environment, measured over the vesting period. Further description
is provided in the Remuneration Report. The cost of equity-settled
awards is measured as described above together with an estimate of
future social security contributions payable in respect of this
value.
The following number of share awards were granted under the LTIP
in the previous financial years. The LTIP vesting period is three
years.
2018 2017 2016
Thousand LTIP LTIP LTIP Total
-------------------- ----- ----- ----- -----
Year ended 31.12.18 392 - - 392
-------------------- ----- ----- ----- -----
Year ended 31.12.17 - 803 - 803
-------------------- ----- ----- ----- -----
Year ended 31.12.16 - - 765 765
-------------------- ----- ----- ----- -----
The following expenses have been recognised in 2018 and 2017 in
respect of the LTIP:
2018 2017 2016 2015 2014
US$000 LTIP LTIP LTIP LTIP LTIP Total
-------------------- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- -----
Year ended 31.12.18 238 389 47 - - 674
-------------------- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- -----
Year ended 31.12.17 - 433 54 112 (13) 586
-------------------- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- -----
Year Year
ended ended Year Year
31.12.18 31.12.17 ended ended
WAFV WAFV 31.12.18 31.12.17
(US$) (US$) No. (000) No. (000)
------------------------------- --------- --------- ---------- ----------
LTIP
------------------------------- --------- --------- ---------- ----------
Beginning of the year 0.86 0.63 2,122 1,862
------------------------------- --------- --------- ---------- ----------
Awards granted during the year 1.97 1.64 392 803
------------------------------- --------- --------- ---------- ----------
Awards vested during the year 0.61 1.17 (594) (112)
------------------------------- --------- --------- ---------- ----------
Awards lapsed during the year 1.13 1.27 (100) (431)
------------------------------- --------- --------- ---------- ----------
Outstanding at 31 December 1.16 0.86 1,820 2,122
------------------------------- --------- --------- ---------- ----------
The main inputs to the valuation of the 2018 LTIP awards were
the share price at date of grant of US$3.11 (2017 LTIP awards:
US$2.01), the volatility of the share price of 71% (2017 LTIP
awards: 74%) and a risk-free interest rate of 2.5% p.a. (2017 LTIP
awards: 1.5% p.a.).
All awards vested during the financial years 2018 and 2017 have
been exercised.
Note 28: Employees
Employee benefits expenses for the year ended 31 December 2018
consisted of the following:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17
--------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Wages and salaries 67,413 50,223
--------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Social security costs 13,152 9,383
--------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Post-employment benefits 21 1,234 943
--------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Other employee costs 3,851 3,336
--------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Share-based payments 27 674 586
--------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Total employee benefits expenses 86,324 64,470
--------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
The table above includes compensation for Non-executive
Directors, Executive Directors and other key management personnel
as outlined below:
Year ended 31.12.18 Year ended 31.12.17
-------------------------------------- ---------------------------------- ----------------------------------
Non-
Executive
Non-Executive Other and
and Executive key Executive Other
US$000 Directors management Total Directors key management Total
-------------------------------------- -------------- ----------- ----- ---------- --------------- -----
Wages and salaries 2,757 4,537 7,294 3,079 3,277 6,356
-------------------------------------- -------------- ----------- ----- ---------- --------------- -----
Social security costs 166 181 347 124 152 276
-------------------------------------- -------------- ----------- ----- ---------- --------------- -----
Post-employment benefits 82 140 222 81 118 199
-------------------------------------- -------------- ----------- ----- ---------- --------------- -----
Other employee costs 196 4 200 170 56 226
-------------------------------------- -------------- ----------- ----- ---------- --------------- -----
Share-based payments 93 383 476 81 197 278
-------------------------------------- -------------- ----------- ----- ---------- --------------- -----
Total compensation for key management 3,294 5,245 8,539 3,535 3,800 7,335
-------------------------------------- -------------- ----------- ----- ---------- --------------- -----
The average number of employees during the financial year 2018
is detailed in the table below:
Year Year
ended ended
Average number of employees 31.12.18 31.12.17
---------------------------------- --------- ---------
Production 7,178 7,154
---------------------------------- --------- ---------
Marketing and distribution 185 180
---------------------------------- --------- ---------
Administration 1,079 1,002
---------------------------------- --------- ---------
Other 728 727
---------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total average number of employees 9,170 9,063
---------------------------------- --------- ---------
Note 29: Commitments, contingencies and legal disputes
Accounting policy
Contingencies
Contingent liabilities are not recognised in the consolidated
financial statements. They are disclosed unless the possibility of
an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits is remote. A
contingent asset is not recognised in the consolidated financial
statements but disclosed when an inflow of economic benefits is
probable.
Leases
The determination of whether an arrangement is, or contains, a
lease is based on the substance of the arrangement at inception
date, i.e. whether fulfilment of the arrangement is dependent on
the use of a specific asset or assets or the arrangement conveys a
right to use the asset, even if that right is not specified in an
arrangement.
Group as a lessee
Finance leases, which transfer to the Group substantially all
the risks and benefits incidental to ownership of the leased item,
are capitalised at the commencement of the lease at the fair value
of the leased asset or, if lower, at the present value of the
minimum lease payments. Lease payments are apportioned between the
finance costs and the amortisation of the lease liability in order
to achieve a constant interest rate on the remaining outstanding
lease liability. Finance costs are recognised in the income
statement.
Leased assets are generally depreciated over the useful life of
the asset. If there is no reasonable certainty that the Group will
obtain ownership by the end of the lease term, the asset is
depreciated over the shorter of the estimated useful life of the
asset and the lease term.
Operating lease payments are recognised as an expense in the
income statement on a straight-line basis over the lease term.
Operating lease commitments - Group as lessee
Future minimum rentals payable under non-cancellable operating
leases as at 31 December 2018 are as follows:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
---------------------------------- --------- ---------
Less than one year 2,807 2,569
---------------------------------- --------- ---------
Between one and five years 4,587 4,542
---------------------------------- --------- ---------
More than five years 1,433 2,271
---------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total operating lease commitments 8,827 9,382
---------------------------------- --------- ---------
In addition the Group has future commitments for contingent
lease payments of US$36,428 thousand (2017: US$33,088 thousand),
which are dependent on non-fixed rates.
During the year ended 31 December 2018, US$2,903 thousand was
recognised as an expense in the income statement in respect of
operating leases (2017: US$2,291 thousand).
The Group leases land and buildings under operating leases. The
leases on land run up to 49 years and with a lease period of five
to ten years on buildings.
IFRS 16 Leases applies to annual reporting periods beginning on
or after 1 January 2019. On transition date, lease liabilities of
US$7,645 thousand will be recognised within net debt along with
corresponding right-of-use assets. For further information see Note
3 New accounting policies.
Finance lease commitments
Future minimum lease payments under finance leases together with
the present value of the net minimum lease payments are as
follows:
As at 31.12.18
------------------------------------------- -----------------------
Present
Minimum value
US$000 payments of payments
------------------------------------------- --------- ------------
Less than one year 2,267 2,074
------------------------------------------- --------- ------------
Total minimum lease payments 2,267 2,074
------------------------------------------- --------- ------------
Less: amounts representing finance charges (193) -
------------------------------------------- --------- ------------
Present value of minimum lease payments 2,074 2,074
------------------------------------------- --------- ------------
As at 31.12.17
------------------------------------------- -----------------------
Present
Minimum value
US$000 payments of payments
------------------------------------------- --------- ------------
Less than one year 4,296 3,969
------------------------------------------- --------- ------------
Between one and five years 2,131 2,072
------------------------------------------- --------- ------------
Total minimum lease payments 6,427 6,041
------------------------------------------- --------- ------------
Less: amounts representing finance charges (386) -
------------------------------------------- --------- ------------
Present value of minimum lease payments 6,041 6,041
------------------------------------------- --------- ------------
Other
As at As at
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Capital commitments on purchase of property, plant and
equipment 67,529 29,681
------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Contingencies
On 4 February 2019 Ferrexpo announced that it had commissioned
an independent review (the "Independent Review") into the Group's
relationship with Blooming Land and its sub-funds (the
"Charity").
For the year ended 31 December 2018, the Group made charitable
contributions of US$9,500 thousand to the Charity (2017: US$24,000
thousand). Donations were ceased in May 2018. The Group has made
donations to the Charity over the last 6 years totalling US$110,000
thousand. Further details on the Group's relationship with the
Charity, including the Independent Review currently being
conducted, are provided in the Independent Review Committee Report
(page 46) and see also Principal Risks (page 25), Responsible
Business (page 31), Corporate Governance Report (page 39), Audit
Committee Report (page 48), and Note 7 Operating expenses, Note 33
Related party disclosures and Note 34 Events after the reporting
period to the consolidated financial statements.
A number of critical judgements have been made in relation to
the Group's relationship with the Charity. These are disclosed
in:
-- Note 7 - Operating expenses - nature of Group's community support donations; and
-- Note 33 - Related party disclosures - completeness.
As noted in the Independent Review Committee Report on page 46,
the Independent Review is ongoing. The Group may be exposed to the
risk of civil, criminal or regulatory actions and liabilities
(including fines and penalties) may accrue to the Group arising
from the Group's relationship with the Charity, including (without
limitation) in the following scenarios:
-- if any of the critical judgements outlined in Note 7
Operating expenses and/or Note 33 Related party disclosures are
incorrect, in whole or in part;
-- if funds donated to the Charity have been misapplied,
including through misappropriation, with or without the knowledge
or involvement of Ferrexpo personnel and/or in circumstances where
the Charity is considered to be performing services for or on
behalf of the Group;
-- if the Group or any of its personnel have derived any direct
or indirect benefit from the Charity; and
-- if the financial statements for the current or prior periods
omit related party or other disclosures that ought to have been
made or the financial statements need to be restated.
At the current time, the existence, timing and quantum of
potential future liability, if any, including fines, penalties or
damages, which could be material or other consequences arising from
the Independent Review cannot be determined and measured reliably
and, as a consequence, no associated liabilities have been
recognised in relation to these matters in the consolidated
statement of financial position as of 31 December 2018.
Legal
In the ordinary course of business, the Group is subject to
legal actions and complaints. Management believes that the ultimate
liability,
if any, arising from such actions or complaints will not have a
material adverse effect on the financial condition or the results
of future operations of the Group.
Deposit Guarantee Fund and liquidator of Bank F&C
The Group's former transactional bank in Ukraine, Bank F&C
("BFC"), is still going through the liquidation process after
having been declared insolvent by the National Bank of Ukraine and
put under temporary administration on 18 September 2015. The Group,
through its major subsidiaries in Ukraine, is engaged in various
court proceedings with the aim to maximise its recovery in the
liquidation process of BFC as disclosed below.
Following the commencement of the liquidation process of BFC and
in accordance with the applicable local legislation, FPM, LLC
Ferrexpo Yeristovo Mining ("FYM") and LLC Ferrexpo Belanovo Mining
("FBM"), collectively referred to as "Ukrainian subsidiaries",
submitted on 21 January 2016 their claims for cash and deposit
balances held with BFC on the date of introduction of temporary
administration totalling UAH4,262 million (US$153,929 thousand as
of 31 December 2018).
On 22 April 2016, the liquidator of BFC issued certificates
recognising UAH540 million (US$19,503 thousand as of 31 December
2018) of these claims and recognised these claims in the ninth
rank. The aforementioned Ukrainian subsidiaries are currently
involved in legal proceedings in respect of the under-recognition
of the claims amounting to UAH3,722 million (US$134,426 thousand as
of 31 December 2018) and the ranking of the claims in the
liquidation process. The court proceedings commenced in October
2016 and following various hearings during the financial year 2017,
the relevant court instance dismissed on 25 October 2017 FPM's
claim in full. FPM filed an appeal on 13 November 2017 and several
hearings took place following the filing of FPM's appeal without a
ruling on the parties' motions by the Kyiv Commercial Court of
Appeal. During the hearing on 18 July 2018, the court ruled in
favour of FPM and the counterparty subsequently filed its cassation
appeal against this decision. On 11 December 2018, the Supreme
Court of Ukraine upheld the cassation appeal and the case was
directed for new consideration to the Northern Commercial Court of
Appeal. The case was heard by the Northern Commercial Court of
Appeal on 27 March 2019 without a decision taken during this first
hearing. The next hearing is scheduled for 22 April 2019. FYM's
claim on the same matter was dismissed by the Kyiv Commercial Court
on 6 February 2019 and FYM filed its appeal against this decision
on 28 February 2019. The first hearing at the Northern Commercial
Court of Appeal took place on 15 April 2019 without a decision
taken. The next hearing is scheduled for 20 May 2019. In relation
to the claims of FBM, the Northern Commercial Court of Appeal
dismissed FBM's appeal on 11 March
2019 and FBM filed its cassation appeal on 2 April 2019.
Note 30: Share capital and reserves
Accounting policy
Ordinary Shares
Ordinary Shares are classified as equity. Incremental costs
directly attributable to the issue of Ordinary Shares and share
options are recognised as a deduction from equity, net of any tax
effects.
Employee benefit trust reserve
Ferrexpo plc shares held by the Group are recognised at cost and
classified in reserves. Consideration received for the sale of such
shares is also recognised in equity, with any difference between
the proceeds from the sale and the original cost to be recorded in
reserves. No gain or loss is recognised in the income statement on
the purchase, issue or cancellation of equity shares.
Treasury shares
Own equity instruments, which are reacquired (treasury shares),
are recognised at cost and deducted from equity. No gain or loss is
recognised in the income statement on the purchase, sale, issue or
cancellation of the Group's own equity instruments. Any difference
between the carrying amount and the consideration is recognised in
reserves.
Translation reserve
The translation reserve represents exchange differences arising
on the translation of non-US Dollar functional currency operations,
mainly those in Ukrainian Hryvnia, within the Group into US
Dollars.
Information on the Group's share capital and reserves is
provided on the following page.
Share capital
Share capital represents the nominal value on issue of the
Company's equity share capital, comprising GBP0.10 Ordinary Shares.
The fully paid share capital of Ferrexpo plc at 31 December 2018
was 613,967,956 Ordinary Shares (2017: 613,967,956) at a par value
of GBP0.10 paid for in cash, resulting in share capital of
US$121,628 thousand (2017: US$121,628 thousand) per the statement
of financial position.
As at 31 December 2018, other reserves attributable to equity
shareholders of Ferrexpo plc comprised:
Employee
Uniting Treasury benefit Total
of interest share trust Translation other
US$000 reserve reserve reserve reserve reserves
----------------------------------------- ------------ -------- -------- ----------- -----------
At 1 January 2017 31,780 (77,260) (5,108) (1,934,170) (1,984,758)
----------------------------------------- ------------ -------- -------- ----------- -----------
Foreign currency translation differences - - - (41,249) (41,249)
----------------------------------------- ------------ -------- -------- ----------- -----------
Tax effect - - - 4,557 4,557
----------------------------------------- ------------ -------- -------- ----------- -----------
Total comprehensive loss for the
period - - - (36,692) (36,692)
----------------------------------------- ------------ -------- -------- ----------- -----------
Share-based payments - - 586 - 586
----------------------------------------- ------------ -------- -------- ----------- -----------
At 31 December 2017 31,780 (77,260) (4,522) (1,970,862) (2,020,864)
----------------------------------------- ------------ -------- -------- ----------- -----------
Foreign currency translation differences - - - 12,117 12,117
----------------------------------------- ------------ -------- -------- ----------- -----------
Tax effect - - - (2,007) (2,007)
----------------------------------------- ------------ -------- -------- ----------- -----------
Total comprehensive income for the
period - - - 10,110 10,110
----------------------------------------- ------------ -------- -------- ----------- -----------
Share-based payments - - 674 - 674
----------------------------------------- ------------ -------- -------- ----------- -----------
At 31 December 2018 31,780 (77,260) (3,848) (1,960,752) (2,010,080)
----------------------------------------- ------------ -------- -------- ----------- -----------
Uniting of interest reserve
The uniting of interest reserve represents the difference
between the initial investment by Ferrexpo AG in FPM to gain
control of the subsidiary in 2005 and the net assets acquired,
which under the pooling of interests method of accounting are
consolidated at their historic cost, less non-controlling
interests.
Treasury share reserve
In September 2008, Ferrexpo plc completed a buyback of
25,343,814 shares for a total cost of US$77,260 thousand. These
shares are currently held as treasury shares by the Group. The
Companies Act 2006 forbids the exercise of any rights (including
voting rights) and the payment of dividends in respect of treasury
shares.
Employee benefit trust reserve
This reserve represents the treasury shares held by Ferrexpo AG
setting up an employee benefit trust reserve. The reserve is used
to satisfy future grants for senior management incentive schemes.
Information on the Group's share-based payments is provided in Note
27 Share-based payments. As at 31 December 2018, the employee
benefit trust reserve includes 2,326,256 shares (2017: 2,916,419
shares).
Translation reserve
During the financial year 2018, the Ukrainian Hryvnia
appreciated from 28.067 as at the beginning of the year to 27.688
as at 31 December 2018 and the exchange differences arising on
translation of the Group's foreign operations are initially
recognised in the statement of other comprehensive income. See also
page 97.
Note 31: Consolidated subsidiaries
Accounting policy
Entities are included in the consolidated financial statements
from the date of obtaining control and the inclusion in the
consolidated financial statements is consequently ceased when the
control over an entity is lost. Control is obtained when the Group
is exposed, or has the rights, to variable returns from its
involvement with an entity and has the ability to affect those
returns through its power over the entity that gives the current
ability to direct the relevant activities. Control can be obtained
through voting rights, but also through agreements, statutes,
contracts, trust deeds or other schemes.
Non-controlling interests in the net assets of consolidated
subsidiaries are shown separately in the Group's consolidated
statement of financial position and consolidated statement of
changes in equity. The share of the profit attributable to
non-controlling interests is shown in the consolidated income
statement and the consolidated statement of comprehensive
income.
The Group comprises Ferrexpo plc and its consolidated
subsidiaries. The Group's interests in the entities are held
indirectly by the Company, with the exception of Ferrexpo AG which
is directly held. The Group's equity interests are 100% for all its
major consolidated subsidiaries, except for FPM. The interest that
non-controlling interests have in the Group's operations are not
material and are predominantly related to FPM. No significant
judgements and assumptions were required to determine that the
Group has control over these entities. The Group's consolidated
subsidiaries are listed on page 167.
The Group does not have any other interests of 20% or more in
undertakings that are not disclosed on page 167, except for the
investment in the associate mentioned in Note 32 Investments in
associates.
Note 32: Investments in associates
Accounting policy
The Group's investments in associates are accounted for using
the equity method of accounting. An associate is an entity in which
the Group has significant influence and which is neither a
subsidiary nor a joint venture.
Under the equity method, the investment in the associate is
carried in the statement of financial position at cost plus any
post-acquisition changes in the Group's share of net assets of the
associate. Goodwill relating to an associate is included in the
carrying amount of the investment and is not amortised nor
individually tested for impairment. After application of the equity
method, the Group determines whether it is necessary to recognise
any additional impairment loss with respect to the Group's
investment in the associate.
The share of profit from an associate is shown on the face of
the income statement. This is the profit attributable to the Group
and is therefore the profit after tax and non-controlling interests
in the subsidiaries of the associate. The reporting dates of the
associates and the Group are identical and the associates'
accounting policies are generally in conformity with those applied
by the Group.
The Group also holds an interest of 49.5% (2017: 49.5%) in TIS
Ruda LLC, operating a port on the Black Sea which the Group uses as
part of its distribution channel.
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------------ --------- ---------
Opening balance 5,947 2,165
------------------------ --------- ---------
Share of profit1 5,360 5,527
------------------------ --------- ---------
Dividends declared (4,515) (1,489)
------------------------ --------- ---------
Translation adjustments 245 (256)
------------------------ --------- ---------
Closing balance 7,037 5,947
------------------------ --------- ---------
For the year ended 31 December 2018 the summarised financial
information for the associate was as follows:
Revenue Net profit
-------------- -------------------- --------------------
Year Year Year Year
ended ended ended ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17 31.12.18 31.12.17
-------------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
TIS Ruda LLC1 21,686 22,002 10,741 11,076
-------------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
1 Based on preliminary and unaudited financial information.
The figures in the table above represent 100% of the associate's
revenue and net profit and not the Group's share based on its
ownership. As at 31 December 2018, the associate's total assets
were US$15,531 thousand (2017: US$13,481 thousand) and the total
liabilities were US$1,428 thousand (2017: US$1,563 thousand) based
on preliminary and unaudited statutory accounts. Any deviations
from the Group's share in the associate's equity based on the
audited financial statements is adjusted subsequent to the year end
once the audited financial statements are available.
Note 33: Related party disclosures
During the periods presented, the Group entered into arm's
length transactions with entities under the common control of the
majority owner of the Group, Kostyantin Zhevago, with associated
companies and with other related parties. Management considers that
the Group has appropriate procedures in place to identify, control,
properly disclose and obtain independent confirmation, when
relevant, for transactions with the related parties.
Entities under common control are those under the control of
Kostyantin Zhevago. Associated companies refer to TIS Ruda LLC, in
which the Group holds an interest of 49.5% (2017: 49.5%). This is
the only associated company of the Group. Other related parties are
principally those entities controlled partially by Anatoly Trefilov
who resigned as a member of the supervisory board of PJSC Ferrexpo
Poltava Mining as of 19 April 2017. In accordance with the Listing
Rules, all transactions with the entities controlled by Anatoly
Trefilov within one year of his resignation from the supervisory
board have been still considered as related party transactions and
disclosed as such. Effective 20 April 2018, the companies
controlled by Anatoly Trefilov are no longer considered as related
parties.
The payments made to the Non-executive Directors and Executive
Directors are disclosed in the Remuneration Report on pages 59 and
75.
Critical judgements
Completeness
The Board concluded that neither the Chief Executive Officer nor
the Group's executive management control or exercise significant
influence over Blooming Land or its sub-funds (the "Charity")
pursuant to relevant accounting standards IFRS 10 Consolidated
financial statements and IAS 28 Investments in joint ventures and
associates or under Chapter 11 of the UK Listing Rules.
A change in the assessment, including as a result of the
Independent Review may, under certain circumstances, expose the
Group to regulatory and other actions resulting in potential legal
claims or penalties, fines or other liabilities. See Note 29
Commitments, contingencies and legal disputes on page 151 for
further information.
Related party transactions entered into by the Group during the
periods presented are summarised in the following tables:
Revenue, expenses, finance income and expense
Year ended 31.12.18 Year ended 31.12.17
------------------------------------ ------------------------------ ------------------------------
Entities Entities
under Other under Other
common Associated related common Associated related
US$000 control companies parties control companies parties
------------------------------------ -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Other sales a 877 - 111 677 - 94
------------------------------------ -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Total related party transactions
within revenue 877 - 111 677 - 94
------------------------------------ -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Materials b 8,429 - 3 7,558 - 8
------------------------------------ -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Spare parts and consumables c 2,959 - - 1,382 - -
------------------------------------ -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Total related party transactions
within cost of sales 11,388 - 3 8,940 - 8
------------------------------------ -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Selling and distribution expenses
d 10,702 19,138 702 10,867 18,366 827
------------------------------------ -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
General and administration expenses
e 788 - 529 594 - 425
------------------------------------ -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Total related party transactions
within expenses 22,878 19,138 1,284 20,401 18,366 1,260
------------------------------------ -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Finance expense 119 - - 34 - -
------------------------------------ -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Total related party transactions 23,874 19,138 1,395 21,112 18,366 1,354
------------------------------------ -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
A description of the most material transactions which are in
aggregate over US$200 thousand in the current or comparative year
is given below.
Entities under common control
The Group entered into various related party transactions with
entities under common control. All transactions were carried out on
an arm's length basis in the normal course of business.
a Sales of power, steam and water and other materials for US$109
thousand (2017: US$88 thousand) and income from premises leased to
Kislorod PCC of US$131 thousand (2017: US$135 thousand);
a Sales of diesel to DVD Trans totalling US$376 thousand (2017:
US$313 thousand). The company ceased to be a related party in
September 2018; in accordance with the Listing Rules, all
transactions with DVD Trans within one year from cessation are
still considered as related party transactions and disclosed as
such; and
a Sales of scrap metal to OJSC Uzhgorodsky Turbogas totalling
US$250 thousand (2017: US$127 thousand).
b Purchases of compressed air and oxygen and scrap metal from
Kislorod PCC for US$4,536 thousand (2017: US$3,911 thousand);
b Purchases of cast iron balls from AutoKraZ Holding Co. for
US$274 thousand (2017: US$851 thousand); and
b Purchases of cast iron balls from OJSC Uzhgorodsky Turbogas
for US$3,536 thousand (2017: US$2,673 thousand).
c Purchases of spare parts from CJSC Kyiv Shipbuilding and Ship
Repair Plant ("KSRSSZ") in the amount of US$1,201 thousand (2017:
US$96 thousand);
c Purchases of spare parts from OJSC Uzhgorodsky Turbogas in the
amount of US$533 thousand (2017: US$294 thousand);
c Purchases of spare parts from Valsa GTV of US$455 thousand (2017: US$756 thousand); and
c Purchases of spare parts from OJSC Berdichev Machine-Building
Plant Progress of US$724 thousand (2017: US$211 thousand).
d Purchases of advertisement, marketing and general public
relations services from FC Vorskla of US$10,702 thousand (2017:
US$10,867 thousand).
e Insurance premiums of US$535 thousand (2017: US$403 thousand)
paid to ASK Omega for workmen's insurance and other insurances.
Associated companies
The Group entered into related party transactions with its
associated company TIS Ruda LLC, which were carried out on an arm's
length basis in the normal course of business for the members of
the Group (see Note 32 Investments in associates).
d Purchases of logistics services in the amount of US$19,138
thousand (2017: US$18,366 thousand) relating to port operations,
including port charges, handling costs, agent commissions and
storage costs.
Other related parties
The Group entered into various transactions with related parties
other than those under the control of the majority owner of the
Group. All transactions were carried out on an arm's length basis
in the normal course of business.
d Purchases of logistics management services from Slavutich Ruda
Ltd. relating to customs clearance services and the coordination of
rail transit totalling US$702 thousand (2017: US$827 thousand).
Effective 20 April 2018, this Company is no longer considered as a
related party. See page 156.
e Legal services in the amount of US$375 thousand (2017: US$221
thousand) provided by Kuoni Attorneys at Law Ltd., which is
controlled by a former member of the Board of Directors of Ferrexpo
plc who resigned in November 2016, but still acts as a member of
the Board of Directors of one of the subsidiaries of the Group;
and
e Consulting service fees and expenses totalling US$154 thousand
(2017: US$205 thousand) paid to Nage Capital Management AG, which
is controlled by a former member of the Board of Directors of
Ferrexpo plc who resigned in August 2014, but still acts as a
member of the Board of Directors of one of the subsidiaries of the
Group.
Purchases of property, plant and equipment
The table below details the transactions of a capital nature
which were undertaken between Group companies and entities under
common control, associated companies and other related parties
during the periods presented.
Year ended 31.12.18 Year ended 31.12.17
----------------------------------- ------------------------------ ------------------------------
Entities Entities
under Other under Other
common Associated related common Associated related
US$000 control companies parties control companies parties
----------------------------------- -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Purchases in the ordinary course
of business 4,678 - - 781 - -
----------------------------------- -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Total purchases of property, plant
and equipment 4,678 - - 781 - -
----------------------------------- -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
During the period ended 31 December 2018, the Group purchased
major spare parts and equipment from OJSC Berdichev
Machine-Building Plant Progress totalling US$2,821 thousand (2017:
US$6 thousand) in respect of the construction of the concentrate
stockyard, from AutoKraZ Holding Co. totalling US$398 thousand
(2017: nil) for cranes and lifters installed on truck chassis and
from Valsa GTV totalling US$212 thousand (2017: nil) for
rubber-lined steel cover sheets for the mills.
The Group further procured services relating to the top soil
removal and relocation of waste material and gravel in the amount
of US$1,165 thousand (2017: US$713 thousand) from DVD Trans. The
company ceased to be a related party in September 2018; in
accordance with the Listing Rules, all transactions with DVD Trans
within one year from the cessation are still considered as related
party transactions and disclosed as such.
Balances with related parties
The outstanding balances, as a result of transactions with
related parties, for the periods presented are shown in the table
below:
As at 31.12.18 As at 31.12.17
------------------------------------- ------------------------------ ------------------------------
Entities Entities
under Other under Other
common Associated related common Associated related
US$000 control companies parties control companies parties
------------------------------------- -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Prepayments for property, plant
and equipmentf 6,121 - - 3,022 - -
------------------------------------- -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Total non-current assets 6,121 - - 3,022 - -
------------------------------------- -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Trade and other receivables g 214 1,302 1 203 1,082 37
------------------------------------- -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Prepayments and other current assets
h 1,181 - - 1,088 - 171
------------------------------------- -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Total current assets 1,395 1,302 1 1,291 1,082 208
------------------------------------- -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Trade and other payables i 465 963 - 344 1,367 64
------------------------------------- -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Accrued liabilities and contract
liabilities - - - - - 51
------------------------------------- -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
Total current liabilities 465 963 - 344 1,367 115
------------------------------------- -------- ---------- -------- -------- ---------- --------
A description of the balances over US$200 thousand in the
current or comparative year is given below.
Entities under common control
f As at 31 December 2018, prepayments for property, plant and
equipment totalling US$5,980 thousand (2017: US$2,722 thousand)
were made to OJSC Berdichev Machine-Building Plant Progress. As at
the end of the comparative period ended 31 December 2017, US$256
thousand was prepaid to AutoKraZ Holding Co for property, plant and
equipment.
h Prepayments and other current assets totalling US$858 thousand
as at 31 December 2018 related to prepayments made to FC Vorskla
for advertisement, marketing and general public relations services
(2017: US$858 thousand).
i Trade and other payables included US$213 thousand (2017:
US$172 thousand) related to the purchase of compressed air, oxygen
and scrap metal from Kislorod PCC.
Associated companies
g As at 31 December 2018, trade and other receivables included
US$1,302 thousand (2017: US$1,082 thousand) related to dividends
declared by TIS Ruda LLC.
i As at 31 December 2018, trade and other payables included
US$963 thousand (2017: US$1,367 thousand) related to purchases of
logistics services from TIS Ruda LLC.
Other related parties
h As at the end of the comparative year ended 31 December 2017
prepayments and other current assets totalling US$171 thousand
related to prepayments made to Slavutich Ruda Ltd. for distribution
services. Effective 20 April 2018, this Company is no longer
considered as a related party. See page 156.
i As at the end of the comparative year ended 31 December 2017
trade and other payables of US$59 thousand were in respect of
distribution services provided by Slavutich Ruda Ltd.
Blooming Land and its three sub-funds (the "Charity")
In the year ended 31 December 2018, the Group made donations of
US$9,500 thousand to the Charity (2017: US$24,000 thousand).
In 2017 and 2018, funding to Blooming Land was provided by one
of the Group's operational subsidiaries in Ukraine, Ferrexpo
Poltava Mining. Khimreaktiv LLC, controlled by Kostyantin Zhevago,
the CEO and ultimate majority shareholder of Ferrexpo, also
independently donated funds to the Charity.
In July 2018, the Board received notification from Deloitte that
as part of their interim review relating to donations made by the
Group to Blooming Land in 2018, Deloitte had discovered, according
to copy bank statements that in 2017 temporary funding
contributions totalling approximately US$16,300 thousand were
advanced by Khimreaktiv LLC into one of the Charity's sub-funds.
The Charity subsequently repaid Khimreaktiv LLC using monies
received from the Group as part of its regular donations. These
transactions between Khimreaktiv LLC and the sub-fund were
considered related party transactions under IAS 24 Related party
disclosures that ought previously to have been disclosed. The
transactions between the sub-funds and Khimreaktiv LLC were not
considered to be related party transactions of the Group under the
UK Listing Rules. These copy bank statements and all related
transactions shown are being further considered as part of the
ongoing Independent Review.
The Charity is considered by the Group to operate independently
of its Chief Executive Officer and its executive management, and
its Chief Executive Officer and its executive management are not
considered to control or exercise significant influence over the
Charity. Accordingly, the Charity is not consolidated by the Group.
There is no agreement or arrangement between the Group and
Khimreaktiv LLC in relation to their contributions to the
Charity.
For further information see Chairman's Statement (page 4),
Principal Risks (page 22), Responsible Business (page 31),
Corporate Governance Report (page 42), Independent Review Committee
Report (page 49), Audit Committee Report (page 50) and Note 7
Operating expenses, Note 29 Commitments, contingencies and legal
disputes and Note 34 Events after the reporting period to the
consolidated financial statements.
Note 34: Events after the reporting period
On 4 February 2019, the Board commenced an Independent Review
into matters relating to the Group's donations to Blooming Land,
including a review into whether Blooming Land's use of Ferrexpo's
contributions was for their stated purpose and to review Blooming
Land's status as a non-related party. An Independent Review
Committee (IRC) was established and the work of the IRC and its
advisers in the UK and Ukraine remains ongoing.
As of the date of this report, the IRC has made progress in
receiving explanations regarding the differences contained in the
copy bank statements, provided by the Charity as well as the
receipt of third party evidence, including governmental
confirmations that could explain some but not all of the possible
discrepancies in the application of funds by the Charity. The IRC
is undertaking further work to corroborate these explanations and
evidence, however, there are indications that some funds could have
been misappropriated.
The potential effect arising from new evidence discovered during
the Independent Review on the consolidated financial statements,
including the critical judgements involved, is disclosed in Note 7
Operating expenses - Nature of the Group's community support
donations, Note 29 Commitments, contingencies and legal disputes,
and further information is provided in Note 33 Related party
disclosures. For further information see Chairman's Statement (page
4), Principal Risks (page 22), Responsible Business (page 31),
Corporate Governance Report (page 42), Independent Review Committee
Report (page 49) and Audit Committee Report (page 50)
On 7 April 2019, the Group made the final repayment of
US$173,181 thousand in respect of the unsecured Notes outstanding
as of the end of the financial year ended 31 December 2018. See
Note 12 Interest-bearing loans and borrowings for further
information.
Subsequent to the year-end, the Group's proposed dividends are
disclosed in Note 12 Earnings per share and dividends paid and
proposed. Other than the above disclosed information, no material
adjusting or non-adjusting events have occurred.
PARENT COMPANY STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION
Ferrexpo plc (the "Company") is required to present its separate
Parent Company statement of financial position and certain notes to
the statement of financial position on a standalone basis as at 31
December 2018 and 2017, which has been prepared in accordance with
Financial Reporting Standard 101 Reduced Disclosure Framework ("FRS
101"). Information on the principal accounting policies is outlined
in Note 3 Significant accounting policies.
Ferrexpo plc is exempt from presenting a standalone Parent
Company profit and loss account and statement of comprehensive
income in accordance with section 408 of the UK Companies Act
2006.
As at As at
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Fixed assets
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Investment in subsidiary undertakings 4 147,496 147,496
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Total fixed assets 147,496 147,496
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Current assets
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Debtors: amounts falling due within one year 5 70,091 22,435
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Debtors: amounts falling due after more than one
year 5 763,891 813,018
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Cash at bank and in hand 184 1,576
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Total current assets 834,166 837,029
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Creditors: amounts falling due within one year 6 3,428 4,068
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Net current assets 830,738 832,961
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Total assets less current liabilities 978,233 980,457
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Creditors: amounts falling due after more than one
year 6 463 494
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Net assets 977,771 979,963
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Capital and reserves
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Called up share capital 7 121,628 121,628
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Share premium account 7 185,112 185,112
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Treasury share reserve 7 (77,260) (77,260)
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Employee benefit trust reserve 7 (3,848) (4,522)
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Retained earnings 7 752,139 755,005
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Total capital and reserves 977,771 979,963
--------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
The profit after taxation for the Company, registration number
05432915, was US$97,790 thousand for the financial year ended 31
December 2018 (2017: US$24,562 thousand).
The financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors
on 22 April 2019.
Steve Lucas
Chairman
Christopher Mawe
Chief Financial Officer
PARENT COMPANY STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY
Employee
Treasury benefit Total
Issued Share share trust Retained capital
US$000 capital premium reserve reserve earnings and reserves
-------------------------------------- -------- -------- -------- -------- --------- -------------
At 1 January 2017 121,628 185,112 (77,260) (5,108) 788,410 1,012,782
-------------------------------------- -------- -------- -------- -------- --------- -------------
Profit for the period - - - - 24,562 24,562
-------------------------------------- -------- -------- -------- -------- --------- -------------
Total comprehensive income for the
period - - - - 24,562 24,562
-------------------------------------- -------- -------- -------- -------- --------- -------------
Equity dividends paid to shareholders - - - - (57,967) (57,967)
-------------------------------------- -------- -------- -------- -------- --------- -------------
Share-based payments - - - 586 - 586
-------------------------------------- -------- -------- -------- -------- --------- -------------
At 31 December 2017 121,628 185,112 (77,260) (4,522) 755,005 979,963
-------------------------------------- -------- -------- -------- -------- --------- -------------
Application of new IFRSs (Note 3) - - - - (3,786) (3,786)
-------------------------------------- -------- -------- -------- -------- --------- -------------
At 1 January 2018 - after application
of new IFRSs 121,628 185,112 (77,260) (4,522) 751,219 976,177
-------------------------------------- -------- -------- -------- -------- --------- -------------
Profit for the period - - - - 97,790 97,790
-------------------------------------- -------- -------- -------- -------- --------- -------------
Total comprehensive income for the
period - - - - 97,790 97,790
-------------------------------------- -------- -------- -------- -------- --------- -------------
Equity dividends paid to shareholders
(Note 7) - - - - (96,870) (96,870)
-------------------------------------- -------- -------- -------- -------- --------- -------------
Share-based payments - - - 674 - 674
-------------------------------------- -------- -------- -------- -------- --------- -------------
At 31 December 2018 121,628 185,112 (77,260) (3,848) 752,139 977,771
-------------------------------------- -------- -------- -------- -------- --------- -------------
notes to the Parent Company Financial Statements
Note 1: Corporate information
The Company is incorporated and registered in England, which is
considered to be the country of domicile, with its registered
office at 55 St James's Street, London SW1A 1LA, UK. The Company's
Ordinary Shares are traded on the London Stock Exchange.
The majority shareholder of the Company is Fevamotinico S.a.r.l.
("Fevamotinico"), a company incorporated in Luxembourg and
ultimately owned by The Minco Trust, of which Kostyantin Zhevago,
the Group's Chief Executive Officer, is a beneficiary. At the time
this report was published, Fevamotinico held 50.3% (2017: 50.3%) of
the Company's issued share capital.
Note 2: Basis of preparation
The financial statements are prepared under the historical cost
convention and in accordance with Financial Reporting Standard 101
Reduced Disclosure Framework ("FRS 101").
The financial statements are presented in US Dollars (US$), the
Company's functional currency, and all values are rounded to the
nearest thousand, except where otherwise indicated. The functional
currency is determined as the currency of the primary economic
environment in which the Company operates. The majority of the
Company's operating activities are conducted in US Dollars.
The Company has taken advantage of the following disclosure
exemptions under FRS 101 as the Company is included in publicly
available consolidated financial statements, which include
disclosures that comply with the standards listed below:
- the requirements of paragraphs 45(b) and 46-52 of IFRS 2 Share-based payments;
- the requirements of IFRS 7 Financial instruments: Disclosures;
- the requirements of paragraphs 91-99 of IFRS 13 Fair value measurements;
- the following paragraphs of IAS 1 Presentation of financial statements:
- 10 (d) (statement of cash flows);
- 16 (statement of compliance with all IFRS);
- 38A (requirement for minimum of two primary statements,
including cash flow statements);
- 38B-D (additional comparative information);
- 111 (cash flow statement information); and
- 134-136 (capital management disclosures).
- the requirements of IAS 7 Statement of cash flows;
- the requirements of paragraphs 30 and 31 of IAS 8 Accounting
policies, changes in accounting estimates and errors;
- the requirements of paragraph 17 of IAS 24 Related party
disclosures and the requirements to disclose related party
transactions entered into between two or more members of a group,
provided that any subsidiary which is a party to the transaction is
wholly owned by such a member of the same standard.
The Company does not have any employees other than the
Directors. The requirement to give employee numbers and costs
information under Section 411 of the Companies Act is addressed in
the Directors' Remuneration Report of the Group on page 59.
Note 3: Significant accounting policies
Foreign currencies
The accounting policy is consistent with the Group's policy set
out in Note 2 Basis of preparation of the Group's financial
statements.
Investments in subsidiary undertakings
Equity investments in subsidiaries are carried at cost less any
provision for impairments. Investments are reviewed for impairment
at each reporting date. If indication exists that investments may
be impaired, the investments' recoverable amounts are estimated. If
the carrying amount of an investment exceeds its recoverable
amount, the investment is considered impaired and is written down
to its recoverable amount, which is the higher of its fair value
less costs of disposal and its value in use. Impairment losses are
recognised in the income statement.
Financial guarantees
Financial guarantee liabilities issued by the Company are those
contracts that require a payment to be made to reimburse the holder
for a loss, which incurs because the specified debtor fails to make
a payment when due in accordance with the terms of a debt
instrument.
Financial guarantees provided are initially recognised at fair
value and subsequently measured at the higher of the best estimate
to settle the present obligation at the reporting date and the
amount initially recognised less, when appropriate, the cumulative
amortisation recognised as guarantee fee.
Treasury share reserve
Own equity instruments which are reacquired (treasury shares)
are recognised at cost and deducted from equity shown in the
treasury share reserve. No gain or loss is recognised in the income
statement on the purchase, sale, issue or cancellation of the
Group's own equity instruments. Any difference between the carrying
amount and the consideration is recognised in reserves.
Share-based payments
The accounting policy is consistent with the Group's policy set
out in Note 27 Share-based payments of the Group's financial
statements.
Employee benefit trust reserve
Ferrexpo plc shares held by the Company are classified in
capital and reserves as employee benefit trust reserves and
recognised at cost. Consideration received for the sale of such
shares is also recognised in equity, with any difference between
the proceeds from sale and the original cost taken to revenue
reserves. No gain or loss is recognised on the purchase, sale issue
or cancellation of equity shares.
Taxation
The accounting policy is consistent with the Group's policy set
out in Note 11 Taxation of the Group's financial statements.
Changes in accounting policies
The accounting policies adopted and applied in the preparation
of the financial statements are consistent with those of the
previous year, except for the adoption of new and amended IFRS and
IFRIC interpretations effective as of 1 January 2018. The new and
amended IFRS and IFRIC interpretations adopted are consistent with
the Group's new accounting policies set out in Note 3 New
accounting policies of the Group's financial statements.
IFRS 9 Financial instruments
A detailed description of the new standard IFRS 9 Financial
instruments is provided in Note 3 New accounting policies of the
Group's financial statements. The effect from the expected credit
loss impairment model to be applied under the new standard is
primarily calculated for the Company's intercompany loan and
receivable balances outstanding as at the end of a reporting
period. The calculation was primarily based on publicly available
default risk ratings of the Group.
The tables below provide the details of the cumulative effects
from the first-time application of the new standards on the
statement of financial position as of 1 January 2018 and on the
statement of financial position and profit after taxation as at 31
December 2018.
Effect
Balance from application
as at of IFRS Year ended
US$000 01.01.18 9 31.12.17
-------------------------------- --------- ----------------- ----------
Statement of financial position
-------------------------------- --------- ----------------- ----------
Assets
-------------------------------- --------- ----------------- ----------
Debtors 831,667 (3,786) 835,453
-------------------------------- --------- ----------------- ----------
Capital and reserves
-------------------------------- --------- ----------------- ----------
Retained earnings 751,219 (3,786) 755,005
-------------------------------- --------- ----------------- ----------
Balance
Effect without
As reported from application effect
as at of IFRS from new
Notes 31.12.18 9 IFRSs
-------------------------------- ----- ----------- ----------------- ---------
Profit and loss account 97,790 200 97,590
-------------------------------- ----- ----------- ----------------- ---------
Statement of financial position
-------------------------------- ----- ----------- ----------------- ---------
Assets
-------------------------------- ----- ----------- ----------------- ---------
Debtors 5 833,981 (3,586) 837,567
-------------------------------- ----- ----------- ----------------- ---------
All other standards, interpretations and amendments adopted as
of 1 January 2018 have not had a significant impact on these
financial statements.
Use of critical estimates and judgements
The Company has not identified any area involving the use of
critical estimates and judgements made by management in preparing
the separate Parent Company financial statements.
Note 4: Investment in subsidiary undertakings
Investment in subsidiary undertakings at 31 December 2018
relates to the Company's investment in Ferrexpo AG, which is
domiciled in Switzerland and wholly owned by the Company. The
subsidiary's registered office is at Bahnhofstrasse 13, 6340 Baar,
Switzerland.
US$000 At 31.12.18 At 31.12.17
-------------------------------------------- ----------- -----------
Investment in subsidiary undertakings 147,496 147,496
-------------------------------------------- ----------- -----------
Total investment in subsidiary undertakings 147,496 147,496
-------------------------------------------- ----------- -----------
See Note 31 Consolidated subsidiaries to the consolidated
financial statements for further information on subsidiaries
indirectly held by the Company.
Note 5: Debtors
Debtors as at 31 December 2018 related to the following:
US$000 At 31.12.18 At 31.12.17
--------------------------------------------------- ----------- -----------
Amounts falling due within one year
--------------------------------------------------- ----------- -----------
Amounts owed by subsidiary undertakings 67,775 19,273
--------------------------------------------------- ----------- -----------
Accrued interest owed by subsidiary undertakings 1,979 2,793
--------------------------------------------------- ----------- -----------
Prepaid expenses 337 369
--------------------------------------------------- ----------- -----------
Total amounts falling due within one year 70,091 22,435
--------------------------------------------------- ----------- -----------
Amounts falling due after more than one year
--------------------------------------------------- ----------- -----------
Amounts owed by subsidiary undertakings 763,891 813,018
--------------------------------------------------- ----------- -----------
Total amounts falling due after more than one year 763,891 813,018
--------------------------------------------------- ----------- -----------
Total debtors 833,982 835,453
--------------------------------------------------- ----------- -----------
The Company's loans are contractually payable on demand but
having assessed the expected repayment profile, this balance is
presented as falling due after more than one year.
Amounts owed by subsidiary undertakings include the financial
guarantees provided by the Company and reflect the future guarantee
fee receivable recorded when the financial guarantees were
recognised as a liability.
The table above includes the impact from the application of the
new expected credit loss impairment model under IFRS 9 Financial
instruments. The balance of impairment losses on debtors included
in the profit after taxation is US$200 thousand as of 31 December
2018.
For the cumulative effects from the application of the new
standards IFRS 9 Financial instruments on the statement of
financial position as at 1 January 2018 and as at 31 December 2018
see Note 3 Significant accounting policies.
Note 6: Creditors
Creditors as at 31 December 2018 related to the following:
US$000 At 31.12.18 At 31.12.17
------ ----------- -----------
Creditors: amounts falling due within one year
--------------------------------------------------------- ----- -----
Financial guarantees 485 1,211
--------------------------------------------------------- ----- -----
Other payables and accrued liabilities 2,943 2,857
--------------------------------------------------------- ----- -----
Total creditors: amounts falling due within one year 3,428 4,068
--------------------------------------------------------- ----- -----
Creditors: amounts falling due after more than one year
--------------------------------------------------------- ----- -----
Financial guarantees 463 494
--------------------------------------------------------- ----- -----
Total creditors: amounts falling due after more than one
year 463 494
--------------------------------------------------------- ----- -----
The Company's policy is to provide financial guarantees under
limited circumstances only for the benefit of wholly owned or
substantially owned subsidiaries.
As at 31 December 2018, the Company was a guarantor to the
following major external debt facilities of the Group's subsidiary
Ferrexpo Finance plc:
- Notes totalling US$173,181 thousand of a 10.375% Eurobond
falling due on 7 April 2019. The first instalment of US$173,181
thousand fell due and was repaid on 7 April 2018. The interest
coupon is payable semi-annually; and
- a syndicated revolving US$400,000 thousand pre-export finance
facility, of which US$205,000 thousand is available (31 December
2017: US$195,000 thousand) and US$195,000 thousand is drawn (31
December 2017: nil). The facility was secured on 16 November 2017
and drawn in March 2018. In August 2018, an agreement to increase
and extend the facility was signed. The effective date of the
increase and extension was 6 November 2018. The facility was
increased from US$195,000 thousand to US$400,000 thousand and the
tenor was extended by one year from 31 December 2020 to 31 December
2021. Following a one-year grace period, the facility will be
amortised in 12 quarterly instalments with the first instalment due
on 6 February 2020 and the final repayment due on 6 November
2022.
The Company earns guarantee fees from its subsidiaries for the
financial guarantees provided in respect of the Group's finance
facilities aforementioned.
Note 7: Share capital and reserves
Share capital
Share capital represents the nominal value on issue of the
Company's equity share capital, comprising GBP0.10 Ordinary Shares.
The fully paid share capital of the Company at 31 December 2018 was
613,967,956 Ordinary Shares (2017: 613,967,956) at a par value of
GBP0.10 paid for in cash, resulting in share capital of US$121,628
thousand (2017: US$121,628 thousand) per the statement of financial
position.
Treasury share reserve
In September 2008, the Company completed a buyback of 25,343,814
shares for a total cost of US$77,260 thousand (2017: US$77,260
thousand). These shares are currently held as treasury shares by
the Group. The Companies Act 2006 forbids the exercise of any
rights (including voting rights) and the payment of dividends in
respect of treasury shares.
Employee benefit trust reserve
This reserve represents the treasury shares used to satisfy
future grants for senior management incentive schemes. As at 31
December 2018, the employee benefit trust reserve included
2,326,256 shares (2017: 2,916,419 shares).
Distributable reserves
The Company is the Group's holding company, with no direct
operating business, so its ability to make distributions to its
shareholders is dependent on its ability to access profits held in
the subsidiaries. The Company's retained earnings shown in the
statement of changes in equity as of 31 December 2018 do not
reflect the profits that are available for distribution by the
Company as of this date. Taking into account relevant thin
capitalisation rules and dividend-related covenants for the Group's
major bank debt facilities, the total available distributable
reserves of Ferrexpo plc was US$168,370 thousand as of 31 December
2018 (2017: US$197,236 thousand).
Dividends proposed and paid
On 6 December 2018, the Group announced that the Directors had
proposed to pay an interim special dividend of 6.6 US cents per
Ordinary Share totalling US$38,695 thousand. This dividend was paid
on 14 January 2019 and, in accordance with UK law, will be
recognised in the financial statements for the year ending 31
December 2019.
As of 31 December 2017, a dividend payable was recognised in
respect of an interim special dividend proposed by the Directors on
7 December 2017 and payable on 15 January 2018. The presentation of
the comparatives as of 31 December 2017 has been adjusted to be
consistent with the current year presentation by derecognising the
interim special dividend of US$19,365 thousand (comprising of
US$16,008 thousand dividend payable and US$3,357 thousand
withholding tax) and recognising a corresponding credit to retained
earnings.
For further information see Note 12 Earnings per share and
dividends paid and proposed to the consolidated financial
statements.
Note 8: Events after the reporting period
No material adjusting or non-adjusting events have occurred
subsequent to the year end other than the proposed dividends
disclosed in Note 12 Earnings per share and dividends paid and
proposed to the consolidated financial statements.
ADDITIONAL DISCLOSURES
See Note 31 Consolidated subsidiaries for further information on
the Group.
Unless otherwise stated, the equity interest disclosed includes
ordinary or common shares which are owned by subsidiaries of the
Group.
Equity interest
owned
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- ------------------
31.12.18 31.12.17
Address of consolidated subsidiary's Principal
Name registered office activity % %
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Consolidated subsidiaries
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Holding company
and sale of
Ferrexpo AG Bahnhofstrasse 13, 6340 Baar, Switzerland iron ore pellets 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
PJSC Ferrexpo Budivelnykiv Street 16, 39802 Horishni
Poltava Mining Plavni, Poltava Region, Ukraine Iron ore mining 99.1 99.1
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
LLC Ferrexpo Yeristovo Budivelnykiv Street 15, 39802 Horishni
Mining Plavni, Poltava Region, Ukraine Iron ore mining 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
LLC Ferrexpo Belanovo Budivelnykiv Street 15, 39802 Horishni
Mining Plavni, Poltava Region, Ukraine Iron ore mining 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Office A2207, Jafza One, Jebel
Ferrexpo Middle Ali Free Zone, Dubai, U.A.E., P.O. Sale of iron
East FZE Box 18341 ore pellets 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Ferrexpo Finance 55 St James's Street, London SW1A
plc 1LA, United Kingdom Finance 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Management
Ferrexpo Services Patris Lumumba Street 4/6, 01042 services and
Limited Kyiv, Ukraine procurement 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Universal Services Patris Lumumba Street 4/6, 01042 Asset holding
Group Ltd. Kyiv, Ukraine company 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Portova Street 65, 39802 Horishni Trade, transportation
DP Ferrotrans Plavni, Poltava Region, Ukraine services 99.1 99.1
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
United Energy Budivelnykiv Street 16, 39802 Horishni
Company LLC Plavni, Poltava Region, Ukraine Holding company 99.1 99.1
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Nova Logistics Budivelnykiv Street 16, 39802 Horishni
Limited Plavni, Poltava Region, Ukraine Service company 51.0 51.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Marina Boulevard #05-02, Marina
Ferrexpo Singapore Bay Financial Centre, 018981 Singapore, Marketing
PTE Ltd. Singapore services 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Ferrexpo Shipping
International Ajeltake Road, MH-96960 Ajeltake
Ltd. Island - Majuro, Marshall Islands Holding company 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Ajeltake Road, MH-96960 Ajeltake
Iron Destiny Ltd. Island - Majuro, Marshall Islands Shipping company 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
First-DDSG Logistics
Holding GmbH Handelskai 348, 1020 Wien, Austria Holding company 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
EDDSG GmbH Handelskai 348, 1020 Wien, Austria Barging company 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
DDSG Tankschiffahrt
GmbH Handelskai 348, 1020 Wien, Austria Barging company 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
DDSG Services
GmbH Handelskai 348, 1020 Wien, Austria Service company 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Sukorói út 1., 8097 Nadap,
DDSG Mahart Kft. Hungary Barging company 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Sukorói út 1., 8097 Nadap,
Pancar Kft. Hungary Barging company 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Ferrexpo Port
Services GmbH Handelskai 348, 1020 Wien, Austria Port services 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Ecluzei Street 1, Agigea, Constanta,
Transcanal SRL Romania Port services 77.6 77.6
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Helogistics Asset Sukorói út 1., 8097 Nadap, Asset holding
Leasing Kft. Hungary company 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
LLC DDSG Ukraine Patris Lumumba Street 4/6, 01042
Holding Kyiv, Ukraine Holding company 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Patris Lumumba Street 4/6, 01042 Asset holding
LLC DDSG Invest Kyiv, Ukraine company 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
LLC DDSG Ukraine
Shipping Patris Lumumba Street 4/6, 01042
Management Kyiv, Ukraine Barging company 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Radhospna Street 18, 39763 Kamiani
LLC DDSG Ukraine Potoky, Kremenchuk District, Poltava Asset holding
Shipping Region, Ukraine company 100.0 100.0
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Ferrexpo Poltava Heroiv Dnipra Street 23-a, 39802
Mining Charity Horishni Plavni, Poltava Region,
Fund1 Ukraine Charity fund 99.1 99.1
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Associate
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Chapaieva Street 50, 67543 Vizirka
TIS Ruda LLC Village, Odesa Region, Ukraine Port development 49.4 49.4
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
Available-for-sale
investments 2
-------------------------- ------------------------------------------ ---------------------- -------- --------
PJSC Stakhanov
Railcar Company Rail car producer 1.1 1.1
---------------------------------------------------------------------- --------------------- -------- --------
Vostok Ruda LLC Iron ore mining 1.1 1.1
---------------------------------------------------------------------- --------------------- -------- --------
LLC Atol Gas 9.9 9.9
---------------------------------------------------------------------- --------------------- -------- --------
CJSC AMA Gas 9.0 9.0
---------------------------------------------------------------------- --------------------- -------- --------
CJSC Amtek Gas 9.0 9.0
---------------------------------------------------------------------- --------------------- -------- --------
1 Charity fund controlled by the Group through its CSR Committees.
2 All investments relate to companies incorporated in Ukraine and are fully impaired.
Alternative Performance Measures
When assessing and discussing the Group's reported financial
performance, financial position and cash flows, management may make
reference to Alternative Performance Measures ("APMs") that are not
defined or specified under International Financial Reporting
Standards ("IFRS").
APMs are not uniformly defined by all companies, including those
in the Group's industry. Accordingly, the APMs used by the Group
may not be comparable with similarly titled measures and
disclosures made by other companies. APMs should be considered in
addition to, and not as a substitute for or as superior to,
measures of financial performance, financial position or cash flows
reported in accordance with IFRS.
Ferrexpo makes reference to the following APMs in the 2018
Annual Report.
C1 cash cost of production
Definition: Non-financial measure, which represents the cash
costs of production of iron pellets from own ore divided by
production volume of own production ore. Non-C1 cost components
include non-cash costs such as depreciation, inventory movements
and costs of purchased ore and concentrate. The Group presents the
C1 cash cost of production because it believes it is a useful
operational measure of its cost competitiveness compared to its
peer group.
Year ended Year ended
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
---------------------------------- ---------- ----------
C1 cash costs 454,560 335,451
---------------------------------- ---------- ----------
Non-C1 cost components 26,800 31,745
---------------------------------- ---------- ----------
Cost of sales - pellet production 481,360 367,196
---------------------------------- ---------- ----------
Own ore produced (tonnes) 10,506,164 10,394,440
---------------------------------- ---------- ----------
C1 cash cost per tonne (US$) 43.27 32.27
---------------------------------- ---------- ----------
Underlying EBITDA
Definition: The Group calculates the underlying EBITDA as profit
before tax and finance plus depreciation and amortisation, net
gains and losses from disposal of investments and property, plant
and equipment, share-based payments and write-offs and impairment
losses. The underlying EBITDA is presented because it is a useful
measure for evaluating the Group's ability to generate cash and its
operating performance. See Note 5 Segment information to the
consolidated financial statements for further details.
Closest equivalent IFRS measure: Profit before tax and
finance.
Rationale for adjustment: The Group presents the underlying
EBITDA as it is a useful measure for evaluating its ability to
generate cash and its operating performance. Also it aids
comparability across peer groups as it is a measurement that is
often used.
Reconciliation to closest IFRS equivalent:
Year Year
ended ended
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Underlying EBITDA 502,897 550,705
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Losses on disposal of property, plant and equipment (5,701) (7,754)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Share-based payments 27 (674) (586)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Write-offs 7 (1,489) (407)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Depreciation and amortisation (62,094) (46,392)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Profit before tax and finance 432,939 495,566
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Diluted earnings per share
Definition: Earnings per share calculated using the diluted
number of Ordinary Shares outstanding.
Closest equivalent IFRS measure: Diluted earnings per share.
Rationale for adjustment: Excludes the impact of special items
that can mask underlying changes in performance.
Reconciliation to closest IFRS equivalent:
Year Year
ended ended
31.12.18 31.12.17
----------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Earnings/(loss) for the year attributable to equity shareholders
per share
----------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Basic (US cents) 56.9 67.1
----------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Diluted (US cents) 56.7 66.9
----------------------------------------------------------------- --------- ---------
Net debt to underlying EBITDA
Definition: Net debt divided by the underlying EBITDA (for the
last 12 months):
As at As at
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------ --------- ---------
Net debt (US$000) (338,862) (393,964)
------------------------------- --------- ---------
Underlying EBITDA (US$000) 502,897 550,705
------------------------------- --------- ---------
Net debt to underlying EBITDA 0.67x 0.72x
------------------------------- --------- ---------
In the current period, management has reviewed the presentation
of the accrued interest and has reclassified it from
interest-bearing loans and borrowings to accrued liabilities in
order to better reflect the nature of this balance in the
presentation reducing net debt by US$9,358 thousand. See Note 5
Segment information to the consolidated financial statements for
further information.
Rationale for adjustment: The ratio is a measurement of the
underlying EBITDA Group's leverage, calculated as a company's
interest-bearing liabilities minus cash or cash equivalents,
divided by its underlying EBITDA.
Reconciliation to net debt:
As at As at
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Cash and cash equivalents 24 62,996 97,742
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings - current 25 (204,600) (305,412)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Interest-bearing loans and borrowings - non-current 25 (197,258) (186,294)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Net debt (338,862) (393,964)
---------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
For a reconciliation of underlying EBITDA to profit before tax
and finance see page 168.
Capital investment
Definition: Capital expenditure for the purchase of property,
plant and equipment and intangible assets.
Closest equivalent IFRS measure: Purchase of property, plant and
equipment and intangible assets (net cash flows used in investing
activities).
Rationale for adjustment: The Group presents the capital
investment as it is a useful measure for evaluating the degree of
capital invested in its business operations.
Reconciliation to closest IFRS equivalent:
As at As at
US$000 Notes 31.12.18 31.12.17
--------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Purchase of property, plant and equipment and intangible
assets
(net cash flows used in investing activities) 13/14 135,113 102,953
--------------------------------------------------------- ----- --------- ---------
Total liquidity
Definition: Sum of cash and cash equivalents and available
facilities.
Closest equivalent IFRS measure: Cash and cash equivalents.
Rationale for adjustment: The Group presents total liquidity as
it is a useful measure for evaluating its ability to meet
short-term business requirements.
Reconciliation to closest IFRS equivalent:
As at As at
US$000 31.12.18 31.12.17
------------------------------- --------- ---------
Cash and cash equivalents 62,996 97,742
-------------------------------- --------- ---------
Available committed facilities 205,000 213,750
-------------------------------- --------- ---------
Total liquidity 267,996 311,492
-------------------------------- --------- ---------
Glossary
Act The Companies Act 2006
AGM The Annual General Meeting of the
Company
Articles The Articles of Association of the
Company
Audit Committee The Audit Committee of the Company's
Board
Bank F&C Bank Finance & Credit
Belanovo or Bilanivske An iron ore deposit located immediately
to the north of Yeristovo
benchmark price International seaborne traded iron
ore pricing mechanism understood to
be offered to the market by major
iron ore producers under long-term
contracts
beneficiation process A number of processes whereby the
mineral is extracted from the crude
ore
BIP Business Improvement Programme, a
programme of projects to increase
production output and efficiency at
FPM
blast furnace pellets Used in Basic Oxygen Furnace "BOF"
steelmaking and constitute about 70%
of the traded pellet market
Board The Board of Directors of the Company
BT Billion tonnes
C1 costs Represents the cash costs of production
of iron pellets from own ore, divided
by production volume from own ore,
and excludes non-cash costs such as
depreciation, pension costs and inventory
movements, costs of purchased ore,
concentrate and production cost of
gravel
Capsize Capesize vessels are typically above
150,000 tonnes deadweight. Ships in
this class include oil tankers, supertankers
and bulk carriers transporting coal,
ore and other commodity raw materials.
Standard capesize vessels are able
to transit through the Suez Canal
capital employed The aggregate of equity attributable
to shareholders, non-controlling interests
and borrowings
Central Europe This segmentation for the Group's
sales includes Austria, the Czech
Republic, Hungary, Serbia and Slovakia
CFR Delivery including cost and freight
Charity Donations made to a charity called
Blooming Land which operates through
three sub-funds
China & South East Asia This segmentation for the Group's
sales includes China and Vietnam
CIF Delivery including cost, insurance
and freight
CIS The Commonwealth of Independent States
Code The UK Corporate Governance Code
CODM The Executive Committee is considered
to be the Group's Chief Operating
Decision-Maker
Company Ferrexpo plc, a public company incorporated
in England and Wales with limited
liability
CPI Consumer Price Index
CRU The CRU Group provides market analysis
and consulting advice in the global
mining industry (see www.crugroup.com)
CSR Corporate Social Responsibility
CSR Committee The Corporate Safety and Social Responsibility
Committee of the Board of the Company
DAP Delivery at place
DFS Detailed feasibility study
Directors The Directors of the Company
Direct reduction Used in Direct Reduction Iron "DRI"
"DR" pellets production. In regions where natural
gas is cheap and plentiful, such as
the Middle East, DR pellets are mixed
with natural gas to produce DRI, an
alternative source of metallic to
scrap in Electric Arc Furnace "EAF"
steelmaking. DR pellets are a niche,
higher quality product with Fe content
greater than 67% and a combined level
of silica and alumina of <2%
EBT Employee benefit trust
EPS Earnings per share
Executive Committee The Executive Committee of management
appointed by the Company's Board
Executive Directors The Executive Directors of the Company
FBM LLC Ferrexpo Belanovo Mining, a company
incorporated under the laws of Ukraine
Fe Iron
Ferrexpo The Company and its subsidiaries
Ferrexpo AG Group Ferrexpo AG and its subsidiaries,
including FPM
Fevamotinico Fevamotinico S.a.r.l., a company incorporated
with limited liability in Luxembourg
First-DDSG First-DDSG Logistics Holding GmbH
(formerly Helogistics Holding GmbH)
and its subsidiaries, an inland waterway
transport group operating on the Danube/Rhine
river corridor
FOB Delivered free on board, which means
that the seller's obligation to deliver
has been fulfilled when the goods
have passed over the ship's rail at
the named port of shipment, and all
future obligations in terms of costs
and risks of loss or damage transfer
to the buyer from that point onwards
FPM Ferrexpo Poltava Mining, also known
as PJSC Ferrexpo Poltava Mining, a
company incorporated under the laws
of Ukraine
FRMC Finance and Risk Management Committee,
a sub-committee of the Executive Committee
FTSE 250 Financial Times Stock Exchange top
250 companies
FYM LLC Ferrexpo Yeristovo Mining, a company
incorporated under the laws of Ukraine
GPL Gorishne-Plavninske-Lavrykivske, the
iron ore deposit being mined by FPM
Group The Company and its subsidiaries
HSE Health, safety and environment
IAS International Accounting Standards
IASB International Accounting Standards
Board
IFRS International Financial Reporting
Standards, as adopted by the EU
IPO Initial public offering
iron ore concentrate Product of the beneficiation process
with enriched iron content
iron ore pellets Balled and fired agglomerate of iron
ore concentrate, whose physical properties
are well suited for transportation
to and reduction within a blast furnace
iron ore sinter fines Fine iron ore screened to -6.3mm
JORC Australasian Joint Ore Reserves Committee
- the internationally accepted code
for ore classification
K22 GPL ore has been classified as either
K22 or K23 quality, of which K22 ore
is of higher quality (richer)
KPI Key Performance Indicator
KT Thousand tonnes
LIBOR The London Inter Bank Offered Rate
LLC Limited Liability Company (in Ukraine)
LTIFR Lost Time Injury Frequency Rate
LTIP Long-Term Incentive Plan
m3 Cubic metre
majority shareholder Fevamotinico S.a.r.l., The Minco Trust
and Kostyantin Zhevago (together)
Mineral Resources Concentration or occurrence of material
of intrinsic economic interest in
or on the earth's crust in such form,
quality and quantity that there are
reasonable prospects for eventual
economic extraction
Mm Millimetre
MT Million tonnes
Mtpa Million tonnes per annum
NBU National Bank of Ukraine
Nominations Committee The Nominations Committee of the Company's
Board
Non-executive Directors Non-executive Directors of the Company
NOPAT Net operating profit after tax
North East Asia This segmentation for the Group's
sales includes Japan and Korea
OHSAS 18001 International safety standard "Occupational
Health & Safety Management System
Specification"
Ordinary Shares Ordinary Shares of 10 pence each in
the Company
Ore A mineral or mineral aggregate containing
precious or useful minerals in such
quantities, grade and chemical combination
as to make extraction economic
Panama Modern panamax ships typically carry
a weight of between 65,000 and 90,000
tonnes of cargo and can transit both
the Panama and Suez canals
PPI Ukrainian producer price index
probable reserves Those measured and/or indicated mineral
resources which are not yet "proved",
but of which detailed technical and
economic studies have demonstrated
that extraction can be justified at
the time of determination and under
specific economic conditions
proved reserves Measured mineral resources of which
detailed technical and economic studies
have demonstrated that extraction
can be justified at the time of determination
and under specific economic conditions
rail car Railway wagon used for the transport
of iron ore concentrate or pellets
Relationship Agreement The relationship agreement entered
into among Fevamotinico S.a.r.l.,
Kostyantin Zhevago, The Minco Trust
and the Company
Remuneration Committee The Remuneration Committee of the
Company's Board
Reserves Those parts of mineral resources for
which sufficient information is available
to enable detailed or conceptual mine
planning and for which such planning
has been undertaken. Reserves are
classified as either proved or probable
Sinter A porous aggregate charged directly
to the blast furnace which is normally
produced by firing fine iron ore and/or
iron ore concentrate, other binding
materials and coke breeze as the heat
source
spot price The current price of a product for
immediate delivery
sterling/GBP Pounds Sterling, the currency of the
United Kingdom
STIP Short-Term Incentive Plan
sub funds Three funds that operate under the
Blooming Land charity
Tailings The waste material produced from ore
after economically recoverable metals
or minerals have been extracted. Changes
in metal prices and improvements in
technology can sometimes make the
tailings economic to process at a
later date
Tolling The process by which a customer supplies
concentrate to a smelter and the smelter
invoices the customer with the smelting
charge, and possibly a refining charge,
and then returns the metal to the
customer
Ton US short ton, equal to 0.9072 metric
tonnes
tonne or t Metric tonne
treasury shares A company's own issued shares that
it has purchased but not cancelled
TSF Tailings storage facility
TSR Total Shareholder Return. The total
return earned on a share over a period
of time, measured as the dividend
per share plus capital gain, divided
by initial share price
UAH Ukrainian Hryvnia, the currency of
Ukraine
Ukr SEPRO The quality certification system in
Ukraine, regulated by law to ensure
conformity with safety and environmental
standards
underlying EBITDA The Group calculates the underlying
EBITDA as profit before tax and finance
plus depreciation and amortisation,
net gains and losses from disposal
of investments and property, plant
and equipment, share-based payments
and write-offs and impairment losses
underlying EBITDA margin Underlying EBITDA (see definition
above) as a percentage of revenue
US$/t US dollars per tonne
value-in-use The implied value of a material to
an end user relative to other options,
e.g. evaluating, in financial terms,
the productivity in the steel making
process of a particular quality of
iron ore pellets versus the productivity
of alternative qualities of iron ore
pellets
VAT Value added tax
WAFV Weighted average fair value
Western Europe This segmentation for the Group's
sales includes Germany and Italy
WMS Wet magnetic separation
Yeristovo or Yerystivske The deposit being developed by FYM
Shareholder Information
Registered Office
55 St James's Street
London
SW1A 1LA
www.ferrexpo.com
Advisers
Share Registrars
Equiniti
Aspect House
Spencer Road
Lancing
West Sussex
BN99 6DA
Financial
J.P. Morgan Cazenove Ltd
25 Bank Street
London
E14 5JP
Corporate Brokers
J.P. Morgan Cazenove Ltd
25 Bank Street
London
E14 5JP
Deutsche Bank AG
Winchester House
1 Great Winchester Street
London
EC2N 2DB
Legal
Herbert Smith Freehills
Exchange House
Primrose Street
London
EC2A 2EG
Auditors
Deloitte LLP
2 New Street Square
London
EC4A 3BZ
United Kingdom
This information is provided by RNS, the news service of the
London Stock Exchange. RNS is approved by the Financial Conduct
Authority to act as a Primary Information Provider in the United
Kingdom. Terms and conditions relating to the use and distribution
of this information may apply. For further information, please
contact rns@lseg.com or visit www.rns.com.
END
FR IJMMTMBMTMLL
(END) Dow Jones Newswires
April 23, 2019 02:01 ET (06:01 GMT)
Ferrexpo (LSE:FXPO)
Historical Stock Chart
From Apr 2024 to May 2024
Ferrexpo (LSE:FXPO)
Historical Stock Chart
From May 2023 to May 2024